<SPAN name="startofbook"></SPAN>
<h1>THE CRUISE OF THE<br/> SNARK</h1>
<div class="gapspace"> </div>
<p style="text-align: center"><span class="GutSmall">BY</span><br/>
JACK LONDON</p>
<p style="text-align: center">AUTHOR OF “VALLEY OF THE
MOON,” “JOHN BARLEYCORN”<br/>
“MUTINY OF THE ELSINORE,” ETC.</p>
<div class="gapspace"> </div>
<blockquote><p>“Yes have heard the beat of the offshore
wind,<br/>
And the thresh of the deep-sea rain;<br/>
You have heard the song—how long! how long!<br/>
Pull out on the trail again!”</p>
</blockquote>
<div class="gapspace"> </div>
<p style="text-align: center">MILLS & BOON, LIMITED<br/>
49 RUPERT STREET<br/>
LONDON, W.1</p>
<div class="gapspace"> </div>
<p style="text-align: center"><i>Copyright in the United States
of America</i> by <span class="smcap">The Macmillan
Company</span></p>
<div class="gapspace"> </div>
<p style="text-align: center">To<br/>
CHARMIAN<br/>
<span class="GutSmall">THE MATE OF THE
“SNARK”</span></p>
<p style="text-align: center"><span class="GutSmall">WHO TOOK THE
WHEEL, NIGHT OR DAY,</span><br/>
<span class="GutSmall">WHEN ENTERING</span><br/>
<span class="GutSmall">OR LEAVING PORT OR RUNNING A
PASSAGE,</span><br/>
<span class="GutSmall">WHO TOOK THE WHEEL IN EVERY EMERGENCY,
AND</span><br/>
<span class="GutSmall">WHO WEPT</span><br/>
<span class="GutSmall">AFTER TWO YEARS OF SAILING, WHEN
THE</span><br/>
<span class="GutSmall">VOYAGE WAS DISCONTINUED</span></p>
<h2>Contents</h2>
<table summary="" >
<tr>
<td> <SPAN href="#chap01">CHAPTER I FOREWORD</SPAN></td>
</tr>
<tr>
<td> <SPAN href="#chap02">CHAPTER II THE INCONCEIVABLE AND MONSTROUS</SPAN></td>
</tr>
<tr>
<td> <SPAN href="#chap03">CHAPTER III ADVENTURE</SPAN></td>
</tr>
<tr>
<td> <SPAN href="#chap04">CHAPTER IV FINDING ONE’S WAY ABOUT</SPAN></td>
</tr>
<tr>
<td> <SPAN href="#chap05">CHAPTER V THE FIRST LANDFALL</SPAN></td>
</tr>
<tr>
<td> <SPAN href="#chap06">CHAPTER VI A ROYAL SPORT</SPAN></td>
</tr>
<tr>
<td> <SPAN href="#chap07">CHAPTER VII THE LEPERS OF MOLOKAI</SPAN></td>
</tr>
<tr>
<td> <SPAN href="#chap08">CHAPTER VIII THE HOUSE OF THE SUN</SPAN></td>
</tr>
<tr>
<td> <SPAN href="#chap09">CHAPTER IX A PACIFIC TRAVERSE</SPAN></td>
</tr>
<tr>
<td> <SPAN href="#chap10">CHAPTER X TYPEE</SPAN></td>
</tr>
<tr>
<td> <SPAN href="#chap11">CHAPTER XI THE NATURE MAN</SPAN></td>
</tr>
<tr>
<td> <SPAN href="#chap12">CHAPTER XII THE HIGH SEAT OF ABUNDANCE</SPAN></td>
</tr>
<tr>
<td> <SPAN href="#chap13">CHAPTER XIII THE STONE-FISHING OF BORA BORA</SPAN></td>
</tr>
<tr>
<td> <SPAN href="#chap14">CHAPTER XIV THE AMATEUR NAVIGATOR</SPAN></td>
</tr>
<tr>
<td> <SPAN href="#chap15">CHAPTER XV CRUISING IN THE SOLOMONS</SPAN></td>
</tr>
<tr>
<td> <SPAN href="#chap16">CHAPTER XVI BÊCHE DE MER ENGLISH</SPAN></td>
</tr>
<tr>
<td> <SPAN href="#chap17">CHAPTER XVII THE AMATEUR M.D.</SPAN></td>
</tr>
<tr>
<td> <SPAN href="#chap18">BACKWORD</SPAN></td>
</tr>
<tr>
<td> <SPAN href="#chap19">FOOTNOTES</SPAN></td>
</tr>
</table>
<h2><SPAN name="chap01"></SPAN>CHAPTER I<br/> <span class="GutSmall">FOREWORD</span></h2>
<p><span class="smcap">It</span> began in the swimming pool at
Glen Ellen. Between swims it was our wont to come out and
lie in the sand and let our skins breathe the warm air and soak
in the sunshine. Roscoe was a yachtsman. I had
followed the sea a bit. It was inevitable that we should
talk about boats. We talked about small boats, and the
seaworthiness of small boats. We instanced Captain Slocum
and his three years’ voyage around the world in the
<i>Spray</i>.</p>
<p>We asserted that we were not afraid to go around the world in
a small boat, say forty feet long. We asserted furthermore
that we would like to do it. We asserted finally that there
was nothing in this world we’d like better than a chance to
do it.</p>
<p>“Let us do it,” we said . . . in fun.</p>
<p>Then I asked Charmian privily if she’d really care to do
it, and she said that it was too good to be true.</p>
<p>The next time we breathed our skins in the sand by the
swimming pool I said to Roscoe, “Let us do it.”</p>
<p>I was in earnest, and so was he, for he said:</p>
<p>“When shall we start?”</p>
<p>I had a house to build on the ranch, also an orchard, a
vineyard, and several hedges to plant, and a number of other
things to do. We thought we would start in four or five
years. Then the lure of the adventure began to grip
us. Why not start at once? We’d never be
younger, any of us. Let the orchard, vineyard, and hedges
be growing up while we were away. When we came back, they
would be ready for us, and we could live in the barn while we
built the house.</p>
<p>So the trip was decided upon, and the building of the
<i>Snark</i> began. We named her the <i>Snark</i> because
we could not think of any other name—this information is
given for the benefit of those who otherwise might think there is
something occult in the name.</p>
<p>Our friends cannot understand why we make this voyage.
They shudder, and moan, and raise their hands. No amount of
explanation can make them comprehend that we are moving along the
line of least resistance; that it is easier for us to go down to
the sea in a small ship than to remain on dry land, just as it is
easier for them to remain on dry land than to go down to the sea
in the small ship. This state of mind comes of an undue
prominence of the ego. They cannot get away from
themselves. They cannot come out of themselves long enough
to see that their line of least resistance is not necessarily
everybody else’s line of least resistance. They make
of their own bundle of desires, likes, and dislikes a yardstick
wherewith to measure the desires, likes, and dislikes of all
creatures. This is unfair. I tell them so. But
they cannot get away from their own miserable egos long enough to
hear me. They think I am crazy. In return, I am
sympathetic. It is a state of mind familiar to me. We
are all prone to think there is something wrong with the mental
processes of the man who disagrees with us.</p>
<p>The ultimate word is I <span class="GutSmall">LIKE</span>. It lies beneath philosophy,
and is twined about the heart of life. When philosophy has
maundered ponderously for a month, telling the individual what he
must do, the individual says, in an instant, “I <span class="GutSmall">LIKE</span>,” and does something else, and
philosophy goes glimmering. It is I <span class="GutSmall">LIKE</span> that makes the drunkard drink and
the martyr wear a hair shirt; that makes one man a reveller and
another man an anchorite; that makes one man pursue fame, another
gold, another love, and another God. Philosophy is very
often a man’s way of explaining his own I <span class="GutSmall">LIKE</span>.</p>
<p>But to return to the <i>Snark</i>, and why I, for one, want to
journey in her around the world. The things I like
constitute my set of values. The thing I like most of all
is personal achievement—not achievement for the
world’s applause, but achievement for my own delight.
It is the old “I did it! I did it! With my own
hands I did it!” But personal achievement, with me,
must be concrete. I’d rather win a water-fight in the
swimming pool, or remain astride a horse that is trying to get
out from under me, than write the great American novel.
Each man to his liking. Some other fellow would prefer
writing the great American novel to winning the water-fight or
mastering the horse.</p>
<p>Possibly the proudest achievement of my life, my moment of
highest living, occurred when I was seventeen. I was in a
three-masted schooner off the coast of Japan. We were in a
typhoon. All hands had been on deck most of the
night. I was called from my bunk at seven in the morning to
take the wheel. Not a stitch of canvas was set. We
were running before it under bare poles, yet the schooner fairly
tore along. The seas were all of an eighth of a mile apart,
and the wind snatched the whitecaps from their summits,
filling. The air so thick with driving spray that it was
impossible to see more than two waves at a time. The
schooner was almost unmanageable, rolling her rail under to
starboard and to port, veering and yawing anywhere between
south-east and south-west, and threatening, when the huge seas
lifted under her quarter, to broach to. Had she broached
to, she would ultimately have been reported lost with all hands
and no tidings.</p>
<p>I took the wheel. The sailing-master watched me for a
space. He was afraid of my youth, feared that I lacked the
strength and the nerve. But when he saw me successfully
wrestle the schooner through several bouts, he went below to
breakfast. Fore and aft, all hands were below at
breakfast. Had she broached to, not one of them would ever
have reached the deck. For forty minutes I stood there
alone at the wheel, in my grasp the wildly careering schooner and
the lives of twenty-two men. Once we were pooped. I
saw it coming, and, half-drowned, with tons of water crushing me,
I checked the schooner’s rush to broach to. At the
end of the hour, sweating and played out, I was relieved.
But I had done it! With my own hands I had done my trick at
the wheel and guided a hundred tons of wood and iron through a
few million tons of wind and waves.</p>
<p>My delight was in that I had done it—not in the fact
that twenty-two men knew I had done it. Within the year
over half of them were dead and gone, yet my pride in the thing
performed was not diminished by half. I am willing to
confess, however, that I do like a small audience. But it
must be a very small audience, composed of those who love me and
whom I love. When I then accomplish personal achievement, I
have a feeling that I am justifying their love for me. But
this is quite apart from the delight of the achievement
itself. This delight is peculiarly my own and does not
depend upon witnesses. When I have done some such thing, I
am exalted. I glow all over. I am aware of a pride in
myself that is mine, and mine alone. It is organic.
Every fibre of me is thrilling with it. It is very
natural. It is a mere matter of satisfaction at adjustment
to environment. It is success.</p>
<p>Life that lives is life successful, and success is the breath
of its nostrils. The achievement of a difficult feat is
successful adjustment to a sternly exacting environment.
The more difficult the feat, the greater the satisfaction at its
accomplishment. Thus it is with the man who leaps forward
from the springboard, out over the swimming pool, and with a
backward half-revolution of the body, enters the water head
first. Once he leaves the springboard his environment
becomes immediately savage, and savage the penalty it will exact
should he fail and strike the water flat. Of course, the
man does not have to run the risk of the penalty. He could
remain on the bank in a sweet and placid environment of summer
air, sunshine, and stability. Only he is not made that
way. In that swift mid-air moment he lives as he could
never live on the bank.</p>
<p>As for myself, I’d rather be that man than the fellows
who sit on the bank and watch him. That is why I am
building the <i>Snark</i>. I am so made. I like, that
is all. The trip around the world means big moments of
living. Bear with me a moment and look at it. Here am
I, a little animal called a man—a bit of vitalized matter,
one hundred and sixty-five pounds of meat and blood, nerve,
sinew, bones, and brain,—all of it soft and tender,
susceptible to hurt, fallible, and frail. I strike a light
back-handed blow on the nose of an obstreperous horse, and a bone
in my hand is broken. I put my head under the water for
five minutes, and I am drowned. I fall twenty feet through
the air, and I am smashed. I am a creature of
temperature. A few degrees one way, and my fingers and ears
and toes blacken and drop off. A few degrees the other way,
and my skin blisters and shrivels away from the raw, quivering
flesh. A few additional degrees either way, and the life
and the light in me go out. A drop of poison injected into
my body from a snake, and I cease to move—for ever I cease
to move. A splinter of lead from a rifle enters my head,
and I am wrapped around in the eternal blackness.</p>
<p>Fallible and frail, a bit of pulsating, jelly-like
life—it is all I am. About me are the great natural
forces—colossal menaces, Titans of destruction,
unsentimental monsters that have less concern for me than I have
for the grain of sand I crush under my foot. They have no
concern at all for me. They do not know me. They are
unconscious, unmerciful, and unmoral. They are the cyclones
and tornadoes, lightning flashes and cloud-bursts, tide-rips and
tidal waves, undertows and waterspouts, great whirls and sucks
and eddies, earthquakes and volcanoes, surfs that thunder on
rock-ribbed coasts and seas that leap aboard the largest crafts
that float, crushing humans to pulp or licking them off into the
sea and to death—and these insensate monsters do not know
that tiny sensitive creature, all nerves and weaknesses, whom men
call Jack London, and who himself thinks he is all right and
quite a superior being.</p>
<p>In the maze and chaos of the conflict of these vast and
draughty Titans, it is for me to thread my precarious way.
The bit of life that is I will exult over them. The bit of
life that is I, in so far as it succeeds in baffling them or in
bitting them to its service, will imagine that it is
godlike. It is good to ride the tempest and feel
godlike. I dare to assert that for a finite speck of
pulsating jelly to feel godlike is a far more glorious feeling
than for a god to feel godlike.</p>
<p>Here is the sea, the wind, and the wave. Here are the
seas, the winds, and the waves of all the world. Here is
ferocious environment. And here is difficult adjustment,
the achievement of which is delight to the small quivering vanity
that is I. I like. I am so made. It is my own
particular form of vanity, that is all.</p>
<p>There is also another side to the voyage of the
<i>Snark</i>. Being alive, I want to see, and all the world
is a bigger thing to see than one small town or valley. We
have done little outlining of the voyage. Only one thing is
definite, and that is that our first port of call will be
Honolulu. Beyond a few general ideas, we have no thought of
our next port after Hawaii. We shall make up our minds as
we get nearer, in a general way we know that we shall wander
through the South Seas, take in Samoa, New Zealand, Tasmania,
Australia, New Guinea, Borneo, and Sumatra, and go on up through
the Philippines to Japan. Then will come Korea, China,
India, the Red Sea, and the Mediterranean. After that the
voyage becomes too vague to describe, though we know a number of
things we shall surely do, and we expect to spend from one to
several months in every country in Europe.</p>
<p>The <i>Snark</i> is to be sailed. There will be a
gasolene engine on board, but it will be used only in case of
emergency, such as in bad water among reefs and shoals, where a
sudden calm in a swift current leaves a sailing-boat
helpless. The rig of the <i>Snark</i> is to be what is
called the “ketch.” The ketch rig is a
compromise between the yawl and the schooner. Of late years
the yawl rig has proved the best for cruising. The ketch
retains the cruising virtues of the yawl, and in addition manages
to embrace a few of the sailing virtues of the schooner.
The foregoing must be taken with a pinch of salt. It is all
theory in my head. I’ve never sailed a ketch, nor
even seen one. The theory commends itself to me. Wait
till I get out on the ocean, then I’ll be able to tell more
about the cruising and sailing qualities of the ketch.</p>
<p>As originally planned, the <i>Snark</i> was to be forty feet
long on the water-line. But we discovered there was no
space for a bath-room, and for that reason we have increased her
length to forty-five feet. Her greatest beam is fifteen
feet. She has no house and no hold. There is six feet
of headroom, and the deck is unbroken save for two companionways
and a hatch for’ard. The fact that there is no house
to break the strength of the deck will make us feel safer in case
great seas thunder their tons of water down on board. A
large and roomy cockpit, sunk beneath the deck, with high rail
and self-bailing, will make our rough-weather days and nights
more comfortable.</p>
<p>There will be no crew. Or, rather, Charmian, Roscoe, and
I are the crew. We are going to do the thing with our own
hands. With our own hands we’re going to
circumnavigate the globe. Sail her or sink her, with our
own hands we’ll do it. Of course there will be a cook
and a cabin-boy. Why should we stew over a stove, wash
dishes, and set the table? We could stay on land if we
wanted to do those things. Besides, we’ve got to
stand watch and work the ship. And also, I’ve got to
work at my trade of writing in order to feed us and to get new
sails and tackle and keep the <i>Snark</i> in efficient working
order. And then there’s the ranch; I’ve got to
keep the vineyard, orchard, and hedges growing.</p>
<p>When we increased the length of the <i>Snark</i> in order to
get space for a bath-room, we found that all the space was not
required by the bath-room. Because of this, we increased
the size of the engine. Seventy horse-power our engine is,
and since we expect it to drive us along at a nine-knot clip, we
do not know the name of a river with a current swift enough to
defy us.</p>
<p>We expect to do a lot of inland work. The smallness of
the <i>Snark</i> makes this possible. When we enter the
land, out go the masts and on goes the engine. There are
the canals of China, and the Yang-tse River. We shall spend
months on them if we can get permission from the
government. That will be the one obstacle to our inland
voyaging—governmental permission. But if we can get
that permission, there is scarcely a limit to the inland voyaging
we can do.</p>
<p>When we come to the Nile, why we can go up the Nile. We
can go up the Danube to Vienna, up the Thames to London, and we
can go up the Seine to Paris and moor opposite the Latin Quarter
with a bow-line out to Notre Dame and a stern-line fast to the
Morgue. We can leave the Mediterranean and go up the
Rhône to Lyons, there enter the Saône, cross from the
Saône to the Maine through the Canal de Bourgogne, and from
the Marne enter the Seine and go out the Seine at Havre.
When we cross the Atlantic to the United States, we can go up the
Hudson, pass through the Erie Canal, cross the Great Lakes, leave
Lake Michigan at Chicago, gain the Mississippi by way of the
Illinois River and the connecting canal, and go down the
Mississippi to the Gulf of Mexico. And then there are the
great rivers of South America. We’ll know something
about geography when we get back to California.</p>
<p>People that build houses are often sore perplexed; but if they
enjoy the strain of it, I’ll advise them to build a boat
like the <i>Snark</i>. Just consider, for a moment, the
strain of detail. Take the engine. What is the best
kind of engine—the two cycle? three cycle? four
cycle? My lips are mutilated with all kinds of strange
jargon, my mind is mutilated with still stranger ideas and is
foot-sore and weary from travelling in new and rocky realms of
thought.—Ignition methods; shall it be make-and-break or
jump-spark? Shall dry cells or storage batteries be
used? A storage battery commends itself, but it requires a
dynamo. How powerful a dynamo? And when we have
installed a dynamo and a storage battery, it is simply ridiculous
not to light the boat with electricity. Then comes the
discussion of how many lights and how many candle-power. It
is a splendid idea. But electric lights will demand a more
powerful storage battery, which, in turn, demands a more powerful
dynamo.</p>
<p>And now that we’ve gone in for it, why not have a
searchlight? It would be tremendously useful. But the
searchlight needs so much electricity that when it runs it will
put all the other lights out of commission. Again we travel
the weary road in the quest after more power for storage battery
and dynamo. And then, when it is finally solved, some one
asks, “What if the engine breaks down?” And we
collapse. There are the sidelights, the binnacle light, and
the anchor light. Our very lives depend upon them. So
we have to fit the boat throughout with oil lamps as well.</p>
<p>But we are not done with that engine yet. The engine is
powerful. We are two small men and a small woman. It
will break our hearts and our backs to hoist anchor by
hand. Let the engine do it. And then comes the
problem of how to convey power for’ard from the engine to
the winch. And by the time all this is settled, we
redistribute the allotments of space to the engine-room, galley,
bath-room, state-rooms, and cabin, and begin all over
again. And when we have shifted the engine, I send off a
telegram of gibberish to its makers at New York, something like
this: <i>Toggle-joint abandoned change thrust-bearing accordingly
distance from forward side of flywheel to face of stern post
sixteen feet six inches</i>.</p>
<p>Just potter around in quest of the best steering gear, or try
to decide whether you will set up your rigging with old-fashioned
lanyards or with turnbuckles, if you want strain of detail.
Shall the binnacle be located in front of the wheel in the centre
of the beam, or shall it be located to one side in front of the
wheel?—there’s room right there for a library of
sea-dog controversy. Then there’s the problem of
gasolene, fifteen hundred gallons of it—what are the safest
ways to tank it and pipe it? and which is the best
fire-extinguisher for a gasolene fire? Then there is the
pretty problem of the life-boat and the stowage of the
same. And when that is finished, come the cook and
cabin-boy to confront one with nightmare possibilities. It
is a small boat, and we’ll be packed close together.
The servant-girl problem of landsmen pales to
insignificance. We did select one cabin-boy, and by that
much were our troubles eased. And then the cabin-boy fell
in love and resigned.</p>
<p>And in the meanwhile how is a fellow to find time to study
navigation—when he is divided between these problems and
the earning of the money wherewith to settle the problems?
Neither Roscoe nor I know anything about navigation, and the
summer is gone, and we are about to start, and the problems are
thicker than ever, and the treasury is stuffed with
emptiness. Well, anyway, it takes years to learn
seamanship, and both of us are seamen. If we don’t
find the time, we’ll lay in the books and instruments and
teach ourselves navigation on the ocean between San Francisco and
Hawaii.</p>
<p>There is one unfortunate and perplexing phase of the voyage of
the <i>Snark</i>. Roscoe, who is to be my co-navigator, is
a follower of one, Cyrus R. Teed. Now Cyrus R. Teed has a
different cosmology from the one generally accepted, and Roscoe
shares his views. Wherefore Roscoe believes that the
surface of the earth is concave and that we live on the inside of
a hollow sphere. Thus, though we shall sail on the one
boat, the <i>Snark</i>, Roscoe will journey around the world on
the inside, while I shall journey around on the outside.
But of this, more anon. We threaten to be of the one mind
before the voyage is completed. I am confident that I shall
convert him into making the journey on the outside, while he is
equally confident that before we arrive back in San Francisco I
shall be on the inside of the earth. How he is going to get
me through the crust I don’t know, but Roscoe is ay a
masterful man.</p>
<div class="gapspace"> </div>
<p>P.S.—That engine! While we’ve got it, and
the dynamo, and the storage battery, why not have an
ice-machine? Ice in the tropics! It is more necessary
than bread. Here goes for the ice-machine! Now I am
plunged into chemistry, and my lips hurt, and my mind hurts, and
how am I ever to find the time to study navigation?</p>
<h2><SPAN name="chap02"></SPAN>CHAPTER II<br/> <span class="GutSmall">THE INCONCEIVABLE AND MONSTROUS</span></h2>
<p>“<span class="smcap">Spare</span> no money,” I
said to Roscoe. “Let everything on the <i>Snark</i>
be of the best. And never mind decoration. Plain pine
boards is good enough finishing for me. But put the money
into the construction. Let the <i>Snark</i> be as staunch
and strong as any boat afloat. Never mind what it costs to
make her staunch and strong; you see that she is made staunch and
strong, and I’ll go on writing and earning the money to pay
for it.”</p>
<p>And I did . . . as well as I could; for the <i>Snark</i> ate
up money faster than I could earn it. In fact, every little
while I had to borrow money with which to supplement my
earnings. Now I borrowed one thousand dollars, now I
borrowed two thousand dollars, and now I borrowed five thousand
dollars. And all the time I went on working every day and
sinking the earnings in the venture. I worked Sundays as
well, and I took no holidays. But it was worth it.
Every time I thought of the <i>Snark</i> I knew she was worth
it.</p>
<p>For know, gentle reader, the staunchness of the
<i>Snark</i>. She is forty-five feet long on the
waterline. Her garboard strake is three inches thick; her
planking two and one-half inches thick; her deck-planking two
inches thick and in all her planking there are no butts. I
know, for I ordered that planking especially from Puget
Sound. Then the <i>Snark</i> has four water-tight
compartments, which is to say that her length is broken by three
water-tight bulkheads. Thus, no matter how large a leak the
<i>Snark</i> may spring, Only one compartment can fill with
water. The other three compartments will keep her afloat,
anyway, and, besides, will enable us to mend the leak.
There is another virtue in these bulkheads. The last
compartment of all, in the very stern, contains six tanks that
carry over one thousand gallons of gasolene. Now gasolene
is a very dangerous article to carry in bulk on a small craft far
out on the wide ocean. But when the six tanks that do not
leak are themselves contained in a compartment hermetically
sealed off from the rest of the boat, the danger will be seen to
be very small indeed.</p>
<p>The <i>Snark</i> is a sail-boat. She was built primarily
to sail. But incidentally, as an auxiliary, a
seventy-horse-power engine was installed. This is a good,
strong engine. I ought to know. I paid for it to come
out all the way from New York City. Then, on deck, above
the engine, is a windlass. It is a magnificent
affair. It weighs several hundred pounds and takes up no
end of deck-room. You see, it is ridiculous to hoist up
anchor by hand-power when there is a seventy-horse-power engine
on board. So we installed the windlass, transmitting power
to it from the engine by means of a gear and castings specially
made in a San Francisco foundry.</p>
<p>The <i>Snark</i> was made for comfort, and no expense was
spared in this regard. There is the bath-room, for
instance, small and compact, it is true, but containing all the
conveniences of any bath-room upon land. The bath-room is a
beautiful dream of schemes and devices, pumps, and levers, and
sea-valves. Why, in the course of its building, I used to
lie awake nights thinking about that bath-room. And next to
the bath-room come the life-boat and the launch. They are
carried on deck, and they take up what little space might have
been left us for exercise. But then, they beat life
insurance; and the prudent man, even if he has built as staunch
and strong a craft as the <i>Snark</i>, will see to it that he
has a good life-boat as well. And ours is a good one.
It is a dandy. It was stipulated to cost one hundred and
fifty dollars, and when I came to pay the bill, it turned out to
be three hundred and ninety-five dollars. That shows how
good a life-boat it is.</p>
<p>I could go on at great length relating the various virtues and
excellences of the <i>Snark</i>, but I refrain. I have
bragged enough as it is, and I have bragged to a purpose, as will
be seen before my tale is ended. And please remember its
title, “The Inconceivable and Monstrous.” It
was planned that the <i>Snark</i> should sail on October 1,
1906. That she did not so sail was inconceivable and
monstrous. There was no valid reason for not sailing except
that she was not ready to sail, and there was no conceivable
reason why she was not ready. She was promised on November
first, on November fifteenth, on December first; and yet she was
never ready. On December first Charmian and I left the
sweet, clean Sonoma country and came down to live in the stifling
city—but not for long, oh, no, only for two weeks, for we
would sail on December fifteenth. And I guess we ought to
know, for Roscoe said so, and it was on his advice that we came
to the city to stay two weeks. Alas, the two weeks went by,
four weeks went by, six weeks went by, eight weeks went by, and
we were farther away from sailing than ever. Explain
it? Who?—me? I can’t. It is the one
thing in all my life that I have backed down on. There is
no explaining it; if there were, I’d do it. I, who am
an artisan of speech, confess my inability to explain why the
<i>Snark</i> was not ready. As I have said, and as I must
repeat, it was inconceivable and monstrous.</p>
<p>The eight weeks became sixteen weeks, and then, one day,
Roscoe cheered us up by saying: “If we don’t sail
before April first, you can use my head for a
football.”</p>
<p>Two weeks later he said, “I’m getting my head in
training for that match.”</p>
<p>“Never mind,” Charmian and I said to each other;
“think of the wonderful boat it is going to be when it is
completed.”</p>
<p>Whereat we would rehearse for our mutual encouragement the
manifold virtues and excellences of the <i>Snark</i>. Also,
I would borrow more money, and I would get down closer to my desk
and write harder, and I refused heroically to take a Sunday off
and go out into the hills with my friends. I was building a
boat, and by the eternal it was going to be a boat, and a boat
spelled out all in capitals—B—O—A—T; and
no matter what it cost I didn’t care. So long as it
was a B O A T.</p>
<p>And, oh, there is one other excellence of the <i>Snark</i>,
upon which I must brag, namely, her bow. No sea could ever
come over it. It laughs at the sea, that bow does; it
challenges the sea; it snorts defiance at the sea. And
withal it is a beautiful bow; the lines of it are dreamlike; I
doubt if ever a boat was blessed with a more beautiful and at the
same time a more capable bow. It was made to punch
storms. To touch that bow is to rest one’s hand on
the cosmic nose of things. To look at it is to realize that
expense cut no figure where it was concerned. And every
time our sailing was delayed, or a new expense was tacked on, we
thought of that wonderful bow and were content.</p>
<p>The <i>Snark</i> is a small boat. When I figured seven
thousand dollars as her generous cost, I was both generous and
correct. I have built barns and houses, and I know the
peculiar trait such things have of running past their estimated
cost. This knowledge was mine, was already mine, when I
estimated the probable cost of the building of the <i>Snark</i>
at seven thousand dollars. Well, she cost thirty
thousand. Now don’t ask me, please. It is the
truth. I signed the cheques and I raised the money.
Of course there is no explaining it, inconceivable and monstrous
is what it is, as you will agree, I know, ere my tale is
done.</p>
<p>Then there was the matter of delay. I dealt with
forty-seven different kinds of union men and with one hundred and
fifteen different firms. And not one union man and not one
firm of all the union men and all the firms ever delivered
anything at the time agreed upon, nor ever was on time for
anything except pay-day and bill-collection. Men pledged me
their immortal souls that they would deliver a certain thing on a
certain date; as a rule, after such pledging, they rarely
exceeded being three months late in delivery. And so it
went, and Charmian and I consoled each other by saying what a
splendid boat the <i>Snark</i> was, so staunch and strong; also,
we would get into the small boat and row around the <i>Snark</i>,
and gloat over her unbelievably wonderful bow.</p>
<p>“Think,” I would say to Charmian, “of a gale
off the China coast, and of the <i>Snark</i> hove to, that
splendid bow of hers driving into the storm. Not a drop
will come over that bow. She’ll be as dry as a
feather, and we’ll be all below playing whist while the
gale howls.”</p>
<p>And Charmian would press my hand enthusiastically and exclaim:
“It’s worth every bit of it—the delay, and
expense, and worry, and all the rest. Oh, what a truly
wonderful boat!”</p>
<p>Whenever I looked at the bow of the <i>Snark</i> or thought of
her water-tight compartments, I was encouraged. Nobody
else, however, was encouraged. My friends began to make
bets against the various sailing dates of the <i>Snark</i>.
Mr. Wiget, who was left behind in charge of our Sonoma ranch was
the first to cash his bet. He collected on New Year’s
Day, 1907. After that the bets came fast and furious.
My friends surrounded me like a gang of harpies, making bets
against every sailing date I set. I was rash, and I was
stubborn. I bet, and I bet, and I continued to bet; and I
paid them all. Why, the women-kind of my friends grew so
brave that those among them who never bet before began to bet
with me. And I paid them, too.</p>
<p>“Never mind,” said Charmian to me; “just
think of that bow and of being hove to on the China
Seas.”</p>
<p>“You see,” I said to my friends, when I paid the
latest bunch of wagers, “neither trouble nor cash is being
spared in making the <i>Snark</i> the most seaworthy craft that
ever sailed out through the Golden Gate—that is what causes
all the delay.”</p>
<p>In the meantime editors and publishers with whom I had
contracts pestered me with demands for explanations. But
how could I explain to them, when I was unable to explain to
myself, or when there was nobody, not even Roscoe, to explain to
me? The newspapers began to laugh at me, and to publish
rhymes anent the <i>Snark’s</i> departure with refrains
like, “Not yet, but soon.” And Charmian cheered
me up by reminding me of the bow, and I went to a banker and
borrowed five thousand more. There was one recompense for
the delay, however. A friend of mine, who happens to be a
critic, wrote a roast of me, of all I had done, and of all I ever
was going to do; and he planned to have it published after I was
out on the ocean. I was still on shore when it came out,
and he has been busy explaining ever since.</p>
<p>And the time continued to go by. One thing was becoming
apparent, namely, that it was impossible to finish the
<i>Snark</i> in San Francisco. She had been so long in the
building that she was beginning to break down and wear out.
In fact, she had reached the stage where she was breaking down
faster than she could be repaired. She had become a
joke. Nobody took her seriously; least of all the men who
worked on her. I said we would sail just as she was and
finish building her in Honolulu. Promptly she sprang a leak
that had to be attended to before we could sail. I started
her for the boat-ways. Before she got to them she was
caught between two huge barges and received a vigorous
crushing. We got her on the ways, and, part way along, the
ways spread and dropped her through, stern-first, into the
mud.</p>
<p>It was a pretty tangle, a job for wreckers, not
boat-builders. There are two high tides every twenty-four
hours, and at every high tide, night and day, for a week, there
were two steam tugs pulling and hauling on the
<i>Snark</i>. There she was, stuck, fallen between the ways
and standing on her stern. Next, and while still in that
predicament, we started to use the gears and castings made in the
local foundry whereby power was conveyed from the engine to the
windlass. It was the first time we ever tried to use that
windlass. The castings had flaws; they shattered asunder,
the gears ground together, and the windlass was out of
commission. Following upon that, the seventy-horse-power
engine went out of commission. This engine came from New
York; so did its bed-plate; there was a flaw in the bed-plate;
there were a lot of flaws in the bed-plate; and the
seventy-horse-power engine broke away from its shattered
foundations, reared up in the air, smashed all connections and
fastenings, and fell over on its side. And the <i>Snark</i>
continued to stick between the spread ways, and the two tugs
continued to haul vainly upon her.</p>
<p>“Never mind,” said Charmian, “think of what
a staunch, strong boat she is.”</p>
<p>“Yes,” said I, “and of that beautiful
bow.”</p>
<p>So we took heart and went at it again. The ruined engine
was lashed down on its rotten foundation; the smashed castings
and cogs of the power transmission were taken down and stored
away—all for the purpose of taking them to Honolulu where
repairs and new castings could be made. Somewhere in the
dim past the <i>Snark</i> had received on the outside one coat of
white paint. The intention of the colour was still evident,
however, when one got it in the right light. The
<i>Snark</i> had never received any paint on the inside. On
the contrary, she was coated inches thick with the grease and
tobacco-juice of the multitudinous mechanics who had toiled upon
her. Never mind, we said; the grease and filth could be
planed off, and later, when we fetched Honolulu, the <i>Snark</i>
could be painted at the same time as she was being rebuilt.</p>
<p>By main strength and sweat we dragged the <i>Snark</i> off
from the wrecked ways and laid her alongside the Oakland City
Wharf. The drays brought all the outfit from home, the
books and blankets and personal luggage. Along with this,
everything else came on board in a torrent of
confusion—wood and coal, water and water-tanks, vegetables,
provisions, oil, the life-boat and the launch, all our friends,
all the friends of our friends and those who claimed to be their
friends, to say nothing of some of the friends of the friends of
the friends of our crew. Also there were reporters, and
photographers, and strangers, and cranks, and finally, and over
all, clouds of coal-dust from the wharf.</p>
<p>We were to sail Sunday at eleven, and Saturday afternoon had
arrived. The crowd on the wharf and the coal-dust were
thicker than ever. In one pocket I carried a cheque-book, a
fountain-pen, a dater, and a blotter; in another pocket I carried
between one and two thousand dollars in paper money and
gold. I was ready for the creditors, cash for the small
ones and cheques for the large ones, and was waiting only for
Roscoe to arrive with the balances of the accounts of the hundred
and fifteen firms who had delayed me so many months. And
then—</p>
<p>And then the inconceivable and monstrous happened once
more. Before Roscoe could arrive there arrived another
man. He was a United States marshal. He tacked a
notice on the <i>Snark’s</i> brave mast so that all on the
wharf could read that the <i>Snark</i> had been libelled for
debt. The marshal left a little old man in charge of the
<i>Snark</i>, and himself went away. I had no longer any
control of the <i>Snark</i>, nor of her wonderful bow. The
little old man was now her lord and master, and I learned that I
was paying him three dollars a day for being lord and
master. Also, I learned the name of the man who had
libelled the <i>Snark</i>. It was Sellers; the debt was two
hundred and thirty-two dollars; and the deed was no more than was
to be expected from the possessor of such a name.
Sellers! Ye gods! Sellers!</p>
<p>But who under the sun was Sellers? I looked in my
cheque-book and saw that two weeks before I had made him out a
cheque for five hundred dollars. Other cheque-books showed
me that during the many months of the building of the
<i>Snark</i> I had paid him several thousand dollars. Then
why in the name of common decency hadn’t he tried to
collect his miserable little balance instead of libelling the
<i>Snark</i>? I thrust my hands into my pockets, and in one
pocket encountered the cheque-hook and the dater and the pen, and
in the other pocket the gold money and the paper money.
There was the wherewithal to settle his pitiful account a few
score of times and over—why hadn’t he given me a
chance? There was no explanation; it was merely the
inconceivable and monstrous.</p>
<p>To make the matter worse, the <i>Snark</i> had been libelled
late Saturday afternoon; and though I sent lawyers and agents all
over Oakland and San Francisco, neither United States judge, nor
United States marshal, nor Mr. Sellers, nor Mr. Sellers’
attorney, nor anybody could be found. They were all out of
town for the weekend. And so the <i>Snark</i> did not sail
Sunday morning at eleven. The little old man was still in
charge, and he said no. And Charmian and I walked out on an
opposite wharf and took consolation in the <i>Snark’s</i>
wonderful bow and thought of all the gales and typhoons it would
proudly punch.</p>
<p>“A bourgeois trick,” I said to Charmian, speaking
of Mr. Sellers and his libel; “a petty trader’s
panic. But never mind; our troubles will cease when once we
are away from this and out on the wide ocean.”</p>
<p>And in the end we sailed away, on Tuesday morning, April 23,
1907. We started rather lame, I confess. We had to
hoist anchor by hand, because the power transmission was a
wreck. Also, what remained of our seventy-horse-power
engine was lashed down for ballast on the bottom of the
<i>Snark</i>. But what of such things? They could be
fixed in Honolulu, and in the meantime think of the magnificent
rest of the boat! It is true, the engine in the launch
wouldn’t run, and the life-boat leaked like a sieve; but
then they weren’t the <i>Snark</i>; they were mere
appurtenances. The things that counted were the water-tight
bulkheads, the solid planking without butts, the bath-room
devices—they were the <i>Snark</i>. And then there
was, greatest of all, that noble, wind-punching bow.</p>
<p>We sailed out through the Golden Gate and set our course south
toward that part of the Pacific where we could hope to pick up
with the north-east trades. And right away things began to
happen. I had calculated that youth was the stuff for a
voyage like that of the <i>Snark</i>, and I had taken three
youths—the engineer, the cook, and the cabin-boy. My
calculation was only two-thirds <i>off</i>; I had forgotten to
calculate on seasick youth, and I had two of them, the cook and
the cabin boy. They immediately took to their bunks, and
that was the end of their usefulness for a week to come. It
will be understood, from the foregoing, that we did not have the
hot meals we might have had, nor were things kept clean and
orderly down below. But it did not matter very much anyway,
for we quickly discovered that our box of oranges had at some
time been frozen; that our box of apples was mushy and spoiling;
that the crate of cabbages, spoiled before it was ever delivered
to us, had to go overboard instanter; that kerosene had been
spilled on the carrots, and that the turnips were woody and the
beets rotten, while the kindling was dead wood that
wouldn’t burn, and the coal, delivered in rotten
potato-sacks, had spilled all over the deck and was washing
through the scuppers.</p>
<p>But what did it matter? Such things were mere
accessories. There was the boat—she was all right,
wasn’t she? I strolled along the deck and in one
minute counted fourteen butts in the beautiful planking ordered
specially from Puget Sound in order that there should be no butts
in it. Also, that deck leaked, and it leaked badly.
It drowned Roscoe out of his bunk and ruined the tools in the
engine-room, to say nothing of the provisions it ruined in the
galley. Also, the sides of the <i>Snark</i> leaked, and the
bottom leaked, and we had to pump her every day to keep her
afloat. The floor of the galley is a couple of feet above
the inside bottom of the <i>Snark</i>; and yet I have stood on
the floor of the galley, trying to snatch a cold bite, and been
wet to the knees by the water churning around inside four hours
after the last pumping.</p>
<p>Then those magnificent water-tight compartments that cost so
much time and money—well, they weren’t water-tight
after all. The water moved free as the air from one
compartment to another; furthermore, a strong smell of gasolene
from the after compartment leads me to suspect that some one or
more of the half-dozen tanks there stored have sprung a
leak. The tanks leak, and they are not hermetically sealed
in their compartment. Then there was the bath-room with its
pumps and levers and sea-valves—it went out of commission
inside the first twenty hours. Powerful iron levers broke
off short in one’s hand when one tried to pump with
them. The bath-room was the swiftest wreck of any portion
of the <i>Snark</i>.</p>
<p>And the iron-work on the <i>Snark</i>, no matter what its
source, proved to be mush. For instance, the bed-plate of
the engine came from New York, and it was mush; so were the
casting and gears for the windlass that came from San
Francisco. And finally, there was the wrought iron used in
the rigging, that carried away in all directions when the first
strains were put upon it. Wrought iron, mind you, and it
snapped like macaroni.</p>
<p>A gooseneck on the gaff of the mainsail broke short off.
We replaced it with the gooseneck from the gaff of the storm
trysail, and the second gooseneck broke short off inside fifteen
minutes of use, and, mind you, it had been taken from the gaff of
the storm trysail, upon which we would have depended in time of
storm. At the present moment the <i>Snark</i> trails her
mainsail like a broken wing, the gooseneck being replaced by a
rough lashing. We’ll see if we can get honest iron in
Honolulu.</p>
<p>Man had betrayed us and sent us to sea in a sieve, but the
Lord must have loved us, for we had calm weather in which to
learn that we must pump every day in order to keep afloat, and
that more trust could be placed in a wooden toothpick than in the
most massive piece of iron to be found aboard. As the
staunchness and the strength of the <i>Snark</i> went glimmering,
Charmian and I pinned our faith more and more to the
<i>Snark’s</i> wonderful bow. There was nothing else
left to pin to. It was all inconceivable and monstrous, we
knew, but that bow, at least, was rational. And then, one
evening, we started to heave to.</p>
<p>How shall I describe it? First of all, for the benefit
of the tyro, let me explain that heaving to is that sea
manœuvre which, by means of short and balanced canvas,
compels a vessel to ride bow-on to wind and sea. When the
wind is too strong, or the sea is too high, a vessel of the size
of the <i>Snark</i> can heave to with ease, whereupon there is no
more work to do on deck. Nobody needs to steer. The
lookout is superfluous. All hands can go below and sleep or
play whist.</p>
<p>Well, it was blowing half of a small summer gale, when I told
Roscoe we’d heave to. Night was coming on. I
had been steering nearly all day, and all hands on deck (Roscoe
and Bert and Charmian) were tired, while all hands below were
seasick. It happened that we had already put two reefs in
the big mainsail. The flying-jib and the jib were taken in,
and a reef put in the fore-staysail. The mizzen was also
taken in. About this time the flying jib-boom buried itself
in a sea and broke short off. I started to put the wheel
down in order to heave to. The <i>Snark</i> at the moment
was rolling in the trough. She continued rolling in the
trough. I put the spokes down harder and harder. She
never budged from the trough. (The trough, gentle reader,
is the most dangerous position all in which to lay a
vessel.) I put the wheel hard down, and still the
<i>Snark</i> rolled in the trough. Eight points was the
nearest I could get her to the wind. I had Roscoe and Bert
come in on the main-sheet. The <i>Snark</i> rolled on in
the trough, now putting her rail under on one side and now under
on the other side.</p>
<p>Again the inconceivable and monstrous was showing its grizzly
head. It was grotesque, impossible. I refused to
believe it. Under double-reefed mainsail and single-reefed
staysail the <i>Snark</i> refused to heave to. We flattened
the mainsail down. It did not alter the
<i>Snark’s</i> course a tenth of a degree. We slacked
the mainsail off with no more result. We set a storm
trysail on the mizzen, and took in the mainsail. No
change. The <i>Snark</i> roiled on in the trough.
That beautiful bow of hers refused to come up and face the
wind.</p>
<p>Next we took in the reefed staysail. Thus, the only bit
of canvas left on her was the storm trysail on the mizzen.
If anything would bring her bow up to the wind, that would.
Maybe you won’t believe me when I say it failed, but I do
say it failed. And I say it failed because I saw it fail,
and not because I believe it failed. I don’t believe
it did fail. It is unbelievable, and I am not telling you
what I believe; I am telling you what I saw.</p>
<p>Now, gentle reader, what would you do if you were on a small
boat, rolling in the trough of the sea, a trysail on that small
boat’s stern that was unable to swing the bow up into the
wind? Get out the sea-anchor. It’s just what we
did. We had a patent one, made to order and warranted not
to dive. Imagine a hoop of steel that serves to keep open
the mouth of a large, conical, canvas bag, and you have a
sea-anchor. Well, we made a line fast to the sea-anchor and
to the bow of the <i>Snark</i>, and then dropped the sea-anchor
overboard. It promptly dived. We had a tripping line
on it, so we tripped the sea-anchor and hauled it in. We
attached a big timber as a float, and dropped the sea-anchor over
again. This time it floated. The line to the bow grew
taut. The trysail on the mizzen tended to swing the bow
into the wind, but, in spite of this tendency, the <i>Snark</i>
calmly took that sea-anchor in her teeth, and went on ahead,
dragging it after her, still in the trough of the sea. And
there you are. We even took in the trysail, hoisted the
full mizzen in its place, and hauled the full mizzen down flat,
and the <i>Snark</i> wallowed in the trough and dragged the
sea-anchor behind her. Don’t believe me. I
don’t believe it myself. I am merely telling you what
I saw.</p>
<p>Now I leave it to you. Who ever heard of a sailing-boat
that wouldn’t heave to?—that wouldn’t heave to
with a sea-anchor to help it? Out of my brief experience
with boats I know I never did. And I stood on deck and
looked on the naked face of the inconceivable and
monstrous—the <i>Snark</i> that wouldn’t heave
to. A stormy night with broken moonlight had come on.
There was a splash of wet in the air, and up to windward there
was a promise of rain-squalls; and then there was the trough of
the sea, cold and cruel in the moonlight, in which the
<i>Snark</i> complacently rolled. And then we took in the
sea-anchor and the mizzen, hoisted the reefed staysail, ran the
<i>Snark</i> off before it, and went below—not to the hot
meal that should have awaited us, but to skate across the slush
and slime on the cabin floor, where cook and cabin-boy lay like
dead men in their bunks, and to lie down in our own bunks, with
our clothes on ready for a call, and to listen to the bilge-water
spouting knee-high on the galley floor.</p>
<p>In the Bohemian Club of San Francisco there are some crack
sailors. I know, because I heard them pass judgment on the
<i>Snark</i> during the process of her building. They found
only one vital thing the matter with her, and on this they were
all agreed, namely, that she could not run. She was all
right in every particular, they said, except that I’d never
be able to run her before it in a stiff wind and sea.
“Her lines,” they explained enigmatically, “it
is the fault of her lines. She simply cannot be made to
run, that is all.” Well, I wish I’d only had
those crack sailors of the Bohemian Club on board the
<i>Snark</i> the other night for them to see for themselves their
one, vital, unanimous judgment absolutely reversed.
Run? It is the one thing the <i>Snark</i> does to
perfection. Run? She ran with a sea-anchor fast
for’ard and a full mizzen flattened down aft.
Run? At the present moment, as I write this, we are bowling
along before it, at a six-knot clip, in the north-east
trades. Quite a tidy bit of sea is running. There is
nobody at the wheel, the wheel is not even lashed and is set over
a half-spoke weather helm. To be precise, the wind is
north-east; the <i>Snark’s</i> mizzen is furled, her
mainsail is over to starboard, her head-sheets are hauled flat:
and the <i>Snark’s</i> course is south-south-west.
And yet there are men who have sailed the seas for forty years
and who hold that no boat can run before it without being
steered. They’ll call me a liar when they read this;
it’s what they called Captain Slocum when he said the same
of his <i>Spray</i>.</p>
<p>As regards the future of the <i>Snark</i> I’m all at
sea. I don’t know. If I had the money or the
credit, I’d build another <i>Snark</i> that <i>would</i>
heave to. But I am at the end of my resources.
I’ve got to put up with the present <i>Snark</i> or
quit—and I can’t quit. So I guess I’ll
have to try to get along with heaving the <i>Snark</i> to stern
first. I am waiting for the next gale to see how it will
work. I think it can be done. It all depends on how
her stern takes the seas. And who knows but that some wild
morning on the China Sea, some gray-beard skipper will stare, rub
his incredulous eyes and stare again, at the spectacle of a
weird, small craft very much like the <i>Snark</i>, hove to
stern-first and riding out the gale?</p>
<p>P.S. On my return to California after the voyage, I
learned that the <i>Snark</i> was forty-three feet on the
water-line instead of forty-five. This was due to the fact
that the builder was not on speaking terms with the tape-line or
two-foot rule.</p>
<h2><SPAN name="chap03"></SPAN>CHAPTER III<br/> <span class="GutSmall">ADVENTURE</span></h2>
<p><span class="smcap">No</span>, adventure is not dead, and in
spite of the steam engine and of Thomas Cook & Son.
When the announcement of the contemplated voyage of the
<i>Snark</i> was made, young men of “roving
disposition” proved to be legion, and young women as
well—to say nothing of the elderly men and women who
volunteered for the voyage. Why, among my personal friends
there were at least half a dozen who regretted their recent or
imminent marriages; and there was one marriage I know of that
almost failed to come off because of the <i>Snark</i>.</p>
<div class="gapspace"> </div>
<p>Every mail to me was burdened with the letters of applicants
who were suffocating in the “man-stifled towns,” and
it soon dawned upon me that a twentieth century Ulysses required
a corps of stenographers to clear his correspondence before
setting sail. No, adventure is certainly not dead—not
while one receives letters that begin:</p>
<p>“There is no doubt that when you read this soul-plea
from a female stranger in New York City,” etc.; and wherein
one learns, a little farther on, that this female stranger weighs
only ninety pounds, wants to be cabin-boy, and “yearns to
see the countries of the world.”</p>
<p>The possession of a “passionate fondness for
geography,” was the way one applicant expressed the
wander-lust that was in him; while another wrote, “I am
cursed with an eternal yearning to be always on the move,
consequently this letter to you.” But best of all was
the fellow who said he wanted to come because his feet
itched.</p>
<p>There were a few who wrote anonymously, suggesting names of
friends and giving said friends’ qualifications; but to me
there was a hint of something sinister in such proceedings, and I
went no further in the matter.</p>
<p>With two or three exceptions, all the hundreds that
volunteered for my crew were very much in earnest. Many of
them sent their photographs. Ninety per cent. offered to
work in any capacity, and ninety-nine per cent. offered to work
without salary. “Contemplating your voyage on the
<i>Snark</i>,” said one, “and notwithstanding its
attendant dangers, to accompany you (in any capacity whatever)
would be the climax of my ambitions.” Which reminds
me of the young fellow who was “seventeen years old and
ambicious,” and who, at the end of his letter, earnestly
requested “but please do not let this git into the papers
or magazines.” Quite different was the one who said,
“I would be willing to work like hell and not demand
pay.” Almost all of them wanted me to telegraph, at
their expense, my acceptance of their services; and quite a
number offered to put up a bond to guarantee their appearance on
sailing date.</p>
<p>Some were rather vague in their own minds concerning the work
to be done on the <i>Snark</i>; as, for instance, the one who
wrote: “I am taking the liberty of writing you this note to
find out if there would be any possibility of my going with you
as one of the crew of your boat to make sketches and
illustrations.” Several, unaware of the needful work
on a small craft like the <i>Snark</i>, offered to serve, as one
of them phrased it, “as assistant in filing materials
collected for books and novels.” That’s what
one gets for being prolific.</p>
<p>“Let me give my qualifications for the job,” wrote
one. “I am an orphan living with my uncle, who is a
hot revolutionary socialist and who says a man without the red
blood of adventure is an animated dish-rag.” Said
another: “I can swim some, though I don’t know any of
the new strokes. But what is more important than strokes,
the water is a friend of mine.” “If I was put
alone in a sail-boat, I could get her anywhere I wanted to
go,” was the qualification of a third—and a better
qualification than the one that follows, “I have also
watched the fish-boats unload.” But possibly the
prize should go to this one, who very subtly conveys his deep
knowledge of the world and life by saying: “My age, in
years, is twenty-two.”</p>
<p>Then there were the simple straight-out, homely, and unadorned
letters of young boys, lacking in the felicities of expression,
it is true, but desiring greatly to make the voyage. These
were the hardest of all to decline, and each time I declined one
it seemed as if I had struck Youth a slap in the face. They
were so earnest, these boys, they wanted so much to go.
“I am sixteen but large for my age,” said one; and
another, “Seventeen but large and healthy.”
“I am as strong at least as the average boy of my
size,” said an evident weakling. “Not afraid of
any kind of work,” was what many said, while one in
particular, to lure me no doubt by inexpensiveness, wrote:
“I can pay my way to the Pacific coast, so that part would
probably be acceptable to you.” “Going around
the world is <i>the one thing</i> I want to do,” said one,
and it seemed to be the one thing that a few hundred wanted to
do. “I have no one who cares whether I go or
not,” was the pathetic note sounded by another. One
had sent his photograph, and speaking of it, said,
“I’m a homely-looking sort of a chap, but looks
don’t always count.” And I am confident that
the lad who wrote the following would have turned out all right:
“My age is 19 years, but I am rather small and consequently
won’t take up much room, but I’m tough as the
devil.” And there was one thirteen-year-old applicant
that Charmian and I fell in love with, and it nearly broke our
hearts to refuse him.</p>
<p>But it must not be imagined that most of my volunteers were
boys; on the contrary, boys constituted a very small
proportion. There were men and women from every walk in
life. Physicians, surgeons, and dentists offered in large
numbers to come along, and, like all the professional men,
offered to come without pay, to serve in any capacity, and to
pay, even, for the privilege of so serving.</p>
<p>There was no end of compositors and reporters who wanted to
come, to say nothing of experienced valets, chefs, and
stewards. Civil engineers were keen on the voyage;
“lady” companions galore cropped up for Charmian;
while I was deluged with the applications of would-be private
secretaries. Many high school and university students
yearned for the voyage, and every trade in the working class
developed a few applicants, the machinists, electricians, and
engineers being especially strong on the trip. I was
surprised at the number, who, in musty law offices, heard the
call of adventure; and I was more than surprised by the number of
elderly and retired sea captains who were still thralls to the
sea. Several young fellows, with millions coming to them
later on, were wild for the adventure, as were also several
county superintendents of schools.</p>
<p>Fathers and sons wanted to come, and many men with their
wives, to say nothing of the young woman stenographer who wrote:
“Write immediately if you need me. I shall bring my
typewriter on the first train.” But the best of all
is the following—observe the delicate way in which he
worked in his wife: “I thought I would drop you a line of
inquiry as to the possibility of making the trip with you, am 24
years of age, married and broke, and a trip of that kind would be
just what we are looking for.”</p>
<p>Come to think of it, for the average man it must be fairly
difficult to write an honest letter of self-recommendation.
One of my correspondents was so stumped that he began his letter
with the words, “This is a hard task”; and, after
vainly trying to describe his good points, he wound up with,
“It is a hard job writing about one’s
self.” Nevertheless, there was one who gave himself a
most glowing and lengthy character, and in conclusion stated that
he had greatly enjoyed writing it.</p>
<p>“But suppose this: your cabin-boy could run your engine,
could repair it when out of order. Suppose he could take
his turn at the wheel, could do any carpenter or machinist
work. Suppose he is strong, healthy, and willing to
work. Would you not rather have him than a kid that gets
seasick and can’t do anything but wash dishes?”
It was letters of this sort that I hated to decline. The
writer of it, self-taught in English, had been only two years in
the United States, and, as he said, “I am not wishing to go
with you to earn my living, but I wish to learn and
see.” At the time of writing to me he was a designer
for one of the big motor manufacturing companies; he had been to
sea quite a bit, and had been used all his life to the handling
of small boats.</p>
<p>“I have a good position, but it matters not so with me
as I prefer travelling,” wrote another. “As to
salary, look at me, and if I am worth a dollar or two, all right,
and if I am not, nothing said. As to my honesty and
character, I shall be pleased to show you my employers.
Never drink, no tobacco, but to be honest, I myself, after a
little more experience, want to do a little writing.”</p>
<p>“I can assure you that I am eminently respectable, but
find other respectable people tiresome.” The man who
wrote the foregoing certainly had me guessing, and I am still
wondering whether or not he’d have found me tiresome, or
what the deuce he did mean.</p>
<p>“I have seen better days than what I am passing through
to-day,” wrote an old salt, “but I have seen them a
great deal worse also.”</p>
<p>But the willingness to sacrifice on the part of the man who
wrote the following was so touching that I could not accept:
“I have a father, a mother, brothers and sisters, dear
friends and a lucrative position, and yet I will sacrifice all to
become one of your crew.”</p>
<p>Another volunteer I could never have accepted was the finicky
young fellow who, to show me how necessary it was that I should
give him a chance, pointed out that “to go in the ordinary
boat, be it schooner or steamer, would be impracticable, for I
would have to mix among and live with the ordinary type of
seamen, which as a rule is not a clean sort of life.”</p>
<p>Then there was the young fellow of twenty-six, who had
“run through the gamut of human emotions,” and had
“done everything from cooking to attending Stanford
University,” and who, at the present writing, was “A
vaquero on a fifty-five-thousand-acre range.” Quite
in contrast was the modesty of the one who said, “I am not
aware of possessing any particular qualities that would be likely
to recommend me to your consideration. But should you be
impressed, you might consider it worth a few minutes’ time
to answer. Otherwise, there’s always work at the
trade. Not expecting, but hoping, I remain, etc.”</p>
<p>But I have held my head in both my hands ever since, trying to
figure out the intellectual kinship between myself and the one
who wrote: “Long before I knew of you, I had mixed
political economy and history and deducted therefrom many of your
conclusions in concrete.”</p>
<p>Here, in its way, is one of the best, as it is the briefest,
that I received: “If any of the present company signed on
for cruise happens to get cold feet and you need one more who
understands boating, engines, etc., would like to hear from you,
etc.” Here is another brief one: “Point blank,
would like to have the job of cabin-boy on your trip around the
world, or any other job on board. Am nineteen years old,
weigh one hundred and forty pounds, and am an
American.”</p>
<p>And here is a good one from a man a “little over five
feet long”: “When I read about your manly plan of
sailing around the world in a small boat with Mrs. London, I was
so much rejoiced that I felt I was planning it myself, and I
thought to write you about filling either position of cook or
cabin-boy myself, but for some reason I did not do it, and I came
to Denver from Oakland to join my friend’s business last
month, but everything is worse and unfavourable. But
fortunately you have postponed your departure on account of the
great earthquake, so I finally decided to propose you to let me
fill either of the positions. I am not very strong, being a
man of a little over five feet long, although I am of sound
health and capability.”</p>
<p>“I think I can add to your outfit an additional method
of utilizing the power of the wind,” wrote a well-wisher,
“which, while not interfering with ordinary sails in light
breezes, will enable you to use the whole force of the wind in
its mightiest blows, so that even when its force is so great that
you may have to take in every inch of canvas used in the ordinary
way, you may carry the fullest spread with my method. With
my attachment your craft could not be UPSET.”</p>
<p>The foregoing letter was written in San Francisco under the
date of April 16, 1906. And two days later, on April 18,
came the Great Earthquake. And that’s why I’ve
got it in for that earthquake, for it made a refugee out of the
man who wrote the letter, and prevented us from ever getting
together.</p>
<p>Many of my brother socialists objected to my making the
cruise, of which the following is typical: “The Socialist
Cause and the millions of oppressed victims of Capitalism has a
right and claim upon your life and services. If, however,
you persist, then, when you swallow the last mouthful of salt
chuck you can hold before sinking, remember that we at least
protested.”</p>
<p>One wanderer over the world who “could, if opportunity
afforded, recount many unusual scenes and events,” spent
several pages ardently trying to get to the point of his letter,
and at last achieved the following: “Still I am neglecting
the point I set out to write you about. So will say at once
that it has been stated in print that you and one or two others
are going to take a cruize around the world a little fifty- or
sixty-foot boat. I therefore cannot get myself to think
that a man of your attainments and experience would attempt such
a proceeding, which is nothing less than courting death in that
way. And even if you were to escape for some time, your
whole Person, and those with you would be bruised from the
ceaseless motion of a craft of the above size, even if she were
padded, a thing not usual at sea.” Thank you, kind
friend, thank you for that qualification, “a thing not
usual at sea.” Nor is this friend ignorant of the
sea. As he says of himself, “I am not a land-lubber,
and I have sailed every sea and ocean.” And he winds
up his letter with: “Although not wishing to offend, it
would be madness to take any woman outside the bay even, in such
a craft.”</p>
<p>And yet, at the moment of writing this, Charmian is in her
state-room at the typewriter, Martin is cooking dinner, Tochigi
is setting the table, Roscoe and Bert are caulking the deck, and
the <i>Snark</i> is steering herself some five knots an hour in a
rattling good sea—and the <i>Snark</i> is not padded,
either.</p>
<p>“Seeing a piece in the paper about your intended trip,
would like to know if you would like a good crew, as there is six
of us boys all good sailor men, with good discharges from the
Navy and Merchant Service, all true Americans, all between the
ages of 20 and 22, and at present are employed as riggers at the
Union Iron Works, and would like very much to sail with
you.”—It was letters like this that made me regret
the boat was not larger.</p>
<p>And here writes the one woman in all the world—outside
of Charmian—for the cruise: “If you have not
succeeded in getting a cook I would like very much to take the
trip in that capacity. I am a woman of fifty, healthy and
capable, and can do the work for the small company that compose
the crew of the <i>Snark</i>. I am a very good cook and a
very good sailor and something of a traveller, and the length of
the voyage, if of ten years’ duration, would suit me better
than one. References, etc.”</p>
<p>Some day, when I have made a lot of money, I’m going to
build a big ship, with room in it for a thousand
volunteers. They will have to do all the work of navigating
that boat around the world, or they’ll stay at home.
I believe that they’ll work the boat around the world, for
I know that Adventure is not dead. I know Adventure is not
dead because I have had a long and intimate correspondence with
Adventure.</p>
<h2><SPAN name="chap04"></SPAN>CHAPTER IV<br/> <span class="GutSmall">FINDING ONE’S WAY ABOUT</span></h2>
<p>“<span class="smcap">But</span>,” our friends
objected, “how dare you go to sea without a navigator on
board? You’re not a navigator, are you?”</p>
<p>I had to confess that I was not a navigator, that I had never
looked through a sextant in my life, and that I doubted if I
could tell a sextant from a nautical almanac. And when they
asked if Roscoe was a navigator, I shook my head. Roscoe
resented this. He had glanced at the “Epitome,”
bought for our voyage, knew how to use logarithm tables, had seen
a sextant at some time, and, what of this and of his seafaring
ancestry, he concluded that he did know navigation. But
Roscoe was wrong, I still insist. When a young boy he came
from Maine to California by way of the Isthmus of Panama, and
that was the only time in his life that he was out of sight of
land. He had never gone to a school of navigation, nor
passed an examination in the same; nor had he sailed the deep sea
and learned the art from some other navigator. He was a San
Francisco Bay yachtsman, where land is always only several miles
away and the art of navigation is never employed.</p>
<p>So the <i>Snark</i> started on her long voyage without a
navigator. We beat through the Golden Gate on April 23, and
headed for the Hawaiian Islands, twenty-one hundred sea-miles
away as the gull flies. And the outcome was our
justification. We arrived. And we arrived,
furthermore, without any trouble, as you shall see; that is,
without any trouble to amount to anything. To begin with,
Roscoe tackled the navigating. He had the theory all right,
but it was the first time he had ever applied it, as was
evidenced by the erratic behaviour of the <i>Snark</i>. Not
but what the <i>Snark</i> was perfectly steady on the sea; the
pranks she cut were on the chart. On a day with a light
breeze she would make a jump on the chart that advertised
“a wet sail and a flowing sheet,” and on a day when
she just raced over the ocean, she scarcely changed her position
on the chart. Now when one’s boat has logged six
knots for twenty-four consecutive hours, it is incontestable that
she has covered one hundred and forty-four miles of ocean.
The ocean was all right, and so was the patent log; as for speed,
one saw it with his own eyes. Therefore the thing that was
not all right was the figuring that refused to boost the
<i>Snark</i> along over the chart. Not that this happened
every day, but that it did happen. And it was perfectly
proper and no more than was to be expected from a first attempt
at applying a theory.</p>
<p>The acquisition of the knowledge of navigation has a strange
effect on the minds of men. The average navigator speaks of
navigation with deep respect. To the layman navigation is a
deed and awful mystery, which feeling has been generated in him
by the deep and awful respect for navigation that the layman has
seen displayed by navigators. I have known frank,
ingenuous, and modest young men, open as the day, to learn
navigation and at once betray secretiveness, reserve, and
self-importance as if they had achieved some tremendous
intellectual attainment. The average navigator impresses
the layman as a priest of some holy rite. With bated
breath, the amateur yachtsman navigator invites one in to look at
his chronometer. And so it was that our friends suffered
such apprehension at our sailing without a navigator.</p>
<p>During the building of the <i>Snark</i>, Roscoe and I had an
agreement, something like this: “I’ll furnish the
books and instruments,” I said, “and do you study up
navigation now. I’ll be too busy to do any
studying. Then, when we get to sea, you can teach me what
you have learned.” Roscoe was delighted.
Furthermore, Roscoe was as frank and ingenuous and modest as the
young men I have described. But when we got out to sea and
he began to practise the holy rite, while I looked on admiringly,
a change, subtle and distinctive, marked his bearing. When
he shot the sun at noon, the glow of achievement wrapped him in
lambent flame. When he went below, figured out his
observation, and then returned on deck and announced our latitude
and longitude, there was an authoritative ring in his voice that
was new to all of us. But that was not the worst of
it. He became filled with incommunicable information.
And the more he discovered the reasons for the erratic jumps of
the <i>Snark</i> over the chart, and the less the <i>Snark</i>
jumped, the more incommunicable and holy and awful became his
information. My mild suggestions that it was about time
that I began to learn, met with no hearty response, with no
offers on his part to help me. He displayed not the
slightest intention of living up to our agreement.</p>
<p>Now this was not Roscoe’s fault; he could not help
it. He had merely gone the way of all the men who learned
navigation before him. By an understandable and forgivable
confusion of values, plus a loss of orientation, he felt weighted
by responsibility, and experienced the possession of power that
was like unto that of a god. All his life Roscoe had lived
on land, and therefore in sight of land. Being constantly
in sight of land, with landmarks to guide him, he had managed,
with occasional difficulties, to steer his body around and about
the earth. Now he found himself on the sea,
wide-stretching, bounded only by the eternal circle of the
sky. This circle looked always the same. There were
no landmarks. The sun rose to the east and set to the west
and the stars wheeled through the night. But who may look
at the sun or the stars and say, “My place on the face of
the earth at the present moment is four and three-quarter miles
to the west of Jones’s Cash Store of Smithersville”?
or “I know where I am now, for the Little Dipper informs me
that Boston is three miles away on the second turning to the
right”? And yet that was precisely what Roscoe
did. That he was astounded by the achievement, is putting
it mildly. He stood in reverential awe of himself; he had
performed a miraculous feat. The act of finding himself on
the face of the waters became a rite, and he felt himself a
superior being to the rest of us who knew not this rite and were
dependent on him for being shepherded across the heaving and
limitless waste, the briny highroad that connects the continents
and whereon there are no mile-stones. So, with the sextant
he made obeisance to the sun-god, he consulted ancient tomes and
tables of magic characters, muttered prayers in a strange tongue
that sounded like <i>Indexerrorparallaxrefraction</i>, made
cabalistic signs on paper, added and carried one, and then, on a
piece of holy script called the Grail—I mean the
Chart—he placed his finger on a certain space conspicuous
for its blankness and said, “Here we are.” When
we looked at the blank space and asked, “And where is
that?” he answered in the cipher-code of the higher
priesthood, “31-15-47 north, 133-5-30 west.”
And we said “Oh,” and felt mighty small.</p>
<p>So I aver, it was not Roscoe’s fault. He was like
unto a god, and he carried us in the hollow of his hand across
the blank spaces on the chart. I experienced a great
respect for Roscoe; this respect grew so profound that had he
commanded, “Kneel down and worship me,” I know that I
should have flopped down on the deck and yammered. But, one
day, there came a still small thought to me that said:
“This is not a god; this is Roscoe, a mere man like
myself. What he has done, I can do. Who taught
him? Himself. Go you and do likewise—be your
own teacher.” And right there Roscoe crashed, and he
was high priest of the <i>Snark</i> no longer. I invaded
the sanctuary and demanded the ancient tomes and magic tables,
also the prayer-wheel—the sextant, I mean.</p>
<p>And now, in simple language. I shall describe how I
taught myself navigation. One whole afternoon I sat in the
cockpit, steering with one hand and studying logarithms with the
other. Two afternoons, two hours each, I studied the
general theory of navigation and the particular process of taking
a meridian altitude. Then I took the sextant, worked out
the index error, and shot the sun. The figuring from the
data of this observation was child’s play. In the
“Epitome” and the “Nautical Almanac” were
scores of cunning tables, all worked out by mathematicians and
astronomers. It was like using interest tables and
lightning-calculator tables such as you all know. The
mystery was mystery no longer. I put my finger on the chart
and announced that that was where we were. I was right too,
or at least I was as right as Roscoe, who selected a spot a
quarter of a mile away from mine. Even he was willing to
split the distance with me. I had exploded the mystery, and
yet, such was the miracle of it, I was conscious of new power in
me, and I felt the thrill and tickle of pride. And when
Martin asked me, in the same humble and respectful way I had
previously asked Roscoe, as to where we were, it was with
exaltation and spiritual chest-throwing that I answered in the
cipher-code of the higher priesthood and heard Martin’s
self-abasing and worshipful “Oh.” As for
Charmian, I felt that in a new way I had proved my right to her;
and I was aware of another feeling, namely, that she was a most
fortunate woman to have a man like me.</p>
<p>I couldn’t help it. I tell it as a vindication of
Roscoe and all the other navigators. The poison of power
was working in me. I was not as other men—most other
men; I knew what they did not know,—the mystery of the
heavens, that pointed out the way across the deep. And the
taste of power I had received drove me on. I steered at the
wheel long hours with one hand, and studied mystery with the
other. By the end of the week, teaching myself, I was able
to do divers things. For instance, I shot the North Star,
at night, of course; got its altitude, corrected for index error,
dip, etc., and found our latitude. And this latitude agreed
with the latitude of the previous noon corrected by dead
reckoning up to that moment. Proud? Well, I was even
prouder with my next miracle. I was going to turn in at
nine o’clock. I worked out the problem,
self-instructed, and learned what star of the first magnitude
would be passing the meridian around half-past eight. This
star proved to be Alpha Crucis. I had never heard of the
star before. I looked it up on the star map. It was
one of the stars of the Southern Cross. What! thought I;
have we been sailing with the Southern Cross in the sky of nights
and never known it? Dolts that we are! Gudgeons and
moles! I couldn’t believe it. I went over the
problem again, and verified it. Charmian had the wheel from
eight till ten that evening. I told her to keep her eyes
open and look due south for the Southern Cross. And when
the stars came out, there shone the Southern Cross low on the
horizon. Proud? No medicine man nor high priest was
ever prouder. Furthermore, with the prayer-wheel I shot
Alpha Crucis and from its altitude worked out our latitude.
And still furthermore, I shot the North Star, too, and it agreed
with what had been told me by the Southern Cross.
Proud? Why, the language of the stars was mine, and I
listened and heard them telling me my way over the deep.</p>
<p>Proud? I was a worker of miracles. I forgot how
easily I had taught myself from the printed page. I forgot
that all the work (and a tremendous work, too) had been done by
the masterminds before me, the astronomers and mathematicians,
who had discovered and elaborated the whole science of navigation
and made the tables in the “Epitome.” I
remembered only the everlasting miracle of it—that I had
listened to the voices of the stars and been told my place upon
the highway of the sea. Charmian did not know, Martin did
not know, Tochigi, the cabin-boy, did not know. But I told
them. I was God’s messenger. I stood between
them and infinity. I translated the high celestial speech
into terms of their ordinary understanding. We were
heaven-directed, and it was I who could read the sign-post of the
sky!—I! I!</p>
<p>And now, in a cooler moment, I hasten to blab the whole
simplicity of it, to blab on Roscoe and the other navigators and
the rest of the priesthood, all for fear that I may become even
as they, secretive, immodest, and inflated with
self-esteem. And I want to say this now: any young fellow
with ordinary gray matter, ordinary education, and with the
slightest trace of the student-mind, can get the books, and
charts, and instruments and teach himself navigation. Now I
must not be misunderstood. Seamanship is an entirely
different matter. It is not learned in a day, nor in many
days; it requires years. Also, navigating by dead reckoning
requires long study and practice. But navigating by
observations of the sun, moon, and stars, thanks to the
astronomers and mathematicians, is child’s play. Any
average young fellow can teach himself in a week. And yet
again I must not be misunderstood. I do not mean to say
that at the end of a week a young fellow could take charge of a
fifteen-thousand-ton steamer, driving twenty knots an hour
through the brine, racing from land to land, fair weather and
foul, clear sky or cloudy, steering by degrees on the compass
card and making landfalls with most amazing precision. But
what I do mean is just this: the average young fellow I have
described can get into a staunch sail-boat and put out across the
ocean, without knowing anything about navigation, and at the end
of the week he will know enough to know where he is on the
chart. He will be able to take a meridian observation with
fair accuracy, and from that observation, with ten minutes of
figuring, work out his latitude and longitude. And,
carrying neither freight nor passengers, being under no press to
reach his destination, he can jog comfortably along, and if at
any time he doubts his own navigation and fears an imminent
landfall, he can heave to all night and proceed in the
morning.</p>
<p>Joshua Slocum sailed around the world a few years ago in a
thirty-seven-foot boat all by himself. I shall never
forget, in his narrative of the voyage, where he heartily
indorsed the idea of young men, in similar small boats, making
similar voyage. I promptly indorsed his idea, and so
heartily that I took my wife along. While it certainly
makes a Cook’s tour look like thirty cents, on top of that,
amid on top of the fun and pleasure, it is a splendid education
for a young man—oh, not a mere education in the things of
the world outside, of lands, and peoples, and climates, but an
education in the world inside, an education in one’s self,
a chance to learn one’s own self, to get on speaking terms
with one’s soul. Then there is the training and the
disciplining of it. First, naturally, the young fellow will
learn his limitations; and next, inevitably, he will proceed to
press back those limitations. And he cannot escape
returning from such a voyage a bigger and better man. And
as for sport, it is a king’s sport, taking one’s self
around the world, doing it with one’s own hands, depending
on no one but one’s self, and at the end, back at the
starting-point, contemplating with inner vision the planet
rushing through space, and saying, “I did it; with my own
hands I did it. I went clear around that whirling sphere,
and I can travel alone, without any nurse of a sea-captain to
guide my steps across the seas. I may not fly to other
stars, but of this star I myself am master.”</p>
<p>As I write these lines I lift my eyes and look seaward.
I am on the beach of Waikiki on the island of Oahu. Far, in
the azure sky, the trade-wind clouds drift low over the
blue-green turquoise of the deep sea. Nearer, the sea is
emerald and light olive-green. Then comes the reef, where
the water is all slaty purple flecked with red. Still
nearer are brighter greens and tans, lying in alternate stripes
and showing where sandbeds lie between the living coral
banks. Through and over and out of these wonderful colours
tumbles and thunders a magnificent surf. As I say, I lift
my eyes to all this, and through the white crest of a breaker
suddenly appears a dark figure, erect, a man-fish or a sea-god,
on the very forward face of the crest where the top falls over
and down, driving in toward shore, buried to his loins in smoking
spray, caught up by the sea and flung landward, bodily, a quarter
of a mile. It is a Kanaka on a surf-board. And I know
that when I have finished these lines I shall be out in that riot
of colour and pounding surf, trying to bit those breakers even as
he, and failing as he never failed, but living life as the best
of us may live it. And the picture of that coloured sea and
that flying sea-god Kanaka becomes another reason for the young
man to go west, and farther west, beyond the Baths of Sunset, and
still west till he arrives home again.</p>
<p>But to return. Please do not think that I already know
it all. I know only the rudiments of navigation.
There is a vast deal yet for me to learn. On the
<i>Snark</i> there is a score of fascinating books on navigation
waiting for me. There is the danger-angle of Lecky, there
is the line of Sumner, which, when you know least of all where
you are, shows most conclusively where you are, and where you are
not. There are dozens and dozens of methods of finding
one’s location on the deep, and one can work years before
he masters it all in all its fineness.</p>
<p>Even in the little we did learn there were slips that
accounted for the apparently antic behaviour of the
<i>Snark</i>. On Thursday, May 16, for instance, the trade
wind failed us. During the twenty-four hours that ended
Friday at noon, by dead reckoning we had not sailed twenty
miles. Yet here are our positions, at noon, for the two
days, worked out from our observations:</p>
<table>
<tr>
<td><p>Thursday</p>
</td>
<td><p style="text-align: right">20°</p>
</td>
<td><p style="text-align: right">57′</p>
</td>
<td><p style="text-align: right">9″</p>
</td>
<td><p style="text-align: center">N</p>
</td>
</tr>
<tr>
<td><p> </p>
</td>
<td><p style="text-align: right">152°</p>
</td>
<td><p style="text-align: right">40′</p>
</td>
<td><p style="text-align: right">30″</p>
</td>
<td><p style="text-align: center">W</p>
</td>
</tr>
<tr>
<td><p>Friday</p>
</td>
<td><p style="text-align: right">21°</p>
</td>
<td><p style="text-align: right">15′</p>
</td>
<td><p style="text-align: right">33″</p>
</td>
<td><p style="text-align: center">N</p>
</td>
</tr>
<tr>
<td><p> </p>
</td>
<td><p style="text-align: right">154°</p>
</td>
<td><p style="text-align: right">12′</p>
</td>
<td><p> </p>
</td>
<td><p> </p>
</td>
</tr>
</table>
<p>The difference between the two positions was something like
eighty miles. Yet we knew we had not travelled twenty
miles. Now our figuring was all right. We went over
it several times. What was wrong was the observations we
had taken. To take a correct observation requires practice
and skill, and especially so on a small craft like the
<i>Snark</i>. The violently moving boat and the closeness
of the observer’s eye to the surface of the water are to
blame. A big wave that lifts up a mile off is liable to
steal the horizon away.</p>
<p>But in our particular case there was another perturbing
factor. The sun, in its annual march north through the
heavens, was increasing its declination. On the 19th
parallel of north latitude in the middle of May the sun is nearly
overhead. The angle of arc was between eighty-eight and
eighty-nine degrees. Had it been ninety degrees it would
have been straight overhead. It was on another day that we
learned a few things about taking the altitude of the almost
perpendicular sun. Roscoe started in drawing the sun down
to the eastern horizon, and he stayed by that point of the
compass despite the fact that the sun would pass the meridian to
the south. I, on the other hand, started in to draw the sun
down to south-east and strayed away to the south-west. You
see, we were teaching ourselves. As a result, at
twenty-five minutes past twelve by the ship’s time, I
called twelve o’clock by the sun. Now this signified
that we had changed our location on the face of the world by
twenty-five minutes, which was equal to something like six
degrees of longitude, or three hundred and fifty miles.
This showed the <i>Snark</i> had travelled fifteen knots per hour
for twenty-four consecutive hours—and we had never noticed
it! It was absurd and grotesque. But Roscoe, still
looking east, averred that it was not yet twelve
o’clock. He was bent on giving us a twenty-knot
clip. Then we began to train our sextants rather wildly all
around the horizon, and wherever we looked, there was the sun,
puzzlingly close to the sky-line, sometimes above it and
sometimes below it. In one direction the sun was
proclaiming morning, in another direction it was proclaiming
afternoon. The sun was all right—we knew that;
therefore we were all wrong. And the rest of the afternoon
we spent in the cockpit reading up the matter in the books and
finding out what was wrong. We missed the observation that
day, but we didn’t the next. We had learned.</p>
<p>And we learned well, better than for a while we thought we
had. At the beginning of the second dog-watch one evening,
Charmian and I sat down on the forecastle-head for a rubber of
cribbage. Chancing to glance ahead, I saw cloud-capped
mountains rising from the sea. We were rejoiced at the
sight of land, but I was in despair over our navigation. I
thought we had learned something, yet our position at noon, plus
what we had run since, did not put us within a hundred miles of
land. But there was the land, fading away before our eyes
in the fires of sunset. The land was all right. There
was no disputing it. Therefore our navigation was all
wrong. But it wasn’t. That land we saw was the
summit of Haleakala, the House of the Sun, the greatest extinct
volcano in the world. It towered ten thousand feet above
the sea, and it was all of a hundred miles away. We sailed
all night at a seven-knot clip, and in the morning the House of
the Sun was still before us, and it took a few more hours of
sailing to bring it abreast of us. “That island is
Maui,” we said, verifying by the chart. “That
next island sticking out is Molokai, where the lepers are.
And the island next to that is Oahu. There is Makapuu Head
now. We’ll be in Honolulu to-morrow. Our
navigation is all right.”</p>
<h2><SPAN name="chap05"></SPAN>CHAPTER V<br/> <span class="GutSmall">THE FIRST LANDFALL</span></h2>
<p>“<span class="smcap">It</span> will not be so monotonous
at sea,” I promised my fellow-voyagers on the
<i>Snark</i>. “The sea is filled with life. It
is so populous that every day something new is happening.
Almost as soon as we pass through the Golden Gate and head south
we’ll pick up with the flying fish. We’ll be
having them fried for breakfast. We’ll be catching
bonita and dolphin, and spearing porpoises from the
bowsprit. And then there are the sharks—sharks
without end.”</p>
<p>We passed through the Golden Gate and headed south. We
dropped the mountains of California beneath the horizon, and
daily the surf grew warmer. But there were no flying fish,
no bonita and dolphin. The ocean was bereft of life.
Never had I sailed on so forsaken a sea. Always, before, in
the same latitudes, had I encountered flying fish.</p>
<p>“Never mind,” I said. “Wait till we
get off the coast of Southern California. Then we’ll
pick up the flying fish.”</p>
<p>We came abreast of Southern California, abreast of the
Peninsula of Lower California, abreast of the coast of Mexico;
and there were no flying fish. Nor was there anything
else. No life moved. As the days went by the absence
of life became almost uncanny.</p>
<p>“Never mind,” I said. “When we do pick
up with the flying fish we’ll pick up with everything
else. The flying fish is the staff of life for all the
other breeds. Everything will come in a bunch when we find
the flying fish.”</p>
<p>When I should have headed the <i>Snark</i> south-west for
Hawaii, I still held her south. I was going to find those
flying fish. Finally the time came when, if I wanted to go
to Honolulu, I should have headed the <i>Snark</i> due west,
instead of which I kept her south. Not until latitude
19° did we encounter the first flying fish. He was very
much alone. I saw him. Five other pairs of eager eyes
scanned the sea all day, but never saw another. So sparse
were the flying fish that nearly a week more elapsed before the
last one on board saw his first flying fish. As for the
dolphin, bonita, porpoise, and all the other hordes of
life—there weren’t any.</p>
<p>Not even a shark broke surface with his ominous dorsal
fin. Bert took a dip daily under the bowsprit, hanging on
to the stays and dragging his body through the water. And
daily he canvassed the project of letting go and having a decent
swim. I did my best to dissuade him. But with him I
had lost all standing as an authority on sea life.</p>
<p>“If there are sharks,” he demanded, “why
don’t they show up?”</p>
<p>I assured him that if he really did let go and have a swim the
sharks would promptly appear. This was a bluff on my
part. I didn’t believe it. It lasted as a
deterrent for two days. The third day the wind fell calm,
and it was pretty hot. The <i>Snark</i> was moving a knot
an hour. Bert dropped down under the bowsprit and let
go. And now behold the perversity of things. We had
sailed across two thousand miles and more of ocean and had met
with no sharks. Within five minutes after Bert finished his
swim, the fin of a shark was cutting the surface in circles
around the <i>Snark</i>.</p>
<p>There was something wrong about that shark. It bothered
me. It had no right to be there in that deserted
ocean. The more I thought about it, the more
incomprehensible it became. But two hours later we sighted
land and the mystery was cleared up. He had come to us from
the land, and not from the uninhabited deep. He had
presaged the landfall. He was the messenger of the
land.</p>
<p>Twenty-seven days out from San Francisco we arrived at the
island of Oahu, Territory of Hawaii. In the early morning
we drifted around Diamond Head into full view of Honolulu; and
then the ocean burst suddenly into life. Flying fish
cleaved the air in glittering squadrons. In five minutes we
saw more of them than during the whole voyage. Other fish,
large ones, of various sorts, leaped into the air. There
was life everywhere, on sea and shore. We could see the
masts and funnels of the shipping in the harbour, the hotels and
bathers along the beach at Waikiki, the smoke rising from the
dwelling-houses high up on the volcanic slopes of the Punch Bowl
and Tantalus. The custom-house tug was racing toward us and
a big school of porpoises got under our bow and began cutting the
most ridiculous capers. The port doctor’s launch came
charging out at us, and a big sea turtle broke the surface with
his back and took a look at us. Never was there such a
burgeoning of life. Strange faces were on our decks,
strange voices were speaking, and copies of that very
morning’s newspaper, with cable reports from all the world,
were thrust before our eyes. Incidentally, we read that the
<i>Snark</i> and all hands had been lost at sea, and that she had
been a very unseaworthy craft anyway. And while we read
this information a wireless message was being received by the
congressional party on the summit of Haleakala announcing the
safe arrival of the <i>Snark</i>.</p>
<p>It was the <i>Snark’s</i> first landfall—and such
a landfall! For twenty-seven days we had been on the
deserted deep, and it was pretty hard to realize that there was
so much life in the world. We were made dizzy by it.
We could not take it all in at once. We were like awakened
Rip Van Winkles, and it seemed to us that we were dreaming.
On one side the azure sea lapped across the horizon into the
azure sky; on the other side the sea lifted itself into great
breakers of emerald that fell in a snowy smother upon a white
coral beach. Beyond the beach, green plantations of
sugar-cane undulated gently upward to steeper slopes, which, in
turn, became jagged volcanic crests, drenched with tropic showers
and capped by stupendous masses of trade-wind clouds. At
any rate, it was a most beautiful dream. The <i>Snark</i>
turned and headed directly in toward the emerald surf, till it
lifted and thundered on either hand; and on either hand, scarce a
biscuit-toss away, the reef showed its long teeth, pale green and
menacing.</p>
<p>Abruptly the land itself, in a riot of olive-greens of a
thousand hues, reached out its arms and folded the <i>Snark</i>
in. There was no perilous passage through the reef, no
emerald surf and azure sea—nothing but a warm soft land, a
motionless lagoon, and tiny beaches on which swam dark-skinned
tropic children. The sea had disappeared. The
<i>Snark’s</i> anchor rumbled the chain through the
hawse-pipe, and we lay without movement on a “lineless,
level floor.” It was all so beautiful and strange
that we could not accept it as real. On the chart this
place was called Pearl Harbour, but we called it Dream
Harbour.</p>
<p>A launch came off to us; in it were members of the Hawaiian
Yacht Club, come to greet us and make us welcome, with true
Hawaiian hospitality, to all they had. They were ordinary
men, flesh and blood and all the rest; but they did not tend to
break our dreaming. Our last memories of men were of United
States marshals and of panicky little merchants with rusty
dollars for souls, who, in a reeking atmosphere of soot and
coal-dust, laid grimy hands upon the <i>Snark</i> and held her
back from her world adventure. But these men who came to
meet us were clean men. A healthy tan was on their cheeks,
and their eyes were not dazzled and bespectacled from gazing
overmuch at glittering dollar-heaps. No, they merely
verified the dream. They clinched it with their unsmirched
souls.</p>
<p>So we went ashore with them across a level flashing sea to the
wonderful green land. We landed on a tiny wharf, and the
dream became more insistent; for know that for twenty-seven days
we had been rocking across the ocean on the tiny
<i>Snark</i>. Not once in all those twenty-seven days had
we known a moment’s rest, a moment’s cessation from
movement. This ceaseless movement had become
ingrained. Body and brain we had rocked and rolled so long
that when we climbed out on the tiny wharf kept on rocking and
rolling. This, naturally, we attributed to the wharf.
It was projected psychology. I spraddled along the wharf
and nearly fell into the water. I glanced at Charmian, and
the way she walked made me sad. The wharf had all the
seeming of a ship’s deck. It lifted, tilted, heaved
and sank; and since there were no handrails on it, it kept
Charmian and me busy avoiding falling in. I never saw such
a preposterous little wharf. Whenever I watched it closely,
it refused to roll; but as soon as I took my attention off from
it, away it went, just like the <i>Snark</i>. Once, I
caught it in the act, just as it upended, and I looked down the
length of it for two hundred feet, and for all the world it was
like the deck of a ship ducking into a huge head-sea.</p>
<p>At last, however, supported by our hosts, we negotiated the
wharf and gained the land. But the land was no
better. The very first thing it did was to tilt up on one
side, and far as the eye could see I watched it tilt, clear to
its jagged, volcanic backbone, and I saw the clouds above tilt,
too. This was no stable, firm-founded land, else it would
not cut such capers. It was like all the rest of our
landfall, unreal. It was a dream. At any moment, like
shifting vapour, it might dissolve away. The thought
entered my head that perhaps it was my fault, that my head was
swimming or that something I had eaten had disagreed with
me. But I glanced at Charmian and her sad walk, and even as
I glanced I saw her stagger and bump into the yachtsman by whose
side she walked. I spoke to her, and she complained about
the antic behaviour of the land.</p>
<p>We walked across a spacious, wonderful lawn and down an avenue
of royal palms, and across more wonderful lawn in the gracious
shade of stately trees. The air was filled with the songs
of birds and was heavy with rich warm fragrances—wafture
from great lilies, and blazing blossoms of hibiscus, and other
strange gorgeous tropic flowers. The dream was becoming
almost impossibly beautiful to us who for so long had seen naught
but the restless, salty sea. Charmian reached out her hand
and clung to me—for support against the ineffable beauty of
it, thought I. But no. As I supported her I braced my
legs, while the flowers and lawns reeled and swung around
me. It was like an earthquake, only it quickly passed
without doing any harm. It was fairly difficult to catch
the land playing these tricks. As long as I kept my mind on
it, nothing happened. But as soon as my attention was
distracted, away it went, the whole panorama, swinging and
heaving and tilting at all sorts of angles. Once, however,
I turned my head suddenly and caught that stately line of royal
palms swinging in a great arc across the sky. But it
stopped, just as soon as I caught it, and became a placid dream
again.</p>
<p>Next we came to a house of coolness, with great sweeping
veranda, where lotus-eaters might dwell. Windows and doors
were wide open to the breeze, and the songs and fragrances blew
lazily in and out. The walls were hung with
tapa-cloths. Couches with grass-woven covers invited
everywhere, and there was a grand piano, that played, I was sure,
nothing more exciting than lullabies.
Servants—Japanese maids in native costume—drifted
around and about, noiselessly, like butterflies. Everything
was preternaturally cool. Here was no blazing down of a
tropic sun upon an unshrinking sea. It was too good to be
true. But it was not real. It was a
dream-dwelling. I knew, for I turned suddenly and caught
the grand piano cavorting in a spacious corner of the room.
I did not say anything, for just then we were being received by a
gracious woman, a beautiful Madonna, clad in flowing white and
shod with sandals, who greeted us as though she had known us
always.</p>
<p>We sat at table on the lotus-eating veranda, served by the
butterfly maids, and ate strange foods and partook of a nectar
called poi. But the dream threatened to dissolve. It
shimmered and trembled like an iridescent bubble about to
break. I was just glancing out at the green grass and
stately trees and blossoms of hibiscus, when suddenly I felt the
table move. The table, and the Madonna across from me, and
the veranda of the lotus-eaters, the scarlet hibiscus, the
greensward and the trees—all lifted and tilted before my
eyes, and heaved and sank down into the trough of a monstrous
sea. I gripped my chair convulsively and held on. I
had a feeling that I was holding on to the dream as well as the
chair. I should not have been surprised had the sea rushed
in and drowned all that fairyland and had I found myself at the
wheel of the <i>Snark</i> just looking up casually from the study
of logarithms. But the dream persisted. I looked
covertly at the Madonna and her husband. They evidenced no
perturbation. The dishes had not moved upon the
table. The hibiscus and trees and grass were still
there. Nothing had changed. I partook of more nectar,
and the dream was more real than ever.</p>
<p>“Will you have some iced tea?” asked the Madonna;
and then her side of the table sank down gently and I said yes to
her at an angle of forty-five degrees.</p>
<p>“Speaking of sharks,” said her husband, “up
at Niihau there was a man—” And at that moment
the table lifted and heaved, and I gazed upward at him at an
angle of forty-five degrees.</p>
<p>So the luncheon went on, and I was glad that I did not have to
bear the affliction of watching Charmian walk. Suddenly,
however, a mysterious word of fear broke from the lips of the
lotus-eaters. “Ah, ah,” thought I, “now
the dream goes glimmering.” I clutched the chair
desperately, resolved to drag back to the reality of the
<i>Snark</i> some tangible vestige of this lotus land. I
felt the whole dream lurching and pulling to be gone. Just
then the mysterious word of fear was repeated. It sounded
like <i>Reporters</i>. I looked and saw three of them
coming across the lawn. Oh, blessed reporters! Then
the dream was indisputably real after all. I glanced out
across the shining water and saw the <i>Snark</i> at anchor, and
I remembered that I had sailed in her from San Francisco to
Hawaii, and that this was Pearl Harbour, and that even then I was
acknowledging introductions and saying, in reply to the first
question, “Yes, we had delightful weather all the way
down.”</p>
<h2><SPAN name="chap06"></SPAN>CHAPTER VI<br/> <span class="GutSmall">A ROYAL SPORT</span></h2>
<p><span class="smcap">That</span> is what it is, a royal sport
for the natural kings of earth. The grass grows right down
to the water at Waikiki Beach, and within fifty feet of the
everlasting sea. The trees also grow down to the salty edge
of things, and one sits in their shade and looks seaward at a
majestic surf thundering in on the beach to one’s very
feet. Half a mile out, where is the reef, the white-headed
combers thrust suddenly skyward out of the placid turquoise-blue
and come rolling in to shore. One after another they come,
a mile long, with smoking crests, the white battalions of the
infinite army of the sea. And one sits and listens to the
perpetual roar, and watches the unending procession, and feels
tiny and fragile before this tremendous force expressing itself
in fury and foam and sound. Indeed, one feels
microscopically small, and the thought that one may wrestle with
this sea raises in one’s imagination a thrill of
apprehension, almost of fear. Why, they are a mile long,
these bull-mouthed monsters, and they weigh a thousand tons, and
they charge in to shore faster than a man can run. What
chance? No chance at all, is the verdict of the shrinking
ego; and one sits, and looks, and listens, and thinks the grass
and the shade are a pretty good place in which to be.</p>
<p>And suddenly, out there where a big smoker lifts skyward,
rising like a sea-god from out of the welter of spume and
churning white, on the giddy, toppling, overhanging and
downfalling, precarious crest appears the dark head of a
man. Swiftly he rises through the rushing white. His
black shoulders, his chest, his loins, his limbs—all is
abruptly projected on one’s vision. Where but the
moment before was only the wide desolation and invincible roar,
is now a man, erect, full-statured, not struggling frantically in
that wild movement, not buried and crushed and buffeted by those
mighty monsters, but standing above them all, calm and superb,
poised on the giddy summit, his feet buried in the churning foam,
the salt smoke rising to his knees, and all the rest of him in
the free air and flashing sunlight, and he is flying through the
air, flying forward, flying fast as the surge on which he
stands. He is a Mercury—a brown Mercury. His
heels are winged, and in them is the swiftness of the sea.
In truth, from out of the sea he has leaped upon the back of the
sea, and he is riding the sea that roars and bellows and cannot
shake him from its back. But no frantic outreaching and
balancing is his. He is impassive, motionless as a statue
carved suddenly by some miracle out of the sea’s depth from
which he rose. And straight on toward shore he flies on his
winged heels and the white crest of the breaker. There is a
wild burst of foam, a long tumultuous rushing sound as the
breaker falls futile and spent on the beach at your feet; and
there, at your feet steps calmly ashore a Kanaka, burnt, golden
and brown by the tropic sun. Several minutes ago he was a
speck a quarter of a mile away. He has “bitted the
bull-mouthed breaker” and ridden it in, and the pride in
the feat shows in the carriage of his magnificent body as he
glances for a moment carelessly at you who sit in the shade of
the shore. He is a Kanaka—and more, he is a man, a
member of the kingly species that has mastered matter and the
brutes and lorded it over creation.</p>
<p>And one sits and thinks of Tristram’s last wrestle with
the sea on that fatal morning; and one thinks further, to the
fact that that Kanaka has done what Tristram never did, and that
he knows a joy of the sea that Tristram never knew. And
still further one thinks. It is all very well, sitting here
in cool shade of the beach, but you are a man, one of the kingly
species, and what that Kanaka can do, you can do yourself.
Go to. Strip off your clothes that are a nuisance in this
mellow clime. Get in and wrestle with the sea; wing your
heels with the skill and power that reside in you; bit the
sea’s breakers, master them, and ride upon their backs as a
king should.</p>
<p>And that is how it came about that I tackled
surf-riding. And now that I have tackled it, more than ever
do I hold it to be a royal sport. But first let me explain
the physics of it. A wave is a communicated
agitation. The water that composes the body of a wave does
not move. If it did, when a stone is thrown into a pond and
the ripples spread away in an ever widening circle, there would
appear at the centre an ever increasing hole. No, the water
that composes the body of a wave is stationary. Thus, you
may watch a particular portion of the ocean’s surface and
you will see the same water rise and fall a thousand times to the
agitation communicated by a thousand successive waves. Now
imagine this communicated agitation moving shoreward. As
the bottom shoals, the lower portion of the wave strikes land
first and is stopped. But water is fluid, and the upper
portion has not struck anything, wherefore it keeps on
communicating its agitation, keeps on going. And when the
top of the wave keeps on going, while the bottom of it lags
behind, something is bound to happen. The bottom of the
wave drops out from under and the top of the wave falls over,
forward, and down, curling and cresting and roaring as it does
so. It is the bottom of a wave striking against the top of
the land that is the cause of all surfs.</p>
<p>But the transformation from a smooth undulation to a breaker
is not abrupt except where the bottom shoals abruptly. Say
the bottom shoals gradually for from quarter of a mile to a mile,
then an equal distance will be occupied by the
transformation. Such a bottom is that off the beach of
Waikiki, and it produces a splendid surf-riding surf. One
leaps upon the back of a breaker just as it begins to break, and
stays on it as it continues to break all the way in to shore.</p>
<p>And now to the particular physics of surf-riding. Get
out on a flat board, six feet long, two feet wide, and roughly
oval in shape. Lie down upon it like a small boy on a
coaster and paddle with your hands out to deep water, where the
waves begin to crest. Lie out there quietly on the
board. Sea after sea breaks before, behind, and under and
over you, and rushes in to shore, leaving you behind. When
a wave crests, it gets steeper. Imagine yourself, on your
hoard, on the face of that steep slope. If it stood still,
you would slide down just as a boy slides down a hill on his
coaster. “But,” you object, “the wave
doesn’t stand still.” Very true, but the water
composing the wave stands still, and there you have the
secret. If ever you start sliding down the face of that
wave, you’ll keep on sliding and you’ll never reach
the bottom. Please don’t laugh. The face of
that wave may be only six feet, yet you can slide down it a
quarter of a mile, or half a mile, and not reach the
bottom. For, see, since a wave is only a communicated
agitation or impetus, and since the water that composes a wave is
changing every instant, new water is rising into the wave as fast
as the wave travels. You slide down this new water, and yet
remain in your old position on the wave, sliding down the still
newer water that is rising and forming the wave. You slide
precisely as fast as the wave travels. If it travels
fifteen miles an hour, you slide fifteen miles an hour.
Between you and shore stretches a quarter of mile of water.
As the wave travels, this water obligingly heaps itself into the
wave, gravity does the rest, and down you go, sliding the whole
length of it. If you still cherish the notion, while
sliding, that the water is moving with you, thrust your arms into
it and attempt to paddle; you will find that you have to be
remarkably quick to get a stroke, for that water is dropping
astern just as fast as you are rushing ahead.</p>
<p>And now for another phase of the physics of surf-riding.
All rules have their exceptions. It is true that the water
in a wave does not travel forward. But there is what may be
called the send of the sea. The water in the overtoppling
crest does move forward, as you will speedily realize if you are
slapped in the face by it, or if you are caught under it and are
pounded by one mighty blow down under the surface panting and
gasping for half a minute. The water in the top of a wave
rests upon the water in the bottom of the wave. But when
the bottom of the wave strikes the land, it stops, while the top
goes on. It no longer has the bottom of the wave to hold it
up. Where was solid water beneath it, is now air, and for
the first time it feels the grip of gravity, and down it falls,
at the same time being torn asunder from the lagging bottom of
the wave and flung forward. And it is because of this that
riding a surf-board is something more than a mere placid sliding
down a hill. In truth, one is caught up and hurled
shoreward as by some Titan’s hand.</p>
<p>I deserted the cool shade, put on a swimming suit, and got
hold of a surf-board. It was too small a board. But I
didn’t know, and nobody told me. I joined some little
Kanaka boys in shallow water, where the breakers were well spent
and small—a regular kindergarten school. I watched
the little Kanaka boys. When a likely-looking breaker came
along, they flopped upon their stomachs on their boards, kicked
like mad with their feet, and rode the breaker in to the
beach. I tried to emulate them. I watched them, tried
to do everything that they did, and failed utterly. The
breaker swept past, and I was not on it. I tried again and
again. I kicked twice as madly as they did, and
failed. Half a dozen would be around. We would all
leap on our boards in front of a good breaker. Away our
feet would churn like the stern-wheels of river steamboats, and
away the little rascals would scoot while I remained in disgrace
behind.</p>
<p>I tried for a solid hour, and not one wave could I persuade to
boost me shoreward. And then arrived a friend, Alexander
Hume Ford, a globe trotter by profession, bent ever on the
pursuit of sensation. And he had found it at Waikiki.
Heading for Australia, he had stopped off for a week to find out
if there were any thrills in surf-riding, and he had become
wedded to it. He had been at it every day for a month and
could not yet see any symptoms of the fascination lessening on
him. He spoke with authority.</p>
<p>“Get off that board,” he said. “Chuck
it away at once. Look at the way you’re trying to
ride it. If ever the nose of that board hits bottom,
you’ll be disembowelled. Here, take my board.
It’s a man’s size.”</p>
<p>I am always humble when confronted by knowledge. Ford
knew. He showed me how properly to mount his board.
Then he waited for a good breaker, gave me a shove at the right
moment, and started me in. Ah, delicious moment when I felt
that breaker grip and fling me.</p>
<p>On I dashed, a hundred and fifty feet, and subsided with the
breaker on the sand. From that moment I was lost. I
waded back to Ford with his board. It was a large one,
several inches thick, and weighed all of seventy-five
pounds. He gave me advice, much of it. He had had no
one to teach him, and all that he had laboriously learned in
several weeks he communicated to me in half an hour. I
really learned by proxy. And inside of half an hour I was
able to start myself and ride in. I did it time after time,
and Ford applauded and advised. For instance, he told me to
get just so far forward on the board and no farther. But I
must have got some farther, for as I came charging in to land,
that miserable board poked its nose down to bottom, stopped
abruptly, and turned a somersault, at the same time violently
severing our relations. I was tossed through the air like a
chip and buried ignominiously under the downfalling
breaker. And I realized that if it hadn’t been for
Ford, I’d have been disembowelled. That particular
risk is part of the sport, Ford says. Maybe he’ll
have it happen to him before he leaves Waikiki, and then, I feel
confident, his yearning for sensation will be satisfied for a
time.</p>
<p>When all is said and done, it is my steadfast belief that
homicide is worse than suicide, especially if, in the former
case, it is a woman. Ford saved me from being a
homicide. “Imagine your legs are a rudder,” he
said. “Hold them close together, and steer with
them.” A few minutes later I came charging in on a
comber. As I neared the beach, there, in the water, up to
her waist, dead in front of me, appeared a woman. How was I
to stop that comber on whose back I was? It looked like a
dead woman. The board weighed seventy-five pounds, I
weighed a hundred and sixty-five. The added weight had a
velocity of fifteen miles per hour. The board and I
constituted a projectile. I leave it to the physicists to
figure out the force of the impact upon that poor, tender
woman. And then I remembered my guardian angel, Ford.
“Steer with your legs!” rang through my brain.
I steered with my legs, I steered sharply, abruptly, with all my
legs and with all my might. The board sheered around
broadside on the crest. Many things happened
simultaneously. The wave gave me a passing buffet, a light
tap as the taps of waves go, but a tap sufficient to knock me off
the board and smash me down through the rushing water to bottom,
with which I came in violent collision and upon which I was
rolled over and over. I got my head out for a breath of air
and then gained my feet. There stood the woman before
me. I felt like a hero. I had saved her life.
And she laughed at me. It was not hysteria. She had
never dreamed of her danger. Anyway, I solaced myself, it
was not I but Ford that saved her, and I didn’t have to
feel like a hero. And besides, that leg-steering was
great. In a few minutes more of practice I was able to
thread my way in and out past several bathers and to remain on
top my breaker instead of going under it.</p>
<p>“To-morrow,” Ford said, “I am going to take
you out into the blue water.”</p>
<p>I looked seaward where he pointed, and saw the great smoking
combers that made the breakers I had been riding look like
ripples. I don’t know what I might have said had I
not recollected just then that I was one of a kingly
species. So all that I did say was, “All right,
I’ll tackle them to-morrow.”</p>
<p>The water that rolls in on Waikiki Beach is just the same as
the water that laves the shores of all the Hawaiian Islands; and
in ways, especially from the swimmer’s standpoint, it is
wonderful water. It is cool enough to be comfortable, while
it is warm enough to permit a swimmer to stay in all day without
experiencing a chill. Under the sun or the stars, at high
noon or at midnight, in midwinter or in midsummer, it does not
matter when, it is always the same temperature—not too
warm, not too cold, just right. It is wonderful water, salt
as old ocean itself, pure and crystal-clear. When the
nature of the water is considered, it is not so remarkable after
all that the Kanakas are one of the most expert of swimming
races.</p>
<p>So it was, next morning, when Ford came along, that I plunged
into the wonderful water for a swim of indeterminate
length. Astride of our surf-boards, or, rather, flat down
upon them on our stomachs, we paddled out through the
kindergarten where the little Kanaka boys were at play.
Soon we were out in deep water where the big smokers came roaring
in. The mere struggle with them, facing them and paddling
seaward over them and through them, was sport enough in
itself. One had to have his wits about him, for it was a
battle in which mighty blows were struck, on one side, and in
which cunning was used on the other side—a struggle between
insensate force and intelligence. I soon learned a
bit. When a breaker curled over my head, for a swift
instant I could see the light of day through its emerald body;
then down would go my head, and I would clutch the board with all
my strength. Then would come the blow, and to the onlooker
on shore I would be blotted out. In reality the board and I
have passed through the crest and emerged in the respite of the
other side. I should not recommend those smashing blows to
an invalid or delicate person. There is weight behind them,
and the impact of the driven water is like a sandblast.
Sometimes one passes through half a dozen combers in quick
succession, and it is just about that time that he is liable to
discover new merits in the stable land and new reasons for being
on shore.</p>
<p>Out there in the midst of such a succession of big smoky ones,
a third man was added to our party, one Freeth. Shaking the
water from my eyes as I emerged from one wave and peered ahead to
see what the next one looked like, I saw him tearing in on the
back of it, standing upright on his board, carelessly poised, a
young god bronzed with sunburn. We went through the wave on
the back of which he rode. Ford called to him. He
turned an airspring from his wave, rescued his board from its
maw, paddled over to us and joined Ford in showing me
things. One thing in particular I learned from Freeth,
namely, how to encounter the occasional breaker of exceptional
size that rolled in. Such breakers were really ferocious,
and it was unsafe to meet them on top of the board. But
Freeth showed me, so that whenever I saw one of that calibre
rolling down on me, I slid off the rear end of the board and
dropped down beneath the surface, my arms over my head and
holding the board. Thus, if the wave ripped the board out
of my hands and tried to strike me with it (a common trick of
such waves), there would be a cushion of water a foot or more in
depth, between my head and the blow. When the wave passed,
I climbed upon the board and paddled on. Many men have been
terribly injured, I learn, by being struck by their boards.</p>
<p>The whole method of surf-riding and surf-fighting, learned, is
one of non-resistance. Dodge the blow that is struck at
you. Dive through the wave that is trying to slap you in
the face. Sink down, feet first, deep under the surface,
and let the big smoker that is trying to smash you go by far
overhead. Never be rigid. Relax. Yield yourself
to the waters that are ripping and tearing at you. When the
undertow catches you and drags you seaward along the bottom,
don’t struggle against it. If you do, you are liable
to be drowned, for it is stronger than you. Yield yourself
to that undertow. Swim with it, not against it, and you
will find the pressure removed. And, swimming with it,
fooling it so that it does not hold you, swim upward at the same
time. It will be no trouble at all to reach the
surface.</p>
<p>The man who wants to learn surf-riding must be a strong
swimmer, and he must be used to going under the water.
After that, fair strength and common-sense are all that is
required. The force of the big comber is rather
unexpected. There are mix-ups in which board and rider are
torn apart and separated by several hundred feet. The
surf-rider must take care of himself. No matter how many
riders swim out with him, he cannot depend upon any of them for
aid. The fancied security I had in the presence of Ford and
Freeth made me forget that it was my first swim out in deep water
among the big ones. I recollected, however, and rather
suddenly, for a big wave came in, and away went the two men on
its back all the way to shore. I could have been drowned a
dozen different ways before they got back to me.</p>
<p>One slides down the face of a breaker on his surf-board, but
he has to get started to sliding. Board and rider must be
moving shoreward at a good rate before the wave overtakes
them. When you see the wave coming that you want to ride
in, you turn tail to it and paddle shoreward with all your
strength, using what is called the windmill stroke. This is
a sort of spurt performed immediately in front of the wave.
If the board is going fast enough, the wave accelerates it, and
the board begins its quarter-of-a-mile slide.</p>
<p>I shall never forget the first big wave I caught out there in
the deep water. I saw it coming, turned my back on it and
paddled for dear life. Faster and faster my board went,
till it seemed my arms would drop off. What was happening
behind me I could not tell. One cannot look behind and
paddle the windmill stroke. I heard the crest of the wave
hissing and churning, and then my board was lifted and flung
forward. I scarcely knew what happened the first
half-minute. Though I kept my eyes open, I could not see
anything, for I was buried in the rushing white of the
crest. But I did not mind. I was chiefly conscious of
ecstatic bliss at having caught the wave. At the end of
the half-minute, however, I began to see things, and to
breathe. I saw that three feet of the nose of my board was
clear out of water and riding on the air. I shifted my
weight forward, and made the nose come down. Then I lay,
quite at rest in the midst of the wild movement, and watched the
shore and the bathers on the beach grow distinct. I
didn’t cover quite a quarter of a mile on that wave,
because, to prevent the board from diving, I shifted my weight
back, but shifted it too far and fell down the rear slope of the
wave.</p>
<p>It was my second day at surf-riding, and I was quite proud of
myself. I stayed out there four hours, and when it was
over, I was resolved that on the morrow I’d come in
standing up. But that resolution paved a distant
place. On the morrow I was in bed. I was not sick,
but I was very unhappy, and I was in bed. When describing
the wonderful water of Hawaii I forgot to describe the wonderful
sun of Hawaii. It is a tropic sun, and, furthermore, in the
first part of June, it is an overhead sun. It is also an
insidious, deceitful sun. For the first time in my life I
was sunburned unawares. My arms, shoulders, and back had
been burned many times in the past and were tough; but not so my
legs. And for four hours I had exposed the tender backs of
my legs, at right-angles, to that perpendicular Hawaiian
sun. It was not until after I got ashore that I discovered
the sun had touched me. Sunburn at first is merely warm;
after that it grows intense and the blisters come out.
Also, the joints, where the skin wrinkles, refuse to bend.
That is why I spent the next day in bed. I couldn’t
walk. And that is why, to-day, I am writing this in
bed. It is easier to than not to. But to-morrow, ah,
to-morrow, I shall be out in that wonderful water, and I shall
come in standing up, even as Ford and Freeth. And if I fail
to-morrow, I shall do it the next day, or the next. Upon
one thing I am resolved: the <i>Snark</i> shall not sail from
Honolulu until I, too, wing my heels with the swiftness of the
sea, and become a sun-burned, skin-peeling Mercury.</p>
<h2><SPAN name="chap07"></SPAN>CHAPTER VII<br/> <span class="GutSmall">THE LEPERS OF MOLOKAI</span></h2>
<p><span class="smcap">When</span> the <i>Snark</i> sailed along
the windward coast of Molokai, on her way to Honolulu, I looked
at the chart, then pointed to a low-lying peninsula backed by a
tremendous cliff varying from two to four thousand feet in
height, and said: “The pit of hell, the most cursed place
on earth.” I should have been shocked, if, at that
moment, I could have caught a vision of myself a month later,
ashore in the most cursed place on earth and having a
disgracefully good time along with eight hundred of the lepers
who were likewise having a good time. Their good time was
not disgraceful; but mine was, for in the midst of so much misery
it was not meet for me to have a good time. That is the way
I felt about it, and my only excuse is that I couldn’t help
having a good time.</p>
<p>For instance, in the afternoon of the Fourth of July all the
lepers gathered at the race-track for the sports. I had
wandered away from the Superintendent and the physicians in order
to get a snapshot of the finish of one of the races. It was
an interesting race, and partisanship ran high. Three
horses were entered, one ridden by a Chinese, one by an Hawaiian,
and one by a Portuguese boy. All three riders were lepers;
so were the judges and the crowd. The race was twice around
the track. The Chinese and the Hawaiian got away together
and rode neck and neck, the Portuguese boy toiling along two
hundred feet behind. Around they went in the same
positions. Halfway around on the second and final lap the
Chinese pulled away and got one length ahead of the
Hawaiian. At the same time the Portuguese boy was beginning
to crawl up. But it looked hopeless. The crowd went
wild. All the lepers were passionate lovers of
horseflesh. The Portuguese boy crawled nearer and
nearer. I went wild, too. They were on the home
stretch. The Portuguese boy passed the Hawaiian.
There was a thunder of hoofs, a rush of the three horses bunched
together, the jockeys plying their whips, and every last onlooker
bursting his throat, or hers, with shouts and yells.
Nearer, nearer, inch by inch, the Portuguese boy crept up, and
passed, yes, passed, winning by a head from the Chinese. I
came to myself in a group of lepers. They were yelling,
tossing their hats, and dancing around like fiends. So was
I. When I came to I was waving my hat and murmuring
ecstatically: “By golly, the boy wins! The boy
wins!”</p>
<p>I tried to check myself. I assured myself that I was
witnessing one of the horrors of Molokai, and that it was
shameful for me, under such circumstances, to be so light-hearted
and light-headed. But it was no use. The next event
was a donkey-race, and it was just starting; so was the
fun. The last donkey in was to win the race, and what
complicated the affair was that no rider rode his own
donkey. They rode one another’s donkeys, the result
of which was that each man strove to make the donkey he rode beat
his own donkey ridden by some one else, Naturally, only men
possessing very slow or extremely obstreperous donkeys had
entered them for the race. One donkey had been trained to
tuck in its legs and lie down whenever its rider touched its
sides with his heels. Some donkeys strove to turn around
and come back; others developed a penchant for the side of the
track, where they stuck their heads over the railing and stopped;
while all of them dawdled. Halfway around the track one
donkey got into an argument with its rider. When all the
rest of the donkeys had crossed the wire, that particular donkey
was still arguing. He won the race, though his rider lost
it and came in on foot. And all the while nearly a thousand
lepers were laughing uproariously at the fun. Anybody in my
place would have joined with them in having a good time.</p>
<p>All the foregoing is by way of preamble to the statement that
the horrors of Molokai, as they have been painted in the past, do
not exist. The Settlement has been written up repeatedly by
sensationalists, and usually by sensationalists who have never
laid eyes on it. Of course, leprosy is leprosy, and it is a
terrible thing; but so much that is lurid has been written about
Molokai that neither the lepers, nor those who devote their lives
to them, have received a fair deal. Here is a case in
point. A newspaper writer, who, of course, had never been
near the Settlement, vividly described Superintendent McVeigh,
crouching in a grass hut and being besieged nightly by starving
lepers on their knees, wailing for food. This hair-raising
account was copied by the press all over the United States and
was the cause of many indignant and protesting editorials.
Well, I lived and slept for five days in Mr. McVeigh’s
“grass hut” (which was a comfortable wooden cottage,
by the way; and there isn’t a grass house in the whole
Settlement), and I heard the lepers wailing for food—only
the wailing was peculiarly harmonious and rhythmic, and it was
accompanied by the music of stringed instruments, violins,
guitars, <i>ukuleles</i>, and banjos. Also, the wailing was
of various sorts. The leper brass band wailed, and two
singing societies wailed, and lastly a quintet of excellent
voices wailed. So much for a lie that should never have
been printed. The wailing was the serenade which the glee
clubs always give Mr. McVeigh when he returns from a trip to
Honolulu.</p>
<p>Leprosy is not so contagious as is imagined. I went for
a week’s visit to the Settlement, and I took my wife
along—all of which would not have happened had we had any
apprehension of contracting the disease. Nor did we wear
long, gauntleted gloves and keep apart from the lepers. On
the contrary, we mingled freely with them, and before we left,
knew scores of them by sight and name. The precautions of
simple cleanliness seem to be all that is necessary. On
returning to their own houses, after having been among and
handling lepers, the non-lepers, such as the physicians and the
superintendent, merely wash their faces and hands with mildly
antiseptic soap and change their coats.</p>
<p>That a leper is unclean, however, should be insisted upon; and
the segregation of lepers, from what little is known of the
disease, should be rigidly maintained. On the other hand,
the awful horror with which the leper has been regarded in the
past, and the frightful treatment he has received, have been
unnecessary and cruel. In order to dispel some of the
popular misapprehensions of leprosy, I want to tell something of
the relations between the lepers and non-lepers as I observed
them at Molokai. On the morning after our arrival Charmian
and I attended a shoot of the Kalaupapa Rifle Club, and caught
our first glimpse of the democracy of affliction and alleviation
that obtains. The club was just beginning a prize shoot for
a cup put up by Mr. McVeigh, who is also a member of the club, as
also are Dr. Goodhue and Dr. Hollmann, the resident physicians
(who, by the way, live in the Settlement with their wives).
All about us, in the shooting booth, were the lepers.
Lepers and non-lepers were using the same guns, and all were
rubbing shoulders in the confined space. The majority of
the lepers were Hawaiians. Sitting beside me on a bench was
a Norwegian. Directly in front of me, in the stand, was an
American, a veteran of the Civil War, who had fought on the
Confederate side. He was sixty-five years of age, but that
did not prevent him from running up a good score. Strapping
Hawaiian policemen, lepers, khaki-clad, were also shooting, as
were Portuguese, Chinese, and kokuas—the latter are native
helpers in the Settlement who are non-lepers. And on the
afternoon that Charmian and I climbed the two-thousand-foot
<i>pali</i> and looked our last upon the Settlement, the
superintendent, the doctors, and the mixture of nationalities and
of diseased and non-diseased were all engaged in an exciting
baseball game.</p>
<p>Not so was the leper and his greatly misunderstood and feared
disease treated during the middle ages in Europe. At that
time the leper was considered legally and politically dead.
He was placed in a funeral procession and led to the church,
where the burial service was read over him by the officiating
clergyman. Then a spadeful of earth was dropped upon his
chest and he was dead-living dead. While this rigorous
treatment was largely unnecessary, nevertheless, one thing was
learned by it. Leprosy was unknown in Europe until it was
introduced by the returning Crusaders, whereupon it spread slowly
until it had seized upon large numbers of the people.
Obviously, it was a disease that could be contracted by
contact. It was a contagion, and it was equally obvious
that it could be eradicated by segregation. Terrible and
monstrous as was the treatment of the leper in those days, the
great lesson of segregation was learned. By its means
leprosy was stamped out.</p>
<p>And by the same means leprosy is even now decreasing in the
Hawaiian Islands. But the segregation of the lepers on
Molokai is not the horrible nightmare that has been so often
exploited by <i>yellow</i> writers. In the first place, the
leper is not torn ruthlessly from his family. When a
suspect is discovered, he is invited by the Board of Health to
come to the Kalihi receiving station at Honolulu. His fare
and all expenses are paid for him. He is first passed upon
by microscopical examination by the bacteriologist of the Board
of Health. If the <i>bacillus lepræ</i> is found, the
patient is examined by the Board of Examining Physicians, five in
number. If found by them to be a leper, he is so declared,
which finding is later officially confirmed by the Board of
Health, and the leper is ordered straight to Molokai.
Furthermore, during the thorough trial that is given his case,
the patient has the right to be represented by a physician whom
he can select and employ for himself. Nor, after having
been declared a leper, is the patient immediately rushed off to
Molokai. He is given ample time, weeks, and even months,
sometimes, during which he stays at Kalihi and winds up or
arranges all his business affairs. At Molokai, in turn, he
may be visited by his relatives, business agents, etc., though
they are not permitted to eat and sleep in his house.
Visitors’ houses, kept “clean,” are maintained
for this purpose.</p>
<p>I saw an illustration of the thorough trial given the suspect,
when I visited Kalihi with Mr. Pinkham, president of the Board of
Health. The suspect was an Hawaiian, seventy years of age,
who for thirty-four years had worked in Honolulu as a pressman in
a printing office. The bacteriologist had decided that he
was a leper, the Examining Board had been unable to make up its
mind, and that day all had come out to Kalihi to make another
examination.</p>
<p>When at Molokai, the declared leper has the privilege of
re-examination, and patients are continually coming back to
Honolulu for that purpose. The steamer that took me to
Molokai had on board two returning lepers, both young women, one
of whom had come to Honolulu to settle up some property she
owned, and the other had come to Honolulu to see her sick
mother. Both had remained at Kalihi for a month.</p>
<p>The Settlement of Molokai enjoys a far more delightful climate
than even Honolulu, being situated on the windward side of the
island in the path of the fresh north-east trades. The
scenery is magnificent; on one side is the blue sea, on the other
the wonderful wall of the <i>pali</i>, receding here and there
into beautiful mountain valleys. Everywhere are grassy
pastures over which roam the hundreds of horses which are owned
by the lepers. Some of them have their own carts, rigs, and
traps. In the little harbour of Kalaupapa lie fishing boats
and a steam launch, all of which are privately owned and operated
by lepers. Their bounds upon the sea are, of course,
determined: otherwise no restriction is put upon their
sea-faring. Their fish they sell to the Board of Health,
and the money they receive is their own. While I was there,
one night’s catch was four thousand pounds.</p>
<p>And as these men fish, others farm. All trades are
followed. One leper, a pure Hawaiian, is the boss
painter. He employs eight men, and takes contracts for
painting buildings from the Board of Health. He is a member
of the Kalaupapa Rifle Club, where I met him, and I must confess
that he was far better dressed than I. Another man,
similarly situated, is the boss carpenter. Then, in
addition to the Board of Health store, there are little privately
owned stores, where those with shopkeeper’s souls may
exercise their peculiar instincts. The Assistant
Superintendent, Mr. Waiamau, a finely educated and able man, is a
pure Hawaiian and a leper. Mr. Bartlett, who is the present
storekeeper, is an American who was in business in Honolulu
before he was struck down by the disease. All that these
men earn is that much in their own pockets. If they do not
work, they are taken care of anyway by the territory, given food,
shelter, clothes, and medical attendance. The Board of
Health carries on agriculture, stock-raising, and dairying, for
local use, and employment at fair wages is furnished to all that
wish to work. They are not compelled to work, however, for
they are the wards of the territory. For the young, and the
very old, and the helpless there are homes and hospitals.</p>
<p>Major Lee, an American and long a marine engineer for the
Inter Island Steamship Company, I met actively at work in the new
steam laundry, where he was busy installing the machinery.
I met him often, afterwards, and one day he said to me:</p>
<p>“Give us a good breeze about how we live here. For
heaven’s sake write us up straight. Put your foot
down on this chamber-of-horrors rot and all the rest of it.
We don’t like being misrepresented. We’ve got
some feelings. Just tell the world how we really are in
here.”</p>
<p>Man after man that I met in the Settlement, and woman after
woman, in one way or another expressed the same sentiment.
It was patent that they resented bitterly the sensational and
untruthful way in which they have been exploited in the past.</p>
<p>In spite of the fact that they are afflicted by disease, the
lepers form a happy colony, divided into two villages and
numerous country and seaside homes, of nearly a thousand
souls. They have six churches, a Young Men’s
Christian Association building, several assembly halls, a band
stand, a race-track, baseball grounds, shooting ranges, an
athletic club, numerous glee clubs, and two brass bands.</p>
<p>“They are so contented down there,” Mr. Pinkham
told me, “that you can’t drive them away with a
shot-gun.”</p>
<p>This I later verified for myself. In January of this
year, eleven of the lepers, on whom the disease, after having
committed certain ravages, showed no further signs of activity,
were brought back to Honolulu for re-examination. They were
loath to come; and, on being asked whether or not they wanted to
go free if found clean of leprosy, one and all answered,
“Back to Molokai.”</p>
<p>In the old days, before the discovery of the leprosy bacillus,
a small number of men and women, suffering from various and
wholly different diseases, were adjudged lepers and sent to
Molokai. Years afterward they suffered great consternation
when the bacteriologists declared that they were not afflicted
with leprosy and never had been. They fought against being
sent away from Molokai, and in one way or another, as helpers and
nurses, they got jobs from the Board of Health and
remained. The present jailer is one of these men.
Declared to be a non-leper, he accepted, on salary, the charge of
the jail, in order to escape being sent away.</p>
<p>At the present moment, in Honolulu, there is a
bootblack. He is an American negro. Mr. McVeigh told
me about him. Long ago, before the bacteriological tests,
he was sent to Molokai as a leper. As a ward of the state
he developed a superlative degree of independence and fomented
much petty mischief. And then, one day, after having been
for years a perennial source of minor annoyances, the
bacteriological test was applied, and he was declared a
non-leper.</p>
<p>“Ah, ha!” chortled Mr. McVeigh. “Now
I’ve got you! Out you go on the next steamer and good
riddance!”</p>
<p>But the negro didn’t want to go. Immediately he
married an old woman, in the last stages of leprosy, and began
petitioning the Board of Health for permission to remain and
nurse his sick wife. There was no one, he said
pathetically, who could take care of his poor wife as well as he
could. But they saw through his game, and he was deported
on the steamer and given the freedom of the world. But he
preferred Molokai. Landing on the leeward side of Molokai,
he sneaked down the <i>pali</i> one night and took up his abode
in the Settlement. He was apprehended, tried and convicted
of trespass, sentenced to pay a small fine, and again deported on
the steamer with the warning that if he trespassed again, he
would be fined one hundred dollars and be sent to prison in
Honolulu. And now, when Mr. McVeigh comes up to Honolulu,
the bootblack shines his shoes for him and says:</p>
<p>“Say, Boss, I lost a good home down there. Yes,
sir, I lost a good home.” Then his voice sinks to a
confidential whisper as he says, “Say, Boss, can’t I
go back? Can’t you fix it for me so as I can go
back?”</p>
<p>He had lived nine years on Molokai, and he had had a better
time there than he has ever had, before and after, on the
outside.</p>
<p>As regards the fear of leprosy itself, nowhere in the
Settlement among lepers, or non-lepers, did I see any sign of
it. The chief horror of leprosy obtains in the minds of
those who have never seen a leper and who do not know anything
about the disease. At the hotel at Waikiki a lady expressed
shuddering amazement at my having the hardihood to pay a visit to
the Settlement. On talking with her I learned that she had
been born in Honolulu, had lived there all her life, and had
never laid eyes on a leper. That was more than I could say
of myself in the United States, where the segregation of lepers
is loosely enforced and where I have repeatedly seen lepers on
the streets of large cities.</p>
<p>Leprosy is terrible, there is no getting away from that; but
from what little I know of the disease and its degree of
contagiousness, I would by far prefer to spend the rest of my
days in Molokai than in any tuberculosis sanatorium. In
every city and county hospital for poor people in the United
States, or in similar institutions in other countries, sights as
terrible as those in Molokai can be witnessed, and the sum total
of these sights is vastly more terrible. For that matter,
if it were given me to choose between being compelled to live in
Molokai for the rest of my life, or in the East End of London,
the East Side of New York, or the Stockyards of Chicago, I would
select Molokai without debate. I would prefer one year of
life in Molokai to five years of life in the above-mentioned
cesspools of human degradation and misery.</p>
<p>In Molokai the people are happy. I shall never forget
the celebration of the Fourth of July I witnessed there. At
six o’clock in the morning the “horribles” were
out, dressed fantastically, astride horses, mules, and donkeys
(their own property), and cutting capers all over the
Settlement. Two brass bands were out as well. Then
there were the <i>pa-u</i> riders, thirty or forty of them,
Hawaiian women all, superb horsewomen dressed gorgeously in the
old, native riding costume, and dashing about in twos and threes
and groups. In the afternoon Charmian and I stood in the
judge’s stand and awarded the prizes for horsemanship and
costume to the <i>pa-u</i> riders. All about were the
hundreds of lepers, with wreaths of flowers on heads and necks
and shoulders, looking on and making merry. And always,
over the brows of hills and across the grassy level stretches,
appearing and disappearing, were the groups of men and women,
gaily dressed, on galloping horses, horses and riders
flower-bedecked and flower-garlanded, singing, and laughing, and
riding like the wind. And as I stood in the judge’s
stand and looked at all this, there came to my recollection the
lazar house of Havana, where I had once beheld some two hundred
lepers, prisoners inside four restricted walls until they
died. No, there are a few thousand places I wot of in this
world over which I would select Molokai as a place of permanent
residence. In the evening we went to one of the leper
assembly halls, where, before a crowded audience, the singing
societies contested for prizes, and where the night wound up with
a dance. I have seen the Hawaiians living in the slums of
Honolulu, and, having seen them, I can readily understand why the
lepers, brought up from the Settlement for re-examination,
shouted one and all, “Back to Molokai!”</p>
<p>One thing is certain. The leper in the Settlement is far
better off than the leper who lies in hiding outside. Such
a leper is a lonely outcast, living in constant fear of discovery
and slowly and surely rotting away. The action of leprosy
is not steady. It lays hold of its victim, commits a
ravage, and then lies dormant for an indeterminate period.
It may not commit another ravage for five years, or ten years, or
forty years, and the patient may enjoy uninterrupted good
health. Rarely, however, do these first ravages cease of
themselves. The skilled surgeon is required, and the
skilled surgeon cannot be called in for the leper who is in
hiding. For instance, the first ravage may take the form of
a perforating ulcer in the sole of the foot. When the bone
is reached, necrosis sets in. If the leper is in hiding, he
cannot be operated upon, the necrosis will continue to eat its
way up the bone of the leg, and in a brief and horrible time that
leper will die of gangrene or some other terrible
complication. On the other hand, if that same leper is in
Molokai, the surgeon will operate upon the foot, remove the
ulcer, cleanse the bone, and put a complete stop to that
particular ravage of the disease. A month after the
operation the leper will be out riding horseback, running foot
races, swimming in the breakers, or climbing the giddy sides of
the valleys for mountain apples. And as has been stated
before, the disease, lying dormant, may not again attack him for
five, ten, or forty years.</p>
<p>The old horrors of leprosy go back to the conditions that
obtained before the days of antiseptic surgery, and before the
time when physicians like Dr. Goodhue and Dr. Hollmann went to
live at the Settlement. Dr. Goodhue is the pioneer surgeon
there, and too much praise cannot be given him for the noble work
he has done. I spent one morning in the operating room with
him and of the three operations he performed, two were on men,
newcomers, who had arrived on the same steamer with me. In
each case, the disease had attacked in one spot only. One
had a perforating ulcer in the ankle, well advanced, and the
other man was suffering from a similar affliction, well advanced,
under his arm. Both cases were well advanced because the
man had been on the outside and had not been treated. In
each case. Dr. Goodhue put an immediate and complete stop
to the ravage, and in four weeks those two men will be as well
and able-bodied as they ever were in their lives. The only
difference between them and you or me is that the disease is
lying dormant in their bodies and may at any future time commit
another ravage.</p>
<p>Leprosy is as old as history. References to it are found
in the earliest written records. And yet to-day practically
nothing more is known about it than was known then. This
much was known then, namely, that it was contagious and that
those afflicted by it should be segregated. The difference
between then and now is that to-day the leper is more rigidly
segregated and more humanely treated. But leprosy itself
still remains the same awful and profound mystery. A
reading of the reports of the physicians and specialists of all
countries reveals the baffling nature of the disease. These
leprosy specialists are unanimous on no one phase of the
disease. They do not know. In the past they rashly
and dogmatically generalized. They generalize no
longer. The one possible generalization that can be drawn
from all the investigation that has been made is that leprosy is
<i>feebly contagious</i>. But in what manner it is feebly
contagious is not known. They have isolated the bacillus of
leprosy. They can determine by bacteriological examination
whether or not a person is a leper; but they are as far away as
ever from knowing how that bacillus finds its entrance into the
body of a non-leper. They do not know the length of time of
incubation. They have tried to inoculate all sorts of
animals with leprosy, and have failed.</p>
<p>They are baffled in the discovery of a serum wherewith to
fight the disease. And in all their work, as yet, they have
found no clue, no cure. Sometimes there have been blazes of
hope, theories of causation and much heralded cures, but every
time the darkness of failure quenched the flame. A doctor
insists that the cause of leprosy is a long-continued fish diet,
and he proves his theory voluminously till a physician from the
highlands of India demands why the natives of that district
should therefore be afflicted by leprosy when they have never
eaten fish, nor all the generations of their fathers before
them. A man treats a leper with a certain kind of oil or
drug, announces a cure, and five, ten, or forty years afterwards
the disease breaks out again. It is this trick of leprosy
lying dormant in the body for indeterminate periods that is
responsible for many alleged cures. But this much is
certain: <i>as yet there has been no authentic case of a
cure</i>.</p>
<p>Leprosy is <i>feebly contagious</i>, but how is it
contagious? An Austrian physician has inoculated himself
and his assistants with leprosy and failed to catch it. But
this is not conclusive, for there is the famous case of the
Hawaiian murderer who had his sentence of death commuted to life
imprisonment on his agreeing to be inoculated with the
<i>bacillus lepræ</i>. Some time after inoculation,
leprosy made its appearance, and the man died a leper on
Molokai. Nor was this conclusive, for it was discovered
that at the time he was inoculated several members of his family
were already suffering from the disease on Molokai. He may
have contracted the disease from them, and it may have been well
along in its mysterious period of incubation at the time he was
officially inoculated. Then there is the case of that hero
of the Church, Father Damien, who went to Molokai a clean man and
died a leper. There have been many theories as to how he
contracted leprosy, but nobody knows. He never knew
himself. But every chance that he ran has certainly been
run by a woman at present living in the Settlement; who has lived
there many years; who has had five leper husbands, and had
children by them; and who is to-day, as she always has been, free
of the disease.</p>
<p>As yet no light has been shed upon the mystery of
leprosy. When more is learned about the disease, a cure for
it may be expected. Once an efficacious serum is
discovered, and leprosy, because it is so feebly contagious, will
pass away swiftly from the earth. The battle waged with it
will be short and sharp. In the meantime, how to discover
that serum, or some other unguessed weapon? In the present
it is a serious matter. It is estimated that there are half
a million lepers, not segregated, in India alone. Carnegie
libraries, Rockefeller universities, and many similar
benefactions are all very well; but one cannot help thinking how
far a few thousands of dollars would go, say in the leper
Settlement of Molokai. The residents there are accidents of
fate, scapegoats to some mysterious natural law of which man
knows nothing, isolated for the welfare of their fellows who else
might catch the dread disease, even as they have caught it,
nobody knows how. Not for their sakes merely, but for the
sake of future generations, a few thousands of dollars would go
far in a legitimate and scientific search after a cure for
leprosy, for a serum, or for some undreamed discovery that will
enable the medical world to exterminate the <i>bacillus
lepræ</i>. There’s the place for your money,
you philanthropists.</p>
<h2><SPAN name="chap08"></SPAN>CHAPTER VIII<br/> <span class="GutSmall">THE HOUSE OF THE SUN</span></h2>
<p><span class="smcap">There</span> are hosts of people who
journey like restless spirits round and about this earth in
search of seascapes and landscapes and the wonders and beauties
of nature. They overrun Europe in armies; they can be met
in droves and herds in Florida and the West Indies, at the
Pyramids, and on the slopes and summits of the Canadian and
American Rockies; but in the House of the Sun they are as rare as
live and wriggling dinosaurs. Haleakala is the Hawaiian
name for “the House of the Sun.” It is a noble
dwelling, situated on the Island of Maui; but so few tourists
have ever peeped into it, much less entered it, that their number
may be practically reckoned as zero. Yet I venture to state
that for natural beauty and wonder the nature-lover may see
dissimilar things as great as Haleakala, but no greater, while he
will never see elsewhere anything more beautiful or
wonderful. Honolulu is six days’ steaming from San
Francisco; Maui is a night’s run on the steamer from
Honolulu; and six hours more if he is in a hurry, can bring the
traveller to Kolikoli, which is ten thousand and thirty-two feet
above the sea and which stands hard by the entrance portal to the
House of the Sun. Yet the tourist comes not, and Haleakala
sleeps on in lonely and unseen grandeur.</p>
<p>Not being tourists, we of the <i>Snark</i> went to
Haleakala. On the slopes of that monster mountain there is
a cattle ranch of some fifty thousand acres, where we spent the
night at an altitude of two thousand feet. The next morning
it was boots and saddles, and with cow-boys and packhorses we
climbed to Ukulele, a mountain ranch-house, the altitude of
which, fifty-five hundred feet, gives a severely temperate
climate, compelling blankets at night and a roaring fireplace in
the living-room. Ukulele, by the way, is the Hawaiian for
“jumping flea” as it is also the Hawaiian for a
certain musical instrument that may be likened to a young
guitar. It is my opinion that the mountain ranch-house was
named after the young guitar. We were not in a hurry, and
we spent the day at Ukulele, learnedly discussing altitudes and
barometers and shaking our particular barometer whenever any
one’s argument stood in need of demonstration. Our
barometer was the most graciously acquiescent instrument I have
ever seen. Also, we gathered mountain raspberries, large as
hen’s eggs and larger, gazed up the pasture-covered lava
slopes to the summit of Haleakala, forty-five hundred feet above
us, and looked down upon a mighty battle of the clouds that was
being fought beneath us, ourselves in the bright sunshine.</p>
<p>Every day and every day this unending battle goes on.
Ukiukiu is the name of the trade-wind that comes raging down out
of the north-east and hurls itself upon Haleakala. Now
Haleakala is so bulky and tall that it turns the north-east
trade-wind aside on either hand, so that in the lee of Haleakala
no trade-wind blows at all. On the contrary, the wind blows
in the counter direction, in the teeth of the north-east
trade. This wind is called Naulu. And day and night
and always Ukiukiu and Naulu strive with each other, advancing,
retreating, flanking, curving, curling, and turning and twisting,
the conflict made visible by the cloud-masses plucked from the
heavens and hurled back and forth in squadrons, battalions,
armies, and great mountain ranges. Once in a while,
Ukiukiu, in mighty gusts, flings immense cloud-masses clear over
the summit of Haleakala; whereupon Naulu craftily captures them,
lines them up in new battle-formation, and with them smites back
at his ancient and eternal antagonist. Then Ukiukiu sends a
great cloud-army around the eastern-side of the mountain.
It is a flanking movement, well executed. But Naulu, from
his lair on the leeward side, gathers the flanking army in,
pulling and twisting and dragging it, hammering it into shape,
and sends it charging back against Ukiukiu around the western
side of the mountain. And all the while, above and below
the main battle-field, high up the slopes toward the sea, Ukiukiu
and Naulu are continually sending out little wisps of cloud, in
ragged skirmish line, that creep and crawl over the ground, among
the trees and through the canyons, and that spring upon and
capture one another in sudden ambuscades and sorties. And
sometimes Ukiukiu or Naulu, abruptly sending out a heavy charging
column, captures the ragged little skirmishers or drives them
skyward, turning over and over, in vertical whirls, thousands of
feet in the air.</p>
<p>But it is on the western slopes of Haleakala that the main
battle goes on. Here Naulu masses his heaviest formations
and wins his greatest victories. Ukiukiu grows weak toward
late afternoon, which is the way of all trade-winds, and is
driven backward by Naulu. Naulu’s generalship is
excellent. All day he has been gathering and packing away
immense reserves. As the afternoon draws on, he welds them
into a solid column, sharp-pointed, miles in length, a mile in
width, and hundreds of feet thick. This column he slowly
thrusts forward into the broad battle-front of Ukiukiu, and
slowly and surely Ukiukiu, weakening fast, is split
asunder. But it is not all bloodless. At times
Ukiukiu struggles wildly, and with fresh accessions of strength
from the limitless north-east, smashes away half a mile at a time
of Naulu’s column and sweeps it off and away toward West
Maui. Sometimes, when the two charging armies meet end-on,
a tremendous perpendicular whirl results, the cloud-masses,
locked together, mounting thousands of feet into the air and
turning over and over. A favourite device of Ukiukiu is to
send a low, squat formation, densely packed, forward along the
ground and under Naulu. When Ukiukiu is under, he proceeds
to buck. Naulu’s mighty middle gives to the blow and
bends upward, but usually he turns the attacking column back upon
itself and sets it milling. And all the while the ragged
little skirmishers, stray and detached, sneak through the trees
and canyons, crawl along and through the grass, and surprise one
another with unexpected leaps and rushes; while above, far above,
serene and lonely in the rays of the setting sun, Haleakala looks
down upon the conflict. And so, the night. But in the
morning, after the fashion of trade-winds, Ukiukiu gathers
strength and sends the hosts of Naulu rolling back in confusion
and rout. And one day is like another day in the battle of
the clouds, where Ukiukiu and Naulu strive eternally on the
slopes of Haleakala.</p>
<p>Again in the morning, it was boots and saddles, cow-boys, and
packhorses, and the climb to the top began. One packhorse
carried twenty gallons of water, slung in five-gallon bags on
either side; for water is precious and rare in the crater itself,
in spite of the fact that several miles to the north and east of
the crater-rim more rain comes down than in any other place in
the world. The way led upward across countless lava flows,
without regard for trails, and never have I seen horses with such
perfect footing as that of the thirteen that composed our
outfit. They climbed or dropped down perpendicular places
with the sureness and coolness of mountain goats, and never a
horse fell or baulked.</p>
<p>There is a familiar and strange illusion experienced by all
who climb isolated mountains. The higher one climbs, the
more of the earth’s surface becomes visible, and the effect
of this is that the horizon seems up-hill from the
observer. This illusion is especially notable on Haleakala,
for the old volcano rises directly from the sea without
buttresses or connecting ranges. In consequence, as fast as
we climbed up the grim slope of Haleakala, still faster did
Haleakala, ourselves, and all about us, sink down into the centre
of what appeared a profound abyss. Everywhere, far above
us, towered the horizon. The ocean sloped down from the
horizon to us. The higher we climbed, the deeper did we
seem to sink down, the farther above us shone the horizon, and
the steeper pitched the grade up to that horizontal line where
sky and ocean met. It was weird and unreal, and vagrant
thoughts of Simm’s Hole and of the volcano through which
Jules Verne journeyed to the centre of the earth flitted through
one’s mind.</p>
<p>And then, when at last we reached the summit of that monster
mountain, which summit was like the bottom of an inverted cone
situated in the centre of an awful cosmic pit, we found that we
were at neither top nor bottom. Far above us was the
heaven-towering horizon, and far beneath us, where the top of the
mountain should have been, was a deeper deep, the great crater,
the House of the Sun. Twenty-three miles around stretched
the dizzy walls of the crater. We stood on the edge of the
nearly vertical western wall, and the floor of the crater lay
nearly half a mile beneath. This floor, broken by
lava-flows and cinder-cones, was as red and fresh and uneroded as
if it were but yesterday that the fires went out. The
cinder-cones, the smallest over four hundred feet in height and
the largest over nine hundred, seemed no more than puny little
sand-hills, so mighty was the magnitude of the setting. Two
gaps, thousands of feet deep, broke the rim of the crater, and
through these Ukiukiu vainly strove to drive his fleecy herds of
trade-wind clouds. As fast as they advanced through the
gaps, the heat of the crater dissipated them into thin air, and
though they advanced always, they got nowhere.</p>
<p>It was a scene of vast bleakness and desolation, stern,
forbidding, fascinating. We gazed down upon a place of fire
and earthquake. The tie-ribs of earth lay bare before
us. It was a workshop of nature still cluttered with the
raw beginnings of world-making. Here and there great dikes
of primordial rock had thrust themselves up from the bowels of
earth, straight through the molten surface-ferment that had
evidently cooled only the other day. It was all unreal and
unbelievable. Looking upward, far above us (in reality
beneath us) floated the cloud-battle of Ukiukiu and Naulu.
And higher up the slope of the seeming abyss, above the
cloud-battle, in the air and sky, hung the islands of Lanai and
Molokai. Across the crater, to the south-east, still
apparently looking upward, we saw ascending, first, the turquoise
sea, then the white surf-line of the shore of Hawaii; above that
the belt of trade-clouds, and next, eighty miles away, rearing
their stupendous hulks out of the azure sky, tipped with snow,
wreathed with cloud, trembling like a mirage, the peaks of Mauna
Kea and Mauna Loa hung poised on the wall of heaven.</p>
<p>It is told that long ago, one Maui, the son of Hina, lived on
what is now known as West Maui. His mother, Hina, employed
her time in the making of <i>kapas</i>. She must have made
them at night, for her days were occupied in trying to dry the
<i>kapas</i>. Each morning, and all morning, she toiled at
spreading them out in the sun. But no sooner were they out,
than she began taking them in, in order to have them all under
shelter for the night. For know that the days were shorter
then than now. Maui watched his mother’s futile toil
and felt sorry for her. He decided to do
something—oh, no, not to help her hang out and take in the
<i>kapas</i>. He was too clever for that. His idea
was to make the sun go slower. Perhaps he was the first
Hawaiian astronomer. At any rate, he took a series of
observations of the sun from various parts of the island.
His conclusion was that the sun’s path was directly across
Haleakala. Unlike Joshua, he stood in no need of divine
assistance. He gathered a huge quantity of coconuts, from
the fibre of which he braided a stout cord, and in one end of
which he made a noose, even as the cow-boys of Haleakala do to
this day. Next he climbed into the House of the Sun and
laid in wait. When the sun came tearing along the path,
bent on completing its journey in the shortest time possible, the
valiant youth threw his lariat around one of the sun’s
largest and strongest beams. He made the sun slow down
some; also, he broke the beam short off. And he kept on
roping and breaking off beams till the sun said it was willing to
listen to reason. Maui set forth his terms of peace, which
the sun accepted, agreeing to go more slowly thereafter.
Wherefore Hina had ample time in which to dry her <i>kapas</i>,
and the days are longer than they used to be, which last is quite
in accord with the teachings of modern astronomy.</p>
<p>We had a lunch of jerked beef and hard <i>poi</i> in a stone
corral, used of old time for the night-impounding of cattle being
driven across the island. Then we skirted the rim for half
a mile and began the descent into the crater. Twenty-five
hundred feet beneath lay the floor, and down a steep slope of
loose volcanic cinders we dropped, the sure-footed horses
slipping and sliding, but always keeping their feet. The
black surface of the cinders, when broken by the horses’
hoofs, turned to a yellow ochre dust, virulent in appearance and
acid of taste, that arose in clouds. There was a gallop
across a level stretch to the mouth of a convenient blow-hole,
and then the descent continued in clouds of volcanic dust,
winding in and out among cinder-cones, brick-red, old rose, and
purplish black of colour. Above us, higher and higher,
towered the crater-walls, while we journeyed on across
innumerable lava-flows, turning and twisting a devious way among
the adamantine billows of a petrified sea. Saw-toothed
waves of lava vexed the surface of this weird ocean, while on
either hand arose jagged crests and spiracles of fantastic
shape. Our way led on past a bottomless pit and along and
over the main stream of the latest lava-flow for seven miles.</p>
<p>At the lower end of the crater was our camping spot, in a
small grove of <i>olapa</i> and <i>kolea</i> trees, tucked away
in a corner of the crater at the base of walls that rose
perpendicularly fifteen hundred feet. Here was pasturage
for the horses, but no water, and first we turned aside and
picked our way across a mile of lava to a known water-hole in a
crevice in the crater-wall. The water-hole was empty.
But on climbing fifty feet up the crevice, a pool was found
containing half a dozen barrels of water. A pail was
carried up, and soon a steady stream of the precious liquid was
running down the rock and filling the lower pool, while the
cow-boys below were busy fighting the horses back, for there was
room for one only to drink at a time. Then it was on to
camp at the foot of the wall, up which herds of wild goats
scrambled and blatted, while the tent arose to the sound of
rifle-firing. Jerked beef, hard <i>poi</i>, and broiled kid
were the menu. Over the crest of the crater, just above our
heads, rolled a sea of clouds, driven on by Ukiukiu. Though
this sea rolled over the crest unceasingly, it never blotted out
nor dimmed the moon, for the heat of the crater dissolved the
clouds as fast as they rolled in. Through the moonlight,
attracted by the camp-fire, came the crater cattle to peer and
challenge. They were rolling fat, though they rarely drank
water, the morning dew on the grass taking its place. It
was because of this dew that the tent made a welcome bedchamber,
and we fell asleep to the chanting of <i>hulas</i> by the
unwearied Hawaiian cow-boys, in whose veins, no doubt, ran the
blood of Maui, their valiant forebear.</p>
<p>The camera cannot do justice to the House of the Sun.
The sublimated chemistry of photography may not lie, but it
certainly does not tell all the truth. The Koolau Gap may
be faithfully reproduced, just as it impinged on the retina of
the camera, yet in the resulting picture the gigantic scale of
things would be missing. Those walls that seem several
hundred feet in height are almost as many thousand; that entering
wedge of cloud is a mile and a half wide in the gap itself, while
beyond the gap it is a veritable ocean; and that foreground of
cinder-cone and volcanic ash, mushy and colourless in appearance,
is in truth gorgeous-hued in brick-red, terra-cotta rose, yellow
ochre, and purplish black. Also, words are a vain thing and
drive to despair. To say that a crater-wall is two thousand
feet high is to say just precisely that it is two thousand feet
high; but there is a vast deal more to that crater-wall than a
mere statistic. The sun is ninety-three millions of miles
distant, but to mortal conception the adjoining county is farther
away. This frailty of the human brain is hard on the
sun. It is likewise hard on the House of the Sun.
Haleakala has a message of beauty and wonder for the human soul
that cannot be delivered by proxy. Kolikoli is six hours
from Kahului; Kahului is a night’s run from Honolulu;
Honolulu is six days from San Francisco; and there you are.</p>
<p>We climbed the crater-walls, put the horses over impossible
places, rolled stones, and shot wild goats. I did not get
any goats. I was too busy rolling stones. One spot in
particular I remember, where we started a stone the size of a
horse. It began the descent easy enough, rolling over,
wobbling, and threatening to stop; but in a few minutes it was
soaring through the air two hundred feet at a jump. It grew
rapidly smaller until it struck a slight slope of volcanic sand,
over which it darted like a startled jackrabbit, kicking up
behind it a tiny trail of yellow dust. Stone and dust
diminished in size, until some of the party said the stone had
stopped. That was because they could not see it any
longer. It had vanished into the distance beyond their
ken. Others saw it rolling farther on—I know I did;
and it is my firm conviction that that stone is still
rolling.</p>
<p>Our last day in the crater, Ukiukiu gave us a taste of his
strength. He smashed Naulu back all along the line, filled
the House of the Sun to overflowing with clouds, and drowned us
out. Our rain-gauge was a pint cup under a tiny hole in the
tent. That last night of storm and rain filled the cup, and
there was no way of measuring the water that spilled over into
the blankets. With the rain-gauge out of business there was
no longer any reason for remaining; so we broke camp in the
wet-gray of dawn, and plunged eastward across the lava to the
Kaupo Gap. East Maui is nothing more or less than the vast
lava stream that flowed long ago through the Kaupo Gap; and down
this stream we picked our way from an altitude of six thousand
five hundred feet to the sea. This was a day’s work
in itself for the horses; but never were there such horses.
Safe in the bad places, never rushing, never losing their heads,
as soon as they found a trail wide and smooth enough to run on,
they ran. There was no stopping them until the trail became
bad again, and then they stopped of themselves.
Continuously, for days, they had performed the hardest kind of
work, and fed most of the time on grass foraged by themselves at
night while we slept, and yet that day they covered twenty-eight
leg-breaking miles and galloped into Hana like a bunch of
colts. Also, there were several of them, reared in the dry
region on the leeward side of Haleakala, that had never worn
shoes in all their lives. Day after day, and all day long,
unshod, they had travelled over the sharp lava, with the extra
weight of a man on their backs, and their hoofs were in better
condition than those of the shod horses.</p>
<p>The scenery between Vieiras’s (where the Kaupo Gap
empties into the sea) and Lana, which we covered in half a day,
is well worth a week or month; but, wildly beautiful as it is, it
becomes pale and small in comparison with the wonderland that
lies beyond the rubber plantations between Hana and the Honomanu
Gulch. Two days were required to cover this marvellous
stretch, which lies on the windward side of Haleakala. The
people who dwell there call it the “ditch country,”
an unprepossessing name, but it has no other. Nobody else
ever comes there. Nobody else knows anything about
it. With the exception of a handful of men, whom business
has brought there, nobody has heard of the ditch country of
Maui. Now a ditch is a ditch, assumably muddy, and usually
traversing uninteresting and monotonous landscapes. But the
Nahiku Ditch is not an ordinary ditch. The windward side of
Haleakala is serried by a thousand precipitous gorges, down which
rush as many torrents, each torrent of which achieves a score of
cascades and waterfalls before it reaches the sea. More
rain comes down here than in any other region in the world.
In 1904 the year’s downpour was four hundred and twenty
inches. Water means sugar, and sugar is the backbone of the
territory of Hawaii, wherefore the Nahiku Ditch, which is not a
ditch, but a chain of tunnels. The water travels
underground, appearing only at intervals to leap a gorge,
travelling high in the air on a giddy flume and plunging into and
through the opposing mountain. This magnificent waterway is
called a “ditch,” and with equal appropriateness can
Cleopatra’s barge be called a box-car.</p>
<p>There are no carriage roads through the ditch country, and
before the ditch was built, or bored, rather, there was no
horse-trail. Hundreds of inches of rain annually, on
fertile soil, under a tropic sun, means a steaming jungle of
vegetation. A man, on foot, cutting his way through, might
advance a mile a day, but at the end of a week he would be a
wreck, and he would have to crawl hastily back if he wanted to
get out before the vegetation overran the passage way he had
cut. O’Shaughnessy was the daring engineer who
conquered the jungle and the gorges, ran the ditch and made the
horse-trail. He built enduringly, in concrete and masonry,
and made one of the most remarkable water-farms in the
world. Every little runlet and dribble is harvested and
conveyed by subterranean channels to the main ditch. But so
heavily does it rain at times that countless spillways let the
surplus escape to the sea.</p>
<p>The horse-trail is not very wide. Like the engineer who
built it, it dares anything. Where the ditch plunges
through the mountain, it climbs over; and where the ditch leaps a
gorge on a flume, the horse-trail takes advantage of the ditch
and crosses on top of the flume. That careless trail thinks
nothing of travelling up or down the faces of precipices.
It gouges its narrow way out of the wall, dodging around
waterfalls or passing under them where they thunder down in white
fury; while straight overhead the wall rises hundreds of feet,
and straight beneath it sinks a thousand. And those
marvellous mountain horses are as unconcerned as the trail.
They fox-trot along it as a matter of course, though the footing
is slippery with rain, and they will gallop with their hind feet
slipping over the edge if you let them. I advise only those
with steady nerves and cool heads to tackle the Nahiku Ditch
trail. One of our cow-boys was noted as the strongest and
bravest on the big ranch. He had ridden mountain horses all
his life on the rugged western slopes of Haleakala. He was
first in the horse-breaking; and when the others hung back, as a
matter of course, he would go in to meet a wild bull in the
cattle-pen. He had a reputation. But he had never
ridden over the Nahiku Ditch. It was there he lost his
reputation. When he faced the first flume, spanning a
hair-raising gorge, narrow, without railings, with a bellowing
waterfall above, another below, and directly beneath a wild
cascade, the air filled with driving spray and rocking to the
clamour and rush of sound and motion—well, that cow-boy
dismounted from his horse, explained briefly that he had a wife
and two children, and crossed over on foot, leading the horse
behind him.</p>
<p>The only relief from the flumes was the precipices; and the
only relief from the precipices was the flumes, except where the
ditch was far under ground, in which case we crossed one horse
and rider at a time, on primitive log-bridges that swayed and
teetered and threatened to carry away. I confess that at
first I rode such places with my feet loose in the stirrups, and
that on the sheer walls I saw to it, by a definite, conscious act
of will, that the foot in the outside stirrup, overhanging the
thousand feet of fall, was exceedingly loose. I say
“at first”; for, as in the crater itself we quickly
lost our conception of magnitude, so, on the Nahiku Ditch, we
quickly lost our apprehension of depth. The ceaseless
iteration of height and depth produced a state of consciousness
in which height and depth were accepted as the ordinary
conditions of existence; and from the horse’s back to look
sheer down four hundred or five hundred feet became quite
commonplace and non-productive of thrills. And as
carelessly as the trail and the horses, we swung along the dizzy
heights and ducked around or through the waterfalls.</p>
<p>And such a ride! Falling water was everywhere. We
rode above the clouds, under the clouds, and through the clouds!
and every now and then a shaft of sunshine penetrated like a
search-light to the depths yawning beneath us, or flashed upon
some pinnacle of the crater-rim thousands of feet above. At
every turn of the trail a waterfall or a dozen waterfalls,
leaping hundreds of feet through the air, burst upon our
vision. At our first night’s camp, in the Keanae
Gulch, we counted thirty-two waterfalls from a single
viewpoint. The vegetation ran riot over that wild
land. There were forests of koa and kolea trees, and
candlenut trees; and then there were the trees called ohia-ai,
which bore red mountain apples, mellow and juicy and most
excellent to eat. Wild bananas grew everywhere, clinging to
the sides of the gorges, and, overborne by their great bunches of
ripe fruit, falling across the trail and blocking the way.
And over the forest surged a sea of green life, the climbers of a
thousand varieties, some that floated airily, in lacelike
filaments, from the tallest branches others that coiled and wound
about the trees like huge serpents; and one, the ei-ei, that was
for all the world like a climbing palm, swinging on a thick stem
from branch to branch and tree to tree and throttling the
supports whereby it climbed. Through the sea of green,
lofty tree-ferns thrust their great delicate fronds, and the
lehua flaunted its scarlet blossoms. Underneath the
climbers, in no less profusion, grew the warm-coloured,
strangely-marked plants that in the United States one is
accustomed to seeing preciously conserved in hot-houses. In
fact, the ditch country of Maui is nothing more nor less than a
huge conservatory. Every familiar variety of fern
flourishes, and more varieties that are unfamiliar, from the
tiniest maidenhair to the gross and voracious staghorn, the
latter the terror of the woodsmen, interlacing with itself in
tangled masses five or six feet deep and covering acres.</p>
<p>Never was there such a ride. For two days it lasted,
when we emerged into rolling country, and, along an actual
wagon-road, came home to the ranch at a gallop. I know it
was cruel to gallop the horses after such a long, hard journey;
but we blistered our hands in vain effort to hold them in.
That’s the sort of horses they grow on Haleakala. At
the ranch there was great festival of cattle-driving, branding,
and horse-breaking. Overhead Ukiukiu and Naulu battled
valiantly, and far above, in the sunshine, towered the mighty
summit of Haleakala.</p>
<h2><SPAN name="chap09"></SPAN>CHAPTER IX<br/> <span class="GutSmall">A PACIFIC TRAVERSE</span></h2>
<p><i>Sandwich Islands to Tahiti</i>.—<i>There is great
difficulty in making this passage across the trades</i>.
<i>The whalers and all others speak with great doubt of fetching
Tahiti from the Sandwich islands</i>. <i>Capt. Bruce says
that a vessel should keep to the northward until she gets a start
of wind before bearing for her destination</i>. <i>In his
passage between them in November</i>, 1837, <i>he had no
variables near the line in coming south</i>, <i>and never could
make easting on either tack</i>, <i>though he endeavoured by
every means to do so</i>.</p>
<p><span class="smcap">So</span> say the sailing directions for
the South Pacific Ocean; and that is all they say. There is
not a word more to help the weary voyager in making this long
traverse—nor is there any word at all concerning the
passage from Hawaii to the Marquesas, which lie some eight
hundred miles to the northeast of Tahiti and which are the more
difficult to reach by just that much. The reason for the
lack of directions is, I imagine, that no voyager is supposed to
make himself weary by attempting so impossible a traverse.
But the impossible did not deter the
<i>Snark</i>,—principally because of the fact that we did
not read that particular little paragraph in the sailing
directions until after we had started. We sailed from Hilo,
Hawaii, on October 7, and arrived at Nuka-hiva, in the Marquesas,
on December 6. The distance was two thousand miles as the
crow flies, while we actually travelled at least four thousand
miles to accomplish it, thus proving for once and for ever that
the shortest distance between two points is not always a straight
line. Had we headed directly for the Marquesas, we might
have travelled five or six thousand miles.</p>
<p>Upon one thing we were resolved: we would not cross the Line
west of 130° west longitude. For here was the
problem. To cross the Line to the west of that point, if
the southeast trades were well around to the southeast, would
throw us so far to leeward of the Marquesas that a head-beat
would be maddeningly impossible. Also, we had to remember
the equatorial current, which moves west at a rate of anywhere
from twelve to seventy-five miles a day. A pretty pickle,
indeed, to be to leeward of our destination with such a current
in our teeth. No; not a minute, nor a second, west of
130° west longitude would we cross the Line. But since
the southeast trades were to be expected five or six degrees
north of the Line (which, if they were well around to the
southeast or south-southeast, would necessitate our sliding off
toward south-southwest), we should have to hold to the eastward,
north of the Line, and north of the southeast trades, until we
gained at least 128° west longitude.</p>
<p>I have forgotten to mention that the seventy-horse-power
gasolene engine, as usual, was not working, and that we could
depend upon wind alone. Neither was the launch engine
working. And while I am about it, I may as well confess
that the five-horse-power, which ran the lights, fans, and pumps,
was also on the sick-list. A striking title for a book
haunts me, waking and sleeping. I should like to write that
book some day and to call it “Around the World with Three
Gasolene Engines and a Wife.” But I am afraid I shall
not write it, for fear of hurting the feelings of some of the
young gentlemen of San Francisco, Honolulu, and Hilo, who learned
their trades at the expense of the <i>Snark’s</i>
engines.</p>
<p>It looked easy on paper. Here was Hilo and there was our
objective, 128° west longitude. With the northeast
trade blowing we could travel a straight line between the two
points, and even slack our sheets off a goodly bit. But one
of the chief troubles with the trades is that one never knows
just where he will pick them up and just in what direction they
will be blowing. We picked up the northeast trade right
outside of Hilo harbour, but the miserable breeze was away around
into the east. Then there was the north equatorial current
setting westward like a mighty river. Furthermore, a small
boat, by the wind and bucking into a big headsea, does not work
to advantage. She jogs up and down and gets nowhere.
Her sails are full and straining, every little while she presses
her lee-rail under, she flounders, and bumps, and splashes, and
that is all. Whenever she begins to gather way, she runs
ker-chug into a big mountain of water and is brought to a
standstill. So, with the <i>Snark</i>, the resultant of her
smallness, of the trade around into the east, and of the strong
equatorial current, was a long sag south. Oh, she did not
go quite south. But the easting she made was
distressing. On October 11, she made forty miles easting;
October 12, fifteen miles; October 13, no easting; October 14,
thirty miles; October 15, twenty-three miles; October 16, eleven
miles; and on October 17, she actually went to the westward four
miles. Thus, in a week she made one hundred and fifteen
miles easting, which was equivalent to sixteen miles a day.
But, between the longitude of Hilo and 128° west longitude is
a difference of twenty-seven degrees, or, roughly, sixteen
hundred miles. At sixteen miles a day, one hundred days
would be required to accomplish this distance. And even
then, our objective, 128° west longitude, was five degrees
north of the Line, while Nuka-hiva, in the Marquesas, lay nine
degrees south of the Line and twelve degrees to the west!</p>
<p>There remained only one thing to do—to work south out of
the trade and into the variables. It is true that Captain
Bruce found no variables on his traverse, and that he
“never could make easting on either tack.” It
was the variables or nothing with us, and we prayed for better
luck than he had had. The variables constitute the belt of
ocean lying between the trades and the doldrums, and are
conjectured to be the draughts of heated air which rise in the
doldrums, flow high in the air counter to the trades, and
gradually sink down till they fan the surface of the ocean where
they are found. And they are found where they are found;
for they are wedged between the trades and the doldrums, which
same shift their territory from day to day and month to
month.</p>
<p>We found the variables in 11° north latitude, and 11°
north latitude we hugged jealously. To the south lay the
doldrums. To the north lay the northeast trade that refused
to blow from the northeast. The days came and went, and
always they found the <i>Snark</i> somewhere near the eleventh
parallel. The variables were truly variable. A light
head-wind would die away and leave us rolling in a calm for
forty-eight hours. Then a light head-wind would spring up,
blow for three hours, and leave us rolling in another calm for
forty-eight hours. Then—hurrah!—the wind would
come out of the west, fresh, beautifully fresh, and send the
<i>Snark</i> along, wing and wing, her wake bubbling, the
log-line straight astern. At the end of half an hour, while
we were preparing to set the spinnaker, with a few sickly gasps
the wind would die away. And so it went. We wagered
optimistically on every favourable fan of air that lasted over
five minutes; but it never did any good. The fans faded out
just the same.</p>
<p>But there were exceptions. In the variables, if you wait
long enough, something is bound to happen, and we were so
plentifully stocked with food and water that we could afford to
wait. On October 26, we actually made one hundred and three
miles of easting, and we talked about it for days
afterwards. Once we caught a moderate gale from the south,
which blew itself out in eight hours, but it helped us to
seventy-one miles of easting in that particular twenty-four
hours. And then, just as it was expiring, the wind came
straight out from the north (the directly opposite quarter), and
fanned us along over another degree of easting.</p>
<p>In years and years no sailing vessel has attempted this
traverse, and we found ourselves in the midst of one of the
loneliest of the Pacific solitudes. In the sixty days we
were crossing it we sighted no sail, lifted no steamer’s
smoke above the horizon. A disabled vessel could drift in
this deserted expanse for a dozen generations, and there would be
no rescue. The only chance of rescue would be from a vessel
like the <i>Snark</i>, and the <i>Snark</i> happened to be there
principally because of the fact that the traverse had been begun
before the particular paragraph in the sailing directions had
been read. Standing upright on deck, a straight line drawn
from the eye to the horizon would measure three miles and a
half. Thus, seven miles was the diameter of the circle of
the sea in which we had our centre. Since we remained
always in the centre, and since we constantly were moving in some
direction, we looked upon many circles. But all circles
looked alike. No tufted islets, gray headlands, nor
glistening patches of white canvas ever marred the symmetry of
that unbroken curve. Clouds came and went, rising up over
the rim of the circle, flowing across the space of it, and
spilling away and down across the opposite rim.</p>
<p>The world faded as the procession of the weeks marched
by. The world faded until at last there ceased to be any
world except the little world of the <i>Snark</i>, freighted with
her seven souls and floating on the expanse of the waters.
Our memories of the world, the great world, became like dreams of
former lives we had lived somewhere before we came to be born on
the <i>Snark</i>. After we had been out of fresh vegetables
for some time, we mentioned such things in much the same way I
have heard my father mention the vanished apples of his
boyhood. Man is a creature of habit, and we on the
<i>Snark</i> had got the habit of the <i>Snark</i>.
Everything about her and aboard her was as a matter of course,
and anything different would have been an irritation and an
offence.</p>
<p>There was no way by which the great world could intrude.
Our bell rang the hours, but no caller ever rang it. There
were no guests to dinner, no telegrams, no insistent telephone
jangles invading our privacy. We had no engagements to
keep, no trains to catch, and there were no morning newspapers
over which to waste time in learning what was happening to our
fifteen hundred million other fellow-creatures.</p>
<p>But it was not dull. The affairs of our little world had
to be regulated, and, unlike the great world, our world had to be
steered in its journey through space. Also, there were
cosmic disturbances to be encountered and baffled, such as do not
afflict the big earth in its frictionless orbit through the
windless void. And we never knew, from moment to moment,
what was going to happen next. There were spice and variety
enough and to spare. Thus, at four in the morning, I
relieve Hermann at the wheel.</p>
<p>“East-northeast,” he gives me the course.
“She’s eight points off, but she ain’t
steering.”</p>
<p>Small wonder. The vessel does not exist that can be
steered in so absolute a calm.</p>
<p>“I had a breeze a little while ago—maybe it will
come back again,” Hermann says hopefully, ere he starts
forward to the cabin and his bunk.</p>
<p>The mizzen is in and fast furled. In the night, what of
the roll and the absence of wind, it had made life too hideous to
be permitted to go on rasping at the mast, smashing at the
tackles, and buffeting the empty air into hollow outbursts of
sound. But the big mainsail is still on, and the staysail,
jib, and flying-jib are snapping and slashing at their sheets
with every roll. Every star is out. Just for luck I
put the wheel hard over in the opposite direction to which it had
been left by Hermann, and I lean back and gaze up at the
stars. There is nothing else for me to do. There is
nothing to be done with a sailing vessel rolling in a stark
calm.</p>
<p>Then I feel a fan on my cheek, faint, so faint, that I can
just sense it ere it is gone. But another comes, and
another, until a real and just perceptible breeze is
blowing. How the <i>Snark’s</i> sails manage to feel
it is beyond me, but feel it they do, as she does as well, for
the compass card begins slowly to revolve in the binnacle.
In reality, it is not revolving at all. It is held by
terrestrial magnetism in one place, and it is the <i>Snark</i>
that is revolving, pivoted upon that delicate cardboard device
that floats in a closed vessel of alcohol.</p>
<p>So the <i>Snark</i> comes back on her course. The breath
increases to a tiny puff. The <i>Snark</i> feels the weight
of it and actually heels over a trifle. There is flying
scud overhead, and I notice the stars being blotted out.
Walls of darkness close in upon me, so that, when the last star
is gone, the darkness is so near that it seems I can reach out
and touch it on every side. When I lean toward it, I can
feel it loom against my face. Puff follows puff, and I am
glad the mizzen is furled. Phew! that was a stiff
one! The <i>Snark</i> goes over and down until her lee-rail
is buried and the whole Pacific Ocean is pouring in. Four
or five of these gusts make me wish that the jib and flying-jib
were in. The sea is picking up, the gusts are growing
stronger and more frequent, and there is a splatter of wet in the
air. There is no use in attempting to gaze to
windward. The wall of blackness is within arm’s
length. Yet I cannot help attempting to see and gauge the
blows that are being struck at the <i>Snark</i>. There is
something ominous and menacing up there to windward, and I have a
feeling that if I look long enough and strong enough, I shall
divine it. Futile feeling. Between two gusts I leave
the wheel and run forward to the cabin companionway, where I
light matches and consult the barometer.
“29-90” it reads. That sensitive instrument
refuses to take notice of the disturbance which is humming with a
deep, throaty voice in the rigging. I get back to the wheel
just in time to meet another gust, the strongest yet. Well,
anyway, the wind is abeam and the <i>Snark</i> is on her course,
eating up easting. That at least is well.</p>
<p>The jib and flying-jib bother me, and I wish they were
in. She would make easier weather of it, and less risky
weather likewise. The wind snorts, and stray raindrops pelt
like birdshot. I shall certainly have to call all hands, I
conclude; then conclude the next instant to hang on a little
longer. Maybe this is the end of it, and I shall have
called them for nothing. It is better to let them
sleep. I hold the <i>Snark</i> down to her task, and from
out of the darkness, at right angles, comes a deluge of rain
accompanied by shrieking wind. Then everything eases except
the blackness, and I rejoice in that I have not called the
men.</p>
<p>No sooner does the wind ease than the sea picks up. The
combers are breaking now, and the boat is tossing like a
cork. Then out of the blackness the gusts come harder and
faster than before. If only I knew what was up there to
windward in the blackness! The <i>Snark</i> is making heavy
weather of it, and her lee-rail is buried oftener than not.
More shrieks and snorts of wind. Now, if ever, is the time
to call the men. I <i>will</i> call them, I resolve.
Then there is a burst of rain, a slackening of the wind, and I do
not call. But it is rather lonely, there at the wheel,
steering a little world through howling blackness. It is
quite a responsibility to be all alone on the surface of a little
world in time of stress, doing the thinking for its sleeping
inhabitants. I recoil from the responsibility as more gusts
begin to strike and as a sea licks along the weather rail and
splashes over into the cockpit. The salt water seems
strangely warm to my body and is shot through with ghostly
nodules of phosphorescent light. I shall surely call all
hands to shorten sail. Why should they sleep? I am a
fool to have any compunctions in the matter. My intellect
is arrayed against my heart. It was my heart that said,
“Let them sleep.” Yes, but it was my intellect
that backed up my heart in that judgment. Let my intellect
then reverse the judgment; and, while I am speculating as to what
particular entity issued that command to my intellect, the gusts
die away. Solicitude for mere bodily comfort has no place
in practical seamanship, I conclude sagely; but study the feel of
the next series of gusts and do not call the men. After
all, it <i>is</i> my intellect, behind everything,
procrastinating, measuring its knowledge of what the <i>Snark</i>
can endure against the blows being struck at her, and waiting the
call of all hands against the striking of still severer
blows.</p>
<p>Daylight, gray and violent, steals through the cloud-pall and
shows a foaming sea that flattens under the weight of recurrent
and increasing squalls. Then comes the rain, filling the
windy valleys of the sea with milky smoke and further flattening
the waves, which but wait for the easement of wind and rain to
leap more wildly than before. Come the men on deck, their
sleep out, and among them Hermann, his face on the broad grin in
appreciation of the breeze of wind I have picked up. I turn
the wheel over to Warren and start to go below, pausing on the
way to rescue the galley stovepipe which has gone adrift. I
am barefooted, and my toes have had an excellent education in the
art of clinging; but, as the rail buries itself in a green sea, I
suddenly sit down on the streaming deck. Hermann
good-naturedly elects to question my selection of such a
spot. Then comes the next roll, and he sits down, suddenly,
and without premeditation. The <i>Snark</i> heels over and
down, the rail takes it green, and Hermann and I, clutching the
precious stove-pipe, are swept down into the lee-scuppers.
After that I finish my journey below, and while changing my
clothes grin with satisfaction—the <i>Snark</i> is making
easting.</p>
<p>No, it is not all monotony. When we had worried along
our easting to 126° west longitude, we left the variables and
headed south through the doldrums, where was much calm weather
and where, taking advantage of every fan of air, we were often
glad to make a score of miles in as many hours. And yet, on
such a day, we might pass through a dozen squalls and be
surrounded by dozens more. And every squall was to be
regarded as a bludgeon capable of crushing the
<i>Snark</i>. We were struck sometimes by the centres and
sometimes by the sides of these squalls, and we never knew just
where or how we were to be hit. The squall that rose up,
covering half the heavens, and swept down upon us, as likely as
not split into two squalls which passed us harmlessly on either
side while the tiny, innocent looking squall that appeared to
carry no more than a hogshead of water and a pound of wind, would
abruptly assume cyclopean proportions, deluging us with rain and
overwhelming us with wind. Then there were treacherous
squalls that went boldly astern and sneaked back upon us from a
mile to leeward. Again, two squalls would tear along, one
on each side of us, and we would get a fillip from each of
them. Now a gale certainly grows tiresome after a few
hours, but squalls never. The thousandth squall in
one’s experience is as interesting as the first one, and
perhaps a bit more so. It is the tyro who has no
apprehension of them. The man of a thousand squalls
respects a squall. He knows what they are.</p>
<p>It was in the doldrums that our most exciting event
occurred. On November 20, we discovered that through an
accident we had lost over one-half of the supply of fresh water
that remained to us. Since we were at that time forty-three
days out from Hilo, our supply of fresh water was not
large. To lose over half of it was a catastrophe. On
close allowance, the remnant of water we possessed would last
twenty days. But we were in the doldrums; there was no
telling where the southeast trades were, nor where we would pick
them up.</p>
<p>The handcuffs were promptly put upon the pump, and once a day
the water was portioned out. Each of us received a quart
for personal use, and eight quarts were given to the cook.
Enters now the psychology of the situation. No sooner had
the discovery of the water shortage been made than I, for one,
was afflicted with a burning thirst. It seemed to me that I
had never been so thirsty in my life. My little quart of
water I could easily have drunk in one draught, and to refrain
from doing so required a severe exertion of will. Nor was I
alone in this. All of us talked water, thought water, and
dreamed water when we slept. We examined the charts for
possible islands to which to run in extremity, but there were no
such islands. The Marquesas were the nearest, and they were
the other side of the Line, and of the doldrums, too, which made
it even worse. We were in 3° north latitude, while the
Marquesas were 9° south latitude—a difference of over a
thousand miles. Furthermore, the Marquesas lay some
fourteen degrees to the west of our longitude. A pretty
pickle for a handful of creatures sweltering on the ocean in the
heat of tropic calms.</p>
<p>We rigged lines on either side between the main and mizzen
riggings. To these we laced the big deck awning, hoisting
it up aft with a sailing pennant so that any rain it might
collect would run forward where it could be caught. Here
and there squalls passed across the circle of the sea. All
day we watched them, now to port or starboard, and again ahead or
astern. But never one came near enough to wet us. In
the afternoon a big one bore down upon us. It spread out
across the ocean as it approached, and we could see it emptying
countless thousands of gallons into the salt sea. Extra
attention was paid to the awning and then we waited.
Warren, Martin, and Hermann made a vivid picture. Grouped
together, holding on to the rigging, swaying to the roll, they
were gazing intently at the squall. Strain, anxiety, and
yearning were in every posture of their bodies. Beside them
was the dry and empty awning. But they seemed to grow limp
and to droop as the squall broke in half, one part passing on
ahead, the other drawing astern and going to leeward.</p>
<p>But that night came rain. Martin, whose psychological
thirst had compelled him to drink his quart of water early, got
his mouth down to the lip of the awning and drank the deepest
draught I ever have seen drunk. The precious water came
down in bucketfuls and tubfuls, and in two hours we caught and
stored away in the tanks one hundred and twenty gallons.
Strange to say, in all the rest of our voyage to the Marquesas
not another drop of rain fell on board. If that squall had
missed us, the handcuffs would have remained on the pump, and we
would have busied ourselves with utilizing our surplus gasolene
for distillation purposes.</p>
<p>Then there was the fishing. One did not have to go in
search of it, for it was there at the rail. A three-inch
steel hook, on the end of a stout line, with a piece of white rag
for bait, was all that was necessary to catch bonitas weighing
from ten to twenty-five pounds. Bonitas feed on
flying-fish, wherefore they are unaccustomed to nibbling at the
hook. They strike as gamely as the gamest fish in the sea,
and their first run is something that no man who has ever caught
them will forget. Also, bonitas are the veriest
cannibals. The instant one is hooked he is attacked by his
fellows. Often and often we hauled them on board with
fresh, clean-bitten holes in them the size of teacups.</p>
<p>One school of bonitas, numbering many thousands, stayed with
us day and night for more than three weeks. Aided by the
<i>Snark</i>, it was great hunting; for they cut a swath of
destruction through the ocean half a mile wide and fifteen
hundred miles in length. They ranged along abreast of the
<i>Snark</i> on either side, pouncing upon the flying-fish her
forefoot scared up. Since they were continually pursuing
astern the flying-fish that survived for several flights, they
were always overtaking the <i>Snark</i>, and at any time one
could glance astern and on the front of a breaking wave see
scores of their silvery forms coasting down just under the
surface. When they had eaten their fill, it was their
delight to get in the shadow of the boat, or of her sails, and a
hundred or so were always to be seen lazily sliding along and
keeping cool.</p>
<p>But the poor flying-fish! Pursued and eaten alive by the
bonitas and dolphins, they sought flight in the air, where the
swooping seabirds drove them back into the water. Under
heaven there was no refuge for them. Flying-fish do not
play when they essay the air. It is a life-and-death affair
with them. A thousand times a day we could lift our eyes
and see the tragedy played out. The swift, broken circling
of a guny might attract one’s attention. A glance
beneath shows the back of a dolphin breaking the surface in a
wild rush. Just in front of its nose a shimmering palpitant
streak of silver shoots from the water into the air—a
delicate, organic mechanism of flight, endowed with sensation,
power of direction, and love of life. The guny swoops for
it and misses, and the flying-fish, gaining its altitude by
rising, kite-like, against the wind, turns in a half-circle and
skims off to leeward, gliding on the bosom of the wind.
Beneath it, the wake of the dolphin shows in churning foam.
So he follows, gazing upward with large eyes at the flashing
breakfast that navigates an element other than his own. He
cannot rise to so lofty occasion, but he is a thorough-going
empiricist, and he knows, sooner or later, if not gobbled up by
the guny, that the flying-fish must return to the water.
And then—breakfast. We used to pity the poor winged
fish. It was sad to see such sordid and bloody
slaughter. And then, in the night watches, when a forlorn
little flying-fish struck the mainsail and fell gasping and
splattering on the deck, we would rush for it just as eagerly,
just as greedily, just as voraciously, as the dolphins and
bonitas. For know that flying-fish are most toothsome for
breakfast. It is always a wonder to me that such dainty
meat does not build dainty tissue in the bodies of the
devourers. Perhaps the dolphins and bonitas are
coarser-fibred because of the high speed at which they drive
their bodies in order to catch their prey. But then again,
the flying-fish drive their bodies at high speed, too.</p>
<p>Sharks we caught occasionally, on large hooks, with
chain-swivels, bent on a length of small rope. And sharks
meant pilot-fish, and remoras, and various sorts of parasitic
creatures. Regular man-eaters some of the sharks proved,
tiger-eyed and with twelve rows of teeth, razor-sharp. By
the way, we of the <i>Snark</i> are agreed that we have eaten
many fish that will not compare with baked shark smothered in
tomato dressing. In the calms we occasionally caught a fish
called “haké” by the Japanese cook. And
once, on a spoon-hook trolling a hundred yards astern, we caught
a snake-like fish, over three feet in length and not more than
three inches in diameter, with four fangs in his jaw. He
proved the most delicious fish—delicious in meat and
flavour—that we have ever eaten on board.</p>
<p>The most welcome addition to our larder was a green
sea-turtle, weighing a full hundred pounds and appearing on the
table most appetizingly in steaks, soups, and stews, and finally
in a wonderful curry which tempted all hands into eating more
rice than was good for them. The turtle was sighted to
windward, calmly sleeping on the surface in the midst of a huge
school of curious dolphins. It was a deep-sea turtle of a
surety, for the nearest land was a thousand miles away. We
put the <i>Snark</i> about and went back for him, Hermann driving
the granes into his head and neck. When hauled aboard,
numerous remora were clinging to his shell, and out of the
hollows at the roots of his flippers crawled several large
crabs. It did not take the crew of the <i>Snark</i> longer
than the next meal to reach the unanimous conclusion that it
would willingly put the <i>Snark</i> about any time for a
turtle.</p>
<p>But it is the dolphin that is the king of deep-sea
fishes. Never is his colour twice quite the same.
Swimming in the sea, an ethereal creature of palest azure, he
displays in that one guise a miracle of colour. But it is
nothing compared with the displays of which he is capable.
At one time he will appear green—pale green, deep green,
phosphorescent green; at another time blue—deep blue,
electric blue, all the spectrum of blue. Catch him on a
hook, and he turns to gold, yellow gold, all gold. Haul him
on deck, and he excels the spectrum, passing through
inconceivable shades of blues, greens, and yellows, and then,
suddenly, turning a ghostly white, in the midst of which are
bright blue spots, and you suddenly discover that he is speckled
like a trout. Then back from white he goes, through all the
range of colours, finally turning to a mother-of-pearl.</p>
<p>For those who are devoted to fishing, I can recommend no finer
sport than catching dolphin. Of course, it must be done on
a thin line with reel and pole. A No. 7,
O’Shaughnessy tarpon hook is just the thing, baited with an
entire flying-fish. Like the bonita, the dolphin’s
fare consists of flying-fish, and he strikes like lightning at
the bait. The first warning is when the reel screeches and
you see the line smoking out at right angles to the boat.
Before you have time to entertain anxiety concerning the length
of your line, the fish rises into the air in a succession of
leaps. Since he is quite certain to be four feet long or
over, the sport of landing so gamey a fish can be realized.
When hooked, he invariably turns golden. The idea of the
series of leaps is to rid himself of the hook, and the man who
has made the strike must be of iron or decadent if his heart does
not beat with an extra flutter when he beholds such gorgeous
fish, glittering in golden mail and shaking itself like a
stallion in each mid-air leap. ’Ware slack! If
you don’t, on one of those leaps the hook will be flung out
and twenty feet away. No slack, and away he will go on
another run, culminating in another series of leaps. About
this time one begins to worry over the line, and to wish that he
had had nine hundred feet on the reel originally instead of six
hundred. With careful playing the line can be saved, and
after an hour of keen excitement the fish can be brought to
gaff. One such dolphin I landed on the <i>Snark</i>
measured four feet and seven inches.</p>
<p>Hermann caught dolphins more prosaically. A hand-line
and a chunk of shark-meat were all he needed. His hand-line
was very thick, but on more than one occasion it parted and lost
the fish. One day a dolphin got away with a lure of
Hermann’s manufacture, to which were lashed four
O’Shaughnessy hooks. Within an hour the same dolphin
was landed with the rod, and on dissecting him the four hooks
were recovered. The dolphins, which remained with us over a
month, deserted us north of the line, and not one was seen during
the remainder of the traverse.</p>
<p>So the days passed. There was so much to be done that
time never dragged. Had there been little to do, time could
not have dragged with such wonderful seascapes and
cloudscapes—dawns that were like burning imperial cities
under rainbows that arched nearly to the zenith; sunsets that
bathed the purple sea in rivers of rose-coloured light, flowing
from a sun whose diverging, heaven-climbing rays were of the
purest blue. Overside, in the heat of the day, the sea was
an azure satiny fabric, in the depths of which the sunshine
focussed in funnels of light. Astern, deep down, when there
was a breeze, bubbled a procession of milky-turquoise
ghosts—the foam flung down by the hull of the <i>Snark</i>
each time she floundered against a sea. At night the wake
was phosphorescent fire, where the medusa slime resented our
passing bulk, while far down could be observed the unceasing
flight of comets, with long, undulating, nebulous
tails—caused by the passage of the bonitas through the
resentful medusa slime. And now and again, from out of the
darkness on either hand, just under the surface, larger
phosphorescent organisms flashed up like electric lights, marking
collisions with the careless bonitas skurrying ahead to the good
hunting just beyond our bowsprit.</p>
<p>We made our easting, worked down through the doldrums, and
caught a fresh breeze out of south-by-west. Hauled up by
the wind, on such a slant, we would fetch past the Marquesas far
away to the westward. But the next day, on Tuesday,
November 26, in the thick of a heavy squall, the wind shifted
suddenly to the southeast. It was the trade at last.
There were no more squalls, naught but fine weather, a fair wind,
and a whirling log, with sheets slacked off and with spinnaker
and mainsail swaying and bellying on either side. The trade
backed more and more, until it blew out of the northeast, while
we steered a steady course to the southwest. Ten days of
this, and on the morning of December 6, at five o’clock, we
sighted land “just where it ought to have been,” dead
ahead. We passed to leeward of Ua-huka, skirted the
southern edge of Nuka-hiva, and that night, in driving squalls
and inky darkness, fought our way in to an anchorage in the
narrow bay of Taiohae. The anchor rumbled down to the
blatting of wild goats on the cliffs, and the air we breathed was
heavy with the perfume of flowers. The traverse was
accomplished. Sixty days from land to land, across a lonely
sea above whose horizons never rise the straining sails of
ships.</p>
<h2><SPAN name="chap10"></SPAN>CHAPTER X<br/> <span class="GutSmall">TYPEE</span></h2>
<p><span class="smcap">To</span> the eastward Ua-huka was being
blotted out by an evening rain-squall that was fast overtaking
the <i>Snark</i>. But that little craft, her big spinnaker
filled by the southeast trade, was making a good race of
it. Cape Martin, the southeasternmost point of Nuku-hiva,
was abeam, and Comptroller Bay was opening up as we fled past its
wide entrance, where Sail Rock, for all the world like the
spritsail of a Columbia River salmon-boat, was making brave
weather of it in the smashing southeast swell.</p>
<p>“What do you make that out to be?” I asked
Hermann, at the wheel.</p>
<p>“A fishing-boat, sir,” he answered after careful
scrutiny.</p>
<p>Yet on the chart it was plainly marked, “Sail
Rock.”</p>
<p>But we were more interested in the recesses of Comptroller
Bay, where our eyes eagerly sought out the three bights of land
and centred on the midmost one, where the gathering twilight
showed the dim walls of a valley extending inland. How
often we had pored over the chart and centred always on that
midmost bight and on the valley it opened—the Valley of
Typee. “Taipi” the chart spelled it, and
spelled it correctly, but I prefer “Typee,” and I
shall always spell it “Typee.” When I was a
little boy, I read a book spelled in that manner—Herman
Melville’s “Typee”; and many long hours I
dreamed over its pages. Nor was it all dreaming. I
resolved there and then, mightily, come what would, that when I
had gained strength and years, I, too, would voyage to
Typee. For the wonder of the world was penetrating to my
tiny consciousness—the wonder that was to lead me to many
lands, and that leads and never pails. The years passed,
but Typee was not forgotten. Returned to San Francisco from
a seven months’ cruise in the North Pacific, I decided the
time had come. The brig <i>Galilee</i> was sailing for the
Marquesas, but her crew was complete and I, who was an
able-seaman before the mast and young enough to be overweeningly
proud of it, was willing to condescend to ship as cabin-boy in
order to make the pilgrimage to Typee. Of course, the
<i>Galilee</i> would have sailed from the Marquesas without me,
for I was bent on finding another Fayaway and another
Kory-Kory. I doubt that the captain read desertion in my
eye. Perhaps even the berth of cabin-boy was already
filled. At any rate, I did not get it.</p>
<p>Then came the rush of years, filled brimming with projects,
achievements, and failures; but Typee was not forgotten, and here
I was now, gazing at its misty outlines till the squall swooped
down and the <i>Snark</i> dashed on into the driving
smother. Ahead, we caught a glimpse and took the compass
bearing of Sentinel Rock, wreathed with pounding surf. Then
it, too, was effaced by the rain and darkness. We steered
straight for it, trusting to hear the sound of breakers in time
to sheer clear. We had to steer for it. We had naught
but a compass bearing with which to orientate ourselves, and if
we missed Sentinel Rock, we missed Taiohae Bay, and we would have
to throw the <i>Snark</i> up to the wind and lie off and on the
whole night—no pleasant prospect for voyagers weary from a
sixty days’ traverse of the vast Pacific solitude, and
land-hungry, and fruit-hungry, and hungry with an appetite of
years for the sweet vale of Typee.</p>
<p>Abruptly, with a roar of sound, Sentinel Rock loomed through
the rain dead ahead. We altered our course, and, with
mainsail and spinnaker bellying to the squall, drove past.
Under the lea of the rock the wind dropped us, and we rolled in
an absolute calm. Then a puff of air struck us, right in
our teeth, out of Taiohae Bay. It was in spinnaker, up
mizzen, all sheets by the wind, and we were moving slowly ahead,
heaving the lead and straining our eyes for the fixed red light
on the ruined fort that would give us our bearings to
anchorage. The air was light and baffling, now east, now
west, now north, now south; while from either hand came the roar
of unseen breakers. From the looming cliffs arose the
blatting of wild goats, and overhead the first stars were peeping
mistily through the ragged train of the passing squall. At
the end of two hours, having come a mile into the bay, we dropped
anchor in eleven fathoms. And so we came to Taiohae.</p>
<p>In the morning we awoke in fairyland. The <i>Snark</i>
rested in a placid harbour that nestled in a vast amphitheatre,
the towering, vine-clad walls of which seemed to rise directly
from the water. Far up, to the east, we glimpsed the thin
line of a trail, visible in one place, where it scoured across
the face of the wall.</p>
<p>“The path by which Toby escaped from Typee!” we
cried.</p>
<p>We were not long in getting ashore and astride horses, though
the consummation of our pilgrimage had to be deferred for a
day. Two months at sea, bare-footed all the time, without
space in which to exercise one’s limbs, is not the best
preliminary to leather shoes and walking. Besides, the land
had to cease its nauseous rolling before we could feel fit for
riding goat-like horses over giddy trails. So we took a
short ride to break in, and crawled through thick jungle to make
the acquaintance of a venerable moss-grown idol, where had
foregathered a German trader and a Norwegian captain to estimate
the weight of said idol, and to speculate upon depreciation in
value caused by sawing him in half. They treated the old
fellow sacrilegiously, digging their knives into him to see how
hard he was and how deep his mossy mantle, and commanding him to
rise up and save them trouble by walking down to the ship
himself. In lieu of which, nineteen Kanakas slung him on a
frame of timbers and toted him to the ship, where, battened down
under hatches, even now he is cleaving the South Pacific Hornward
and toward Europe—the ultimate abiding-place for all good
heathen idols, save for the few in America and one in particular
who grins beside me as I write, and who, barring shipwreck, will
grin somewhere in my neighbourhood until I die. And he will
win out. He will be grinning when I am dust.</p>
<p>Also, as a preliminary, we attended a feast, where one Taiara
Tamarii, the son of an Hawaiian sailor who deserted from a
whaleship, commemorated the death of his Marquesan mother by
roasting fourteen whole hogs and inviting in the village.
So we came along, welcomed by a native herald, a young girl, who
stood on a great rock and chanted the information that the
banquet was made perfect by our presence—which information
she extended impartially to every arrival. Scarcely were we
seated, however, when she changed her tune, while the company
manifested intense excitement. Her cries became eager and
piercing. From a distance came answering cries, in
men’s voices, which blended into a wild, barbaric chant
that sounded incredibly savage, smacking of blood and war.
Then, through vistas of tropical foliage appeared a procession of
savages, naked save for gaudy loin-cloths. They advanced
slowly, uttering deep guttural cries of triumph and
exaltation. Slung from young saplings carried on their
shoulders were mysterious objects of considerable weight, hidden
from view by wrappings of green leaves.</p>
<p>Nothing but pigs, innocently fat and roasted to a turn, were
inside those wrappings, but the men were carrying them into camp
in imitation of old times when they carried in
“long-pig.” Now long-pig is not pig.
Long-pig is the Polynesian euphemism for human flesh; and these
descendants of man-eaters, a king’s son at their head,
brought in the pigs to table as of old their grandfathers had
brought in their slain enemies. Every now and then the
procession halted in order that the bearers should have every
advantage in uttering particularly ferocious shouts of victory,
of contempt for their enemies, and of gustatory desire. So
Melville, two generations ago, witnessed the bodies of slain
Happar warriors, wrapped in palm-leaves, carried to banquet at
the Ti. At another time, at the Ti, he “observed a
curiously carved vessel of wood,” and on looking into it
his eyes “fell upon the disordered members of a human
skeleton, the bones still fresh with moisture, and with particles
of flesh clinging to them here and there.”</p>
<p>Cannibalism has often been regarded as a fairy story by
ultracivilized men who dislike, perhaps, the notion that their
own savage forebears have somewhere in the past been addicted to
similar practices. Captain Cook was rather sceptical upon
the subject, until, one day, in a harbour of New Zealand, he
deliberately tested the matter. A native happened to have
brought on board, for sale, a nice, sun-dried head. At
Cook’s orders strips of the flesh were cut away and handed
to the native, who greedily devoured them. To say the
least, Captain Cook was a rather thorough-going empiricist.
At any rate, by that act he supplied one ascertained fact of
which science had been badly in need. Little did he dream
of the existence of a certain group of islands, thousands of
miles away, where in subsequent days there would arise a curious
suit at law, when an old chief of Maui would be charged with
defamation of character because he persisted in asserting that
his body was the living repository of Captain Cook’s great
toe. It is said that the plaintiffs failed to prove that
the old chief was not the tomb of the navigator’s great
toe, and that the suit was dismissed.</p>
<p>I suppose I shall not have the chance in these degenerate days
to see any long-pig eaten, but at least I am already the
possessor of a duly certified Marquesan calabash, oblong in
shape, curiously carved, over a century old, from which has been
drunk the blood of two shipmasters. One of those captains
was a mean man. He sold a decrepit whale-boat, as good as
new what of the fresh white paint, to a Marquesan chief.
But no sooner had the captain sailed away than the whale-boat
dropped to pieces. It was his fortune, some time
afterwards, to be wrecked, of all places, on that particular
island. The Marquesan chief was ignorant of rebates and
discounts; but he had a primitive sense of equity and an equally
primitive conception of the economy of nature, and he balanced
the account by eating the man who had cheated him.</p>
<p>We started in the cool dawn for Typee, astride ferocious
little stallions that pawed and screamed and bit and fought one
another quite oblivious of the fragile humans on their backs and
of the slippery boulders, loose rocks, and yawning gorges.
The way led up an ancient road through a jungle of <i>hau</i>
trees. On every side were the vestiges of a one-time dense
population. Wherever the eye could penetrate the thick
growth, glimpses were caught of stone walls and of stone
foundations, six to eight feet in height, built solidly
throughout, and many yards in width and depth. They formed
great stone platforms, upon which, at one time, there had been
houses. But the houses and the people were gone, and huge
trees sank their roots through the platforms and towered over the
under-running jungle. These foundations are called
<i>pae-paes</i>—the <i>pi-pis</i> of Melville, who spelled
phonetically.</p>
<p>The Marquesans of the present generation lack the energy to
hoist and place such huge stones. Also, they lack
incentive. There are plenty of <i>pae-paes</i> to go
around, with a few thousand unoccupied ones left over. Once
or twice, as we ascended the valley, we saw magnificent
<i>pae-paes</i> bearing on their general surface pitiful little
straw huts, the proportions being similar to a voting booth
perched on the broad foundation of the Pyramid of Cheops.
For the Marquesans are perishing, and, to judge from conditions
at Taiohae, the one thing that retards their destruction is the
infusion of fresh blood. A pure Marquesan is a
rarity. They seem to be all half-breeds and strange
conglomerations of dozens of different races. Nineteen able
labourers are all the trader at Taiohae can muster for the
loading of copra on shipboard, and in their veins runs the blood
of English, American, Dane, German, French, Corsican, Spanish,
Portuguese, Chinese, Hawaiian, Paumotan, Tahitian, and Easter
Islander. There are more races than there are persons, but
it is a wreckage of races at best. Life faints and stumbles
and gasps itself away. In this warm, equable clime—a
truly terrestrial paradise—where are never extremes of
temperature and where the air is like balm, kept ever pure by the
ozone-laden southeast trade, asthma, phthisis, and tuberculosis
flourish as luxuriantly as the vegetation. Everywhere, from
the few grass huts, arises the racking cough or exhausted groan
of wasted lungs. Other horrible diseases prosper as well,
but the most deadly of all are those that attack the lungs.
There is a form of consumption called “galloping,”
which is especially dreaded. In two months’ time it
reduces the strongest man to a skeleton under a
grave-cloth. In valley after valley the last inhabitant has
passed and the fertile soil has relapsed to jungle. In
Melville’s day the valley of Hapaa (spelled by him
“Happar”) was peopled by a strong and warlike
tribe. A generation later, it contained but two hundred
persons. To-day it is an untenanted, howling, tropical
wilderness.</p>
<p>We climbed higher and higher in the valley, our unshod
stallions picking their steps on the disintegrating trail, which
led in and out through the abandoned <i>pae-paes</i> and
insatiable jungle. The sight of red mountain apples, the
<i>ohias</i>, familiar to us from Hawaii, caused a native to be
sent climbing after them. And again he climbed for
cocoa-nuts. I have drunk the cocoanuts of Jamaica and of
Hawaii, but I never knew how delicious such draught could be till
I drank it here in the Marquesas. Occasionally we rode
under wild limes and oranges—great trees which had survived
the wilderness longer than the motes of humans who had cultivated
them.</p>
<p>We rode through endless thickets of yellow-pollened
cassi—if riding it could be called; for those fragrant
thickets were inhabited by wasps. And such wasps!
Great yellow fellows the size of small canary birds, darting
through the air with behind them drifting a bunch of legs a
couple of inches long. A stallion abruptly stands on his
forelegs and thrusts his hind legs skyward. He withdraws
them from the sky long enough to make one wild jump ahead, and
then returns them to their index position. It is
nothing. His thick hide has merely been punctured by a
flaming lance of wasp virility. Then a second and a third
stallion, and all the stallions, begin to cavort on their
forelegs over the precipitous landscape. Swat! A
white-hot poniard penetrates my cheek. Swat again!! I
am stabbed in the neck. I am bringing up the rear and
getting more than my share. There is no retreat, and the
plunging horses ahead, on a precarious trail, promise little
safety. My horse overruns Charmian’s horse, and that
sensitive creature, fresh-stung at the psychological moment,
planks one of his hoofs into my horse and the other hoof into
me. I thank my stars that he is not steel-shod, and
half-arise from the saddle at the impact of another flaming
dagger. I am certainly getting more than my share, and so
is my poor horse, whose pain and panic are only exceeded by
mine.</p>
<p>“Get out of the way! I’m coming!” I
shout, frantically dashing my cap at the winged vipers around
me.</p>
<p>On one side of the trail the landscape rises straight
up. On the other side it sinks straight down. The
only way to get out of my way is to keep on going. How that
string of horses kept their feet is a miracle; but they dashed
ahead, over-running one another, galloping, trotting, stumbling,
jumping, scrambling, and kicking methodically skyward every time
a wasp landed on them. After a while we drew breath and
counted our injuries. And this happened not once, nor
twice, but time after time. Strange to say, it never grew
monotonous. I know that I, for one, came through each brush
with the undiminished zest of a man flying from sudden
death. No; the pilgrim from Taiohae to Typee will never
suffer from <i>ennui</i> on the way.</p>
<p>At last we arose above the vexation of wasps. It was a
matter of altitude, however, rather than of fortitude. All
about us lay the jagged back-bones of ranges, as far as the eye
could see, thrusting their pinnacles into the trade-wind
clouds. Under us, from the way we had come, the
<i>Snark</i> lay like a tiny toy on the calm water of Taiohae
Bay. Ahead we could see the inshore indentation of
Comptroller Bay. We dropped down a thousand feet, and Typee
lay beneath us. “Had a glimpse of the gardens of
paradise been revealed to me I could scarcely have been more
ravished with the sight”—so said Melville on the
moment of his first view of the valley. He saw a
garden. We saw a wilderness. Where were the hundred
groves of the breadfruit tree he saw? We saw jungle,
nothing but jungle, with the exception of two grass huts and
several clumps of cocoanuts breaking the primordial green
mantle. Where was the <i>Ti</i> of Mehevi, the
bachelors’ hall, the palace where women were taboo, and
where he ruled with his lesser chieftains, keeping the half-dozen
dusty and torpid ancients to remind them of the valorous
past? From the swift stream no sounds arose of maids and
matrons pounding <i>tapa</i>. And where was the hut that
old Narheyo eternally builded? In vain I looked for him
perched ninety feet from the ground in some tall cocoanut, taking
his morning smoke.</p>
<p>We went down a zigzag trail under overarching, matted jungle,
where great butterflies drifted by in the silence. No
tattooed savage with club and javelin guarded the path; and when
we forded the stream, we were free to roam where we
pleased. No longer did the taboo, sacred and merciless,
reign in that sweet vale. Nay, the taboo still did reign, a
new taboo, for when we approached too near the several wretched
native women, the taboo was uttered warningly. And it was
well. They were lepers. The man who warned us was
afflicted horribly with elephantiasis. All were suffering
from lung trouble. The valley of Typee was the abode of
death, and the dozen survivors of the tribe were gasping feebly
the last painful breaths of the race.</p>
<p>Certainly the battle had not been to the strong, for once the
Typeans were very strong, stronger than the Happars, stronger
than the Taiohaeans, stronger than all the tribes of
Nuku-hiva. The word “typee,” or, rather,
“taipi,” originally signified an eater of human
flesh. But since all the Marquesans were human-flesh
eaters, to be so designated was the token that the Typeans were
the human-flesh eaters par excellence. Not alone to
Nuku-hiva did the Typean reputation for bravery and ferocity
extend. In all the islands of the Marquesas the Typeans
were named with dread. Man could not conquer them.
Even the French fleet that took possession of the Marquesas left
the Typeans alone. Captain Porter, of the frigate
<i>Essex</i>, once invaded the valley. His sailors and
marines were reinforced by two thousand warriors of Happar and
Taiohae. They penetrated quite a distance into the valley,
but met with so fierce a resistance that they were glad to
retreat and get away in their flotilla of boats and
war-canoes.</p>
<p>Of all inhabitants of the South Seas, the Marquesans were
adjudged the strongest and the most beautiful. Melville
said of them: “I was especially struck by the physical
strength and beauty they displayed . . . In beauty of form they
surpassed anything I had ever seen. Not a single instance
of natural deformity was observable in all the throng attending
the revels. Every individual appeared free from those
blemishes which sometimes mar the effect of an otherwise perfect
form. But their physical excellence did not merely consist
in an exemption from these evils; nearly every individual of the
number might have been taken for a sculptor’s
model.” Mendaña, the discoverer of the
Marquesas, described the natives as wondrously beautiful to
behold. Figueroa, the chronicler of his voyage, said of
them: “In complexion they were nearly white; of good
stature and finely formed.” Captain Cook called the
Marquesans the most splendid islanders in the South Seas.
The men were described, as “in almost every instance of
lofty stature, scarcely ever less than six feet in
height.”</p>
<p>And now all this strength and beauty has departed, and the
valley of Typee is the abode of some dozen wretched creatures,
afflicted by leprosy, elephantiasis, and tuberculosis.
Melville estimated the population at two thousand, not taking
into consideration the small adjoining valley of Ho-o-u-mi.
Life has rotted away in this wonderful garden spot, where the
climate is as delightful and healthful as any to be found in the
world. Not alone were the Typeans physically magnificent;
they were pure. Their air did not contain the bacilli and
germs and microbes of disease that fill our own air. And
when the white men imported in their ships these various
micro-organisms or disease, the Typeans crumpled up and went down
before them.</p>
<p>When one considers the situation, one is almost driven to the
conclusion that the white race flourishes on impurity and
corruption. Natural selection, however, gives the
explanation. We of the white race are the survivors and the
descendants of the thousands of generations of survivors in the
war with the micro-organisms. Whenever one of us was born
with a constitution peculiarly receptive to these minute enemies,
such a one promptly died. Only those of us survived who
could withstand them. We who are alive are the immune, the
fit—the ones best constituted to live in a world of hostile
micro-organisms. The poor Marquesans had undergone no such
selection. They were not immune. And they, who had
made a custom of eating their enemies, were now eaten by enemies
so microscopic as to be invisible, and against whom no war of
dart and javelin was possible. On the other hand, had there
been a few hundred thousand Marquesans to begin with, there might
have been sufficient survivors to lay the foundation for a new
race—a regenerated race, if a plunge into a festering bath
of organic poison can be called regeneration.</p>
<p>We unsaddled our horses for lunch, and after we had fought the
stallions apart—mine with several fresh chunks bitten out
of his back—and after we had vainly fought the sand-flies,
we ate bananas and tinned meats, washed down by generous draughts
of cocoanut milk. There was little to be seen. The
jungle had rushed back and engulfed the puny works of man.
Here and there <i>pai-pais</i> were to be stumbled upon, but
there were no inscriptions, no hieroglyphics, no clues to the
past they attested—only dumb stones, builded and carved by
hands that were forgotten dust. Out of the <i>pai-pais</i>
grew great trees, jealous of the wrought work of man, splitting
and scattering the stones back into the primeval chaos.</p>
<p>We gave up the jungle and sought the stream with the idea of
evading the sand-flies. Vain hope! To go in swimming
one must take off his clothes. The sand-flies are aware of
the fact, and they lurk by the river bank in countless
myriads. In the native they are called the <i>nau-nau</i>,
which is pronounced “now-now.” They are
certainly well named, for they are the insistent present.
There is no past nor future when they fasten upon one’s
epidermis, and I am willing to wager that Omer Khayyám
could never have written the Rubáiyat in the valley of
Typee—it would have been psychologically impossible.
I made the strategic mistake of undressing on the edge of a steep
bank where I could dive in but could not climb out. When I
was ready to dress, I had a hundred yards’ walk on the bank
before I could reach my clothes. At the first step, fully
ten thousand <i>nau-naus</i> landed upon me. At the second
step I was walking in a cloud. By the third step the sun
was dimmed in the sky. After that I don’t know what
happened. When I arrived at my clothes, I was a
maniac. And here enters my grand tactical error.
There is only one rule of conduct in dealing with
<i>nau-naus</i>. Never swat them. Whatever you do,
don’t swat them. They are so vicious that in the
instant of annihilation they eject their last atom of poison into
your carcass. You must pluck them delicately, between thumb
and forefinger, and persuade them gently to remove their
proboscides from your quivering flesh. It is like pulling
teeth. But the difficulty was that the teeth sprouted
faster than I could pull them, so I swatted, and, so doing,
filled myself full with their poison. This was a week
ago. At the present moment I resemble a sadly neglected
smallpox convalescent.</p>
<p>Ho-o-u-mi is a small valley, separated from Typee by a low
ridge, and thither we started when we had knocked our indomitable
and insatiable riding-animals into submission. As it was,
Warren’s mount, after a mile run, selected the most
dangerous part of the trail for an exhibition that kept us all on
the anxious seat for fully five minutes. We rode by the
mouth of Typee valley and gazed down upon the beach from which
Melville escaped. There was where the whale-boat lay on its
oars close in to the surf; and there was where Karakoee, the
taboo Kanaka, stood in the water and trafficked for the
sailor’s life. There, surely, was where Melville gave
Fayaway the parting embrace ere he dashed for the boat. And
there was the point of land from which Mehevi and Mow-mow and
their following swam off to intercept the boat, only to have
their wrists gashed by sheath-knives when they laid hold of the
gunwale, though it was reserved for Mow-mow to receive the
boat-hook full in the throat from Melville’s hands.</p>
<p>We rode on to Ho-o-u-mi. So closely was Melville guarded
that he never dreamed of the existence of this valley, though he
must continually have met its inhabitants, for they belonged to
Typee. We rode through the same abandoned <i>pae-paes</i>,
but as we neared the sea we found a profusion of cocoanuts,
breadfruit trees and taro patches, and fully a dozen grass
dwellings. In one of these we arranged to pass the night,
and preparations were immediately put on foot for a feast.
A young pig was promptly despatched, and while he was being
roasted among hot stones, and while chickens were stewing in
cocoanut milk, I persuaded one of the cooks to climb an unusually
tall cocoanut palm. The cluster of nuts at the top was
fully one hundred and twenty-five feet from the ground, but that
native strode up to the tree, seized it in both hands,
jack-knived at the waist so that the soles of his feet rested
flatly against the trunk, and then he walked right straight up
without stopping. There were no notches in the tree.
He had no ropes to help him. He merely walked up the tree,
one hundred and twenty-five feet in the air, and cast down the
nuts from the summit. Not every man there had the physical
stamina for such a feat, or the lungs, rather, for most of them
were coughing their lives away. Some of the women kept up a
ceaseless moaning and groaning, so badly were their lungs
wasted. Very few of either sex were full-blooded
Marquesans. They were mostly half-breeds and
three-quarter-breeds of French, English, Danish, and Chinese
extraction. At the best, these infusions of fresh blood
merely delayed the passing, and the results led one to wonder
whether it was worth while.</p>
<p>The feast was served on a broad <i>pae-pae</i>, the rear
portion of which was occupied by the house in which we were to
sleep. The first course was raw fish and <i>poi-poi</i>,
the latter sharp and more acrid of taste than the <i>poi</i> of
Hawaii, which is made from taro. The <i>poi-poi</i> of the
Marquesas is made from breadfruit. The ripe fruit, after
the core is removed, is placed in a calabash and pounded with a
stone pestle into a stiff, sticky paste. In this stage of
the process, wrapped in leaves, it can be buried in the ground,
where it will keep for years. Before it can be eaten,
however, further processes are necessary. A leaf-covered
package is placed among hot stones, like the pig, and thoroughly
baked. After that it is mixed with cold water and thinned
out—not thin enough to run, but thin enough to be eaten by
sticking one’s first and second fingers into it. On
close acquaintance it proves a pleasant and most healthful
food. And breadfruit, ripe and well boiled or
roasted! It is delicious. Breadfruit and taro are
kingly vegetables, the pair of them, though the former is
patently a misnomer and more resembles a sweet potato than
anything else, though it is not mealy like a sweet potato, nor is
it so sweet.</p>
<p>The feast ended, we watched the moon rise over Typee.
The air was like balm, faintly scented with the breath of
flowers. It was a magic night, deathly still, without the
slightest breeze to stir the foliage; and one caught one’s
breath and felt the pang that is almost hurt, so exquisite was
the beauty of it. Faint and far could be heard the thin
thunder of the surf upon the beach. There were no beds; and
we drowsed and slept wherever we thought the floor softest.
Near by, a woman panted and moaned in her sleep, and all about us
the dying islanders coughed in the night.</p>
<h2><SPAN name="chap11"></SPAN>CHAPTER XI<br/> <span class="GutSmall">THE NATURE MAN</span></h2>
<p>I <span class="smcap">first</span> met him on Market Street in
San Francisco. It was a wet and drizzly afternoon, and he
was striding along, clad solely in a pair of abbreviated
knee-trousers and an abbreviated shirt, his bare feet going
slick-slick through the pavement-slush. At his heels
trooped a score of excited gamins. Every head—and
there were thousands—turned to glance curiously at him as
he went by. And I turned, too. Never had I seen such
lovely sunburn. He was all sunburn, of the sort a blond
takes on when his skin does not peel. His long yellow hair
was burnt, so was his beard, which sprang from a soil unploughed
by any razor. He was a tawny man, a golden-tawny man, all
glowing and radiant with the sun. Another prophet, thought
I, come up to town with a message that will save the world.</p>
<p>A few weeks later I was with some friends in their bungalow in
the Piedmont hills overlooking San Francisco Bay.
“We’ve got him, we’ve got him,” they
barked. “We caught him up a tree; but he’s all
right now, he’ll feed from the hand. Come on and see
him.” So I accompanied them up a dizzy hill, and in a
rickety shack in the midst of a eucalyptus grove found my
sunburned prophet of the city pavements.</p>
<p>He hastened to meet us, arriving in the whirl and blur of a
handspring. He did not shake hands with us; instead, his
greeting took the form of stunts. He turned more
handsprings. He twisted his body sinuously, like a snake,
until, having sufficiently limbered up, he bent from the hips,
and, with legs straight and knees touching, beat a tattoo on the
ground with the palms of his hands. He whirligigged and
pirouetted, dancing and cavorting round like an inebriated
ape. All the sun-warmth of his ardent life beamed in his
face. I am so happy, was the song without words he
sang.</p>
<p>He sang it all evening, ringing the changes on it with an
endless variety of stunts. “A fool! a fool! I
met a fool in the forest!” thought I, and a worthy fool he
proved. Between handsprings and whirligigs he delivered his
message that would save the world. It was twofold.
First, let suffering humanity strip off its clothing and run wild
in the mountains and valleys; and, second, let the very miserable
world adopt phonetic spelling. I caught a glimpse of the
great social problems being settled by the city populations
swarming naked over the landscape, to the popping of shot-guns,
the barking of ranch-dogs, and countless assaults with pitchforks
wielded by irate farmers.</p>
<p>The years passed, and, one sunny morning, the <i>Snark</i>
poked her nose into a narrow opening in a reef that smoked with
the crashing impact of the trade-wind swell, and beat slowly up
Papeete harbour. Coming off to us was a boat, flying a
yellow flag. We knew it contained the port doctor.
But quite a distance off, in its wake, was a tiny out rigger
canoe that puzzled us. It was flying a red flag. I
studied it through the glasses, fearing that it marked some
hidden danger to navigation, some recent wreck or some buoy or
beacon that had been swept away. Then the doctor came on
board. After he had examined the state of our health and
been assured that we had no live rats hidden away in the
<i>Snark</i>, I asked him the meaning of the red flag.
“Oh, that is Darling,” was the answer.</p>
<p>And then Darling, Ernest Darling flying the red flag that is
indicative of the brotherhood of man, hailed us.
“Hello, Jack!” he called. “Hello,
Charmian!” He paddled swiftly nearer, and I saw that
he was the tawny prophet of the Piedmont hills. He came
over the side, a sun-god clad in a scarlet loin-cloth, with
presents of Arcady and greeting in both his hands—a bottle
of golden honey and a leaf-basket filled <i>with</i> great golden
mangoes, golden bananas specked with freckles of deeper gold,
golden pine-apples and golden limes, and juicy oranges minted
from the same precious ore of sun and soil. And in this
fashion under the southern sky, I met once more Darling, the
Nature Man.</p>
<p>Tahiti is one of the most beautiful spots in the world,
inhabited by thieves and robbers and liars, also by several
honest and truthful men and women. Wherefore, because of
the blight cast upon Tahiti’s wonderful beauty by the
spidery human vermin that infest it, I am minded to write, not of
Tahiti, but of the Nature Man. He, at least, is refreshing
and wholesome. The spirit that emanates from him is so
gentle and sweet that it would harm nothing, hurt nobody’s
feelings save the feelings of a predatory and plutocratic
capitalist.</p>
<p>“What does this red flag mean?” I asked.</p>
<p>“Socialism, of course.”</p>
<p>“Yes, yes, I know that,” I went on; “but
what does it mean in your hands?”</p>
<p>“Why, that I’ve found my message.”</p>
<p>“And that you are delivering it to Tahiti?” I
demanded incredulously.</p>
<p>“Sure,” he answered simply; and later on I found
that he was, too.</p>
<p>When we dropped anchor, lowered a small boat into the water,
and started ashore, the Nature Man joined us. Now, thought
I, I shall be pestered to death by this crank. Waking or
sleeping I shall never be quit of him until I sail away from
here.</p>
<p>But never in my life was I more mistaken. I took a house
and went to live and work in it, and the Nature Man never came
near me. He was waiting for the invitation. In the
meantime he went aboard the <i>Snark</i> and took possession of
her library, delighted by the quantity of scientific books, and
shocked, as I learned afterwards, by the inordinate amount of
fiction. The Nature Man never wastes time on fiction.</p>
<p>After a week or so, my conscience smote me, and I invited him
to dinner at a downtown hotel.</p>
<p>He arrived, looking unwontedly stiff and uncomfortable in a
cotton jacket. When invited to peel it off, he beamed his
gratitude and joy, and did so, revealing his sun-gold skin, from
waist to shoulder, covered only by a piece of fish-net of coarse
twine and large of mesh. A scarlet loin-cloth completed his
costume. I began my acquaintance with him that night, and
during my long stay in Tahiti that acquaintance ripened into
friendship.</p>
<p>“So you write books,” he said, one day when, tired
and sweaty, I finished my morning’s work.</p>
<p>“I, too, write books,” he announced.</p>
<p>Aha, thought I, now at last is he going to pester me with his
literary efforts. My soul was in revolt. I had not
come all the way to the South Seas to be a literary bureau.</p>
<p>“This is the book I write,” he explained, smashing
himself a resounding blow on the chest with his clenched
fist. “The gorilla in the African jungle pounds his
chest till the noise of it can be heard half a mile
away.”</p>
<p>“A pretty good chest,” quoth I, admiringly;
“it would even make a gorilla envious.”</p>
<p>And then, and later, I learned the details of the marvellous
book Ernest Darling had written. Twelve years ago he lay
close to death. He weighed but ninety pounds, and was too
weak to speak. The doctors had given him up. His
father, a practising physician, had given him up.
Consultations with other physicians had been held upon him.
There was no hope for him. Overstudy (as a school-teacher
and as a university student) and two successive attacks of
pneumonia were responsible for his breakdown. Day by day he
was losing strength. He could extract no nutrition from the
heavy foods they gave him; nor could pellets and powders help his
stomach to do the work of digestion. Not only was he a
physical wreck, but he was a mental wreck. His mind was
overwrought. He was sick and tired of medicine, and he was
sick and tired of persons. Human speech jarred upon
him. Human attentions drove him frantic. The thought
came to him that since he was going to die, he might as well die
in the open, away from all the bother and irritation. And
behind this idea lurked a sneaking idea that perhaps he would not
die after all if only he could escape from the heavy foods, the
medicines, and the well-intentioned persons who made him
frantic.</p>
<p>So Ernest Darling, a bag of bones and a death’s-head, a
perambulating corpse, with just the dimmest flutter of life in it
to make it perambulate, turned his back upon men and the
habitations of men and dragged himself for five miles through the
brush, away from the city of Portland, Oregon. Of course he
was crazy. Only a lunatic would drag himself out of his
death-bed.</p>
<p>But in the brush, Darling found what he was looking
for—rest. Nobody bothered him with beefsteaks and
pork. No physicians lacerated his tired nerves by feeling
his pulse, nor tormented his tired stomach with pellets and
powders. He began to feel soothed. The sun was
shining warm, and he basked in it. He had the feeling that
the sun shine was an elixir of health. Then it seemed to
him that his whole wasted wreck of a body was crying for the
sun. He stripped off his clothes and bathed in the
sunshine. He felt better. It had done him
good—the first relief in weary months of pain.</p>
<p>As he grew better, he sat up and began to take notice.
All about him were the birds fluttering and chirping, the
squirrels chattering and playing. He envied them their
health and spirits, their happy, care-free existence. That
he should contrast their condition with his was inevitable; and
that he should question why they were splendidly vigorous while
he was a feeble, dying wraith of a man, was likewise
inevitable. His conclusion was the very obvious one,
namely, that they lived naturally, while he lived most
unnaturally; therefore, if he intended to live, he must return to
nature.</p>
<p>Alone, there in the brush, he worked out his problem and began
to apply it. He stripped off his clothing and leaped and
gambolled about, running on all fours, climbing trees; in short,
doing physical stunts,—and all the time soaking in the
sunshine. He imitated the animals. He built a nest of
dry leaves and grasses in which to sleep at night, covering it
over with bark as a protection against the early fall
rains. “Here is a beautiful exercise,” he told
me, once, flapping his arms mightily against his sides; “I
learned it from watching the roosters crow.” Another
time I remarked the loud, sucking intake with which he drank
cocoanut-milk. He explained that he had noticed the cows
drinking that way and concluded there must be something in
it. He tried it and found it good, and thereafter he drank
only in that fashion.</p>
<p>He noted that the squirrels lived on fruits and nuts. He
started on a fruit-and-nut diet, helped out by bread, and he grew
stronger and put on weight. For three months he continued
his primordial existence in the brush, and then the heavy Oregon
rains drove him back to the habitations of men. Not in
three months could a ninety-pound survivor of two attacks of
pneumonia develop sufficient ruggedness to live through an Oregon
winter in the open.</p>
<p>He had accomplished much, but he had been driven in.
There was no place to go but back to his father’s house,
and there, living in close rooms with lungs that panted for all
the air of the open sky, he was brought down by a third attack of
pneumonia. He grew weaker even than before. In that
tottering tabernacle of flesh, his brain collapsed. He lay
like a corpse, too weak to stand the fatigue of speaking, too
irritated and tired in his miserable brain to care to listen to
the speech of others. The only act of will of which he was
capable was to stick his fingers in his ears and resolutely to
refuse to hear a single word that was spoken to him. They
sent for the insanity experts. He was adjudged insane, and
also the verdict was given that he would not live a month.</p>
<p>By one such mental expert he was carted off to a sanatorium on
Mt. Tabor. Here, when they learned that he was harmless,
they gave him his own way. They no longer dictated as to
the food he ate, so he resumed his fruits and nuts—olive
oil, peanut butter, and bananas the chief articles of his
diet. As he regained his strength he made up his mind to
live thenceforth his own life. If he lived like others,
according to social conventions, he would surely die. And
he did not want to die. The fear of death was one of the
strongest factors in the genesis of the Nature Man. To
live, he must have a natural diet, the open air, and the blessed
sunshine.</p>
<p>Now an Oregon winter has no inducements for those who wish to
return to Nature, so Darling started out in search of a
climate. He mounted a bicycle and headed south for the
sunlands. Stanford University claimed him for a year.
Here he studied and worked his way, attending lectures in as
scant garb as the authorities would allow and applying as much as
possible the principles of living that he had learned in
squirrel-town. His favourite method of study was to go off
in the hills back of the University, and there to strip off his
clothes and lie on the grass, soaking in sunshine and health at
the same time that he soaked in knowledge.</p>
<p>But Central California has her winters, and the quest for a
Nature Man’s climate drew him on. He tried Los
Angeles and Southern California, being arrested a few times and
brought before the insanity commissions because, forsooth, his
mode of life was not modelled after the mode of life of his
fellow-men. He tried Hawaii, where, unable to prove him
insane, the authorities deported him. It was not exactly a
deportation. He could have remained by serving a year in
prison. They gave him his choice. Now prison is death
to the Nature Man, who thrives only in the open air and in
God’s sunshine. The authorities of Hawaii are not to
be blamed. Darling was an undesirable citizen. Any
man is undesirable who disagrees with one. And that any man
should disagree to the extent Darling did in his philosophy of
the simple life is ample vindication of the Hawaiian authorities
verdict of his undesirableness.</p>
<p>So Darling went thence in search of a climate which would not
only be desirable, but wherein he would not be undesirable.
And he found it in Tahiti, the garden-spot of garden-spots.
And so it was, according to the narrative as given, that he wrote
the pages of his book. He wears only a loin-cloth and a
sleeveless fish-net shirt. His stripped weight is one
hundred and sixty-five pounds. His health is perfect.
His eyesight, that at one time was considered ruined, is
excellent. The lungs that were practically destroyed by
three attacks of pneumonia have not only recovered, but are
stronger than ever before.</p>
<p>I shall never forget the first time, while talking to me, that
he squashed a mosquito. The stinging pest had settled in
the middle of his back between his shoulders. Without
interrupting the flow of conversation, without dropping even a
syllable, his clenched fist shot up in the air, curved backward,
and smote his back between the shoulders, killing the mosquito
and making his frame resound like a bass drum. It reminded
me of nothing so much as of horses kicking the woodwork in their
stalls.</p>
<p>“The gorilla in the African jungle pounds his chest
until the noise of it can be heard half a mile away,” he
will announce suddenly, and thereat beat a hair-raising,
devil’s tattoo on his own chest.</p>
<p>One day he noticed a set of boxing-gloves hanging on the wall,
and promptly his eyes brightened.</p>
<p>“Do you box?” I asked.</p>
<p>“I used to give lessons in boxing when I was at
Stanford,” was the reply.</p>
<p>And there and then we stripped and put on the gloves.
Bang! a long, gorilla arm flashed out, landing the gloved end on
my nose. Biff! he caught me, in a duck, on the side of the
head nearly knocking me over sidewise. I carried the lump
raised by that blow for a week. I ducked under a straight
left, and landed a straight right on his stomach. It was a
fearful blow. The whole weight of my body was behind it,
and his body had been met as it lunged forward. I looked
for him to crumple up and go down. Instead of which his
face beamed approval, and he said, “That was
beautiful.” The next instant I was covering up and
striving to protect myself from a hurricane of hooks, jolts, and
uppercuts. Then I watched my chance and drove in for the
solar plexus. I hit the mark. The Nature Man dropped
his arms, gasped, and sat down suddenly.</p>
<p>“I’ll be all right,” he said.
“Just wait a moment.”</p>
<p>And inside thirty seconds he was on his feet—ay, and
returning the compliment, for he hooked me in the solar plexus,
and I gasped, dropped my hands, and sat down just a trifle more
suddenly than he had.</p>
<p>All of which I submit as evidence that the man I boxed with
was a totally different man from the poor, ninety-pound weight of
eight years before, who, given up by physicians and alienists,
lay gasping his life away in a closed room in Portland,
Oregon. The book that Ernest Darling has written is a good
book, and the binding is good, too.</p>
<p>Hawaii has wailed for years her need for desirable
immigrants. She has spent much time, and thought, and
money, in importing desirable citizens, and she has, as yet,
nothing much to show for it. Yet Hawaii deported the Nature
Man. She refused to give him a chance. So it is, to
chasten Hawaii’s proud spirit, that I take this opportunity
to show her what she has lost in the Nature Man. When he
arrived in Tahiti, he proceeded to seek out a piece of land on
which to grow the food he ate. But land was difficult to
find—that is, inexpensive land. The Nature Man was
not rolling in wealth. He spent weeks in wandering over the
steep hills, until, high up the mountain, where clustered several
tiny canyons, he found eighty acres of brush-jungle which were
apparently unrecorded as the property of any one. The
government officials told him that if he would clear the land and
till it for thirty years he would be given a title for it.</p>
<p>Immediately he set to work. And never was there such
work. Nobody farmed that high up. The land was
covered with matted jungle and overrun by wild pigs and countless
rats. The view of Papeete and the sea was magnificent, but
the outlook was not encouraging. He spent weeks in building
a road in order to make the plantation accessible. The pigs
and the rats ate up whatever he planted as fast as it
sprouted. He shot the pigs and trapped the rats. Of
the latter, in two weeks he caught fifteen hundred.
Everything had to be carried up on his back. He usually did
his packhorse work at night.</p>
<p>Gradually he began to win out. A grass-walled house was
built. On the fertile, volcanic soil he had wrested from
the jungle and jungle beasts were growing five hundred cocoanut
trees, five hundred papaia trees, three hundred mango trees, many
breadfruit trees and alligator-pear trees, to say nothing of
vines, bushes, and vegetables. He developed the drip of the
hills in the canyons and worked out an efficient irrigation
scheme, ditching the water from canyon to canyon and paralleling
the ditches at different altitudes. His narrow canyons
became botanical gardens. The arid shoulders of the hills,
where formerly the blazing sun had parched the jungle and beaten
it close to earth, blossomed into trees and shrubs and
flowers. Not only had the Nature Man become
self-supporting, but he was now a prosperous agriculturist with
produce to sell to the city-dwellers of Papeete.</p>
<p>Then it was discovered that his land, which the government
officials had informed him was without an owner, really had an
owner, and that deeds, descriptions, etc., were on record.
All his work bade fare to be lost. The land had been
valueless when he took it up, and the owner, a large landholder,
was unaware of the extent to which the Nature Man had developed
it. A just price was agreed upon, and Darling’s deed
was officially filed.</p>
<p>Next came a more crushing blow. Darling’s access
to market was destroyed. The road he had built was fenced
across by triple barb-wire fences. It was one of those
jumbles in human affairs that is so common in this absurdest of
social systems. Behind it was the fine hand of the same
conservative element that haled the Nature Man before the
Insanity Commission in Los Angeles and that deported him from
Hawaii. It is so hard for self-satisfied men to understand
any man whose satisfactions are fundamentally different. It
seems clear that the officials have connived with the
conservative element, for to this day the road the Nature Man
built is closed; nothing has been done about it, while an adamant
unwillingness to do anything about it is evidenced on every
hand. But the Nature Man dances and sings along his
way. He does not sit up nights thinking about the wrong
which has been done him; he leaves the worrying to the doers of
the wrong. He has no time for bitterness. He believes
he is in the world for the purpose of being happy, and he has not
a moment to waste in any other pursuit.</p>
<p>The road to his plantation is blocked. He cannot build a
new road, for there is no ground on which he can build it.
The government has restricted him to a wild-pig trail which runs
precipitously up the mountain. I climbed the trail with
him, and we had to climb with hands and feet in order to get
up. Nor can that wild-pig trail be made into a road by any
amount of toil less than that of an engineer, a steam-engine, and
a steel cable. But what does the Nature Man care? In
his gentle ethics the evil men do him he requites with
goodness. And who shall say he is not happier than
they?</p>
<p>“Never mind their pesky road,” he said to me as we
dragged ourselves up a shelf of rock and sat down, panting, to
rest. “I’ll get an air machine soon and fool
them. I’m clearing a level space for a landing stage
for the airships, and next time you come to Tahiti you will
alight right at my door.”</p>
<p>Yes, the Nature Man has some strange ideas besides that of the
gorilla pounding his chest in the African jungle. The
Nature Man has ideas about levitation. “Yes,
sir,” he said to me, “levitation is not
impossible. And think of the glory of it—lifting
one’s self from the ground by an act of will. Think
of it! The astronomers tell us that our whole solar system
is dying; that, barring accidents, it will all be so cold that no
life can live upon it. Very well. In that day all men
will be accomplished levitationists, and they will leave this
perishing planet and seek more hospitable worlds. How can
levitation be accomplished? By progressive fasts.
Yes, I have tried them, and toward the end I could feel myself
actually getting lighter.”</p>
<p>The man is a maniac, thought I.</p>
<p>“Of course,” he added, “these are only
theories of mine. I like to speculate upon the glorious
future of man. Levitation may not be possible, but I like
to think of it as possible.”</p>
<p>One evening, when he yawned, I asked him how much sleep he
allowed himself.</p>
<p>“Seven hours,” was the answer. “But in
ten years I’ll be sleeping only six hours, and in twenty
years only five hours. You see, I shall cut off an
hour’s sleep every ten years.”</p>
<p>“Then when you are a hundred you won’t be sleeping
at all,” I interjected.</p>
<p>“Just that. Exactly that. When I am a
hundred I shall not require sleep. Also, I shall be living
on air. There are plants that live on air, you
know.”</p>
<p>“But has any man ever succeeded in doing it?”</p>
<p>He shook his head.</p>
<p>“I never heard of him if he did. But it is only a
theory of mine, this living on air. It would be fine,
wouldn’t it? Of course it may be
impossible—most likely it is. You see, I am not
unpractical. I never forget the present. When I soar
ahead into the future, I always leave a string by which to find
my way back again.”</p>
<p>I fear me the Nature Man is a joker. At any rate he
lives the simple life. His laundry bill cannot be
large. Up on his plantation he lives on fruit the labour
cost of which, in cash, he estimates at five cents a day.
At present, because of his obstructed road and because he is head
over heels in the propaganda of socialism, he is living in town,
where his expenses, including rent, are twenty-five cents a
day. In order to pay those expenses he is running a night
school for Chinese.</p>
<p>The Nature Man is not bigoted. When there is nothing
better to eat than meat, he eats meat, as, for instance, when in
jail or on shipboard and the nuts and fruits give out. Nor
does he seem to crystallize into anything except sunburn.</p>
<p>“Drop anchor anywhere and the anchor will
drag—that is, if your soul is a limitless, fathomless sea,
and not dog-pound,” he quoted to me, then added: “You
see, my anchor is always dragging. I live for human health
and progress, and I strive to drag my anchor always in that
direction. To me, the two are identical. Dragging
anchor is what has saved me. My anchor did not hold me to
my death-bed. I dragged anchor into the brush and fooled
the doctors. When I recovered health and strength, I
started, by preaching and by example, to teach the people to
become nature men and nature women. But they had deaf
ears. Then, on the steamer coming to Tahiti, a
quarter-master expounded socialism to me. He showed me that
an economic square deal was necessary before men and women could
live naturally. So I dragged anchor once more, and now I am
working for the co-operative commonwealth. When that
arrives, it will be easy to bring about nature living.</p>
<p>“I had a dream last night,” he went on
thoughtfully, his face slowly breaking into a glow.
“It seemed that twenty-five nature men and nature women had
just arrived on the steamer from California, and that I was
starting to go with them up the wild-pig trail to the
plantation.”</p>
<p>Ah, me, Ernest Darling, sun-worshipper and nature man, there
are times when I am compelled to envy you and your carefree
existence. I see you now, dancing up the steps and cutting
antics on the veranda; your hair dripping from a plunge in the
salt sea, your eyes sparkling, your sun-gilded body flashing,
your chest resounding to the devil’s own tattoo as you
chant: “The gorilla in the African jungle pounds his chest
until the noise of it can be heard half a mile away.”
And I shall see you always as I saw you that last day, when the
<i>Snark</i> poked her nose once more through the passage in the
smoking reef, outward bound, and I waved good-bye to those on
shore. Not least in goodwill and affection was the wave I
gave to the golden sun-god in the scarlet loin-cloth, standing
upright in his tiny outrigger canoe.</p>
<h2><SPAN name="chap12"></SPAN>CHAPTER XII<br/> <span class="GutSmall">THE HIGH SEAT OF ABUNDANCE</span></h2>
<blockquote><p>On the arrival of strangers, every man endeavoured
to obtain one as a friend and carry him off to his own
habitation, where he is treated with the greatest kindness by the
inhabitants of the district; they place him on a high seat and
feed him with abundance of the finest food.—<i>Polynesian
Researches</i>.</p>
</blockquote>
<p><span class="smcap">The</span> <i>Snark</i> was lying at
anchor at Raiatea, just off the village of Uturoa. She had
arrived the night before, after dark, and we were preparing to
pay our first visit ashore. Early in the morning I had
noticed a tiny outrigger canoe, with an impossible spritsail,
skimming the surface of the lagoon. The canoe itself was
coffin-shaped, a mere dugout, fourteen feet long, a scant twelve
inches wide, and maybe twenty-four inches deep. It had no
lines, except in so far that it was sharp at both ends. Its
sides were perpendicular. Shorn of the outrigger, it would
have capsized of itself inside a tenth of a second. It was
the outrigger that kept it right side up.</p>
<p>I have said that the sail was impossible. It was.
It was one of those things, not that you have to see to believe,
but that you cannot believe after you have seen it. The
hoist of it and the length of its boom were sufficiently
appalling; but, not content with that, its artificer had given it
a tremendous head. So large was the head that no common
sprit could carry the strain of it in an ordinary breeze.
So a spar had been lashed to the canoe, projecting aft over the
water. To this had been made fast a sprit guy: thus, the
foot of the sail was held by the main-sheet, and the peak by the
guy to the sprit.</p>
<p>It was not a mere boat, not a mere canoe, but a sailing
machine. And the man in it sailed it by his weight and his
nerve—principally by the latter. I watched the canoe
beat up from leeward and run in toward the village, its sole
occupant far out on the outrigger and luffing up and spilling the
wind in the puffs.</p>
<p>“Well, I know one thing,” I announced; “I
don’t leave Raiatea till I have a ride in that
canoe.”</p>
<p>A few minutes later Warren called down the companionway,
“Here’s that canoe you were talking about.”</p>
<p>Promptly I dashed on deck and gave greeting to its owner, a
tall, slender Polynesian, ingenuous of face, and with clear,
sparkling, intelligent eyes. He was clad in a scarlet
loin-cloth and a straw hat. In his hands were
presents—a fish, a bunch of greens, and several enormous
yams. All of which acknowledged by smiles (which are
coinage still in isolated spots of Polynesia) and by frequent
repetitions of <i>mauruuru</i> (which is the Tahitian
“thank you”), I proceeded to make signs that I
desired to go for a sail in his canoe.</p>
<p>His face lighted with pleasure and he uttered the single word,
“Tahaa,” turning at the same time and pointing to the
lofty, cloud-draped peaks of an island three miles away—the
island of Tahaa. It was fair wind over, but a head-beat
back. Now I did not want to go to Tahaa. I had
letters to deliver in Raiatea, and officials to see, and there
was Charmian down below getting ready to go ashore. By
insistent signs I indicated that I desired no more than a short
sail on the lagoon. Quick was the disappointment in his
face, yet smiling was the acquiescence.</p>
<p>“Come on for a sail,” I called below to
Charmian. “But put on your swimming suit.
It’s going to be wet.”</p>
<p>It wasn’t real. It was a dream. That canoe
slid over the water like a streak of silver. I climbed out
on the outrigger and supplied the weight to hold her down, while
Tehei (pronounced Tayhayee) supplied the nerve. He, too, in
the puffs, climbed part way out on the outrigger, at the same
time steering with both hands on a large paddle and holding the
mainsheet with his foot.</p>
<p>“Ready about!” he called.</p>
<p>I carefully shifted my weight inboard in order to maintain the
equilibrium as the sail emptied.</p>
<p>“Hard a-lee!” he called, shooting her into the
wind.</p>
<p>I slid out on the opposite side over the water on a spar
lashed across the canoe, and we were full and away on the other
tack.</p>
<p>“All right,” said Tehei.</p>
<p>Those three phrases, “Ready about,” “Hard
a-lee,” and “All right,” comprised
Tehei’s English vocabulary and led me to suspect that at
some time he had been one of a Kanaka crew under an American
captain. Between the puffs I made signs to him and
repeatedly and interrogatively uttered the word
<i>sailor</i>. Then I tried it in atrocious French.
<i>Marin</i> conveyed no meaning to him; nor did
<i>matelot</i>. Either my French was bad, or else he was
not up in it. I have since concluded that both conjectures
were correct. Finally, I began naming over the adjacent
islands. He nodded that he had been to them. By the
time my quest reached Tahiti, he caught my drift. His
thought-processes were almost visible, and it was a joy to watch
him think. He nodded his head vigorously. Yes, he had
been to Tahiti, and he added himself names of islands such as
Tikihau, Rangiroa, and Fakarava, thus proving that he had sailed
as far as the Paumotus—undoubtedly one of the crew of a
trading schooner.</p>
<p>After our short sail, when he had returned on board, he by
signs inquired the destination of the <i>Snark</i>, and when I
had mentioned Samoa, Fiji, New Guinea, France, England, and
California in their geographical sequence, he said
“Samoa,” and by gestures intimated that he wanted to
go along. Whereupon I was hard put to explain that there
was no room for him. “<i>Petit bateau</i>”
finally solved it, and again the disappointment in his face was
accompanied by smiling acquiescence, and promptly came the
renewed invitation to accompany him to Tahaa.</p>
<p>Charmian and I looked at each other. The exhilaration of
the ride we had taken was still upon us. Forgotten were the
letters to Raiatea, the officials we had to visit. Shoes, a
shirt, a pair of trousers, cigarettes, matches, and a book to read
were hastily crammed into a biscuit tin and wrapped in a rubber
blanket, and we were over the side and into the canoe.</p>
<p>“When shall we look for you?” Warren called, as
the wind filled the sail and sent Tehei and me scurrying out on
the outrigger.</p>
<p>“I don’t know,” I answered.
“When we get back, as near as I can figure it.”</p>
<p>And away we went. The wind had increased, and with
slacked sheets we ran off before it. The freeboard of the
canoe was no more than two and a half inches, and the little
waves continually lapped over the side. This required
bailing. Now bailing is one of the principal functions of
the vahine. Vahine is the Tahitian for woman, and Charmian
being the only vahine aboard, the bailing fell appropriately to
her. Tehei and I could not very well do it, the both of us
being perched part way out on the outrigger and busied with
keeping the canoe bottom-side down. So Charmian bailed,
with a wooden scoop of primitive design, and so well did she do
it that there were occasions when she could rest off almost half
the time.</p>
<p>Raiatea and Tahaa are unique in that they lie inside the same
encircling reef. Both are volcanic islands, ragged of
sky-line, with heaven-aspiring peaks and minarets. Since
Raiatea is thirty miles in circumference, and Tahaa fifteen
miles, some idea may be gained of the magnitude of the reef that
encloses them. Between them and the reef stretches from one
to two miles of water, forming a beautiful lagoon. The huge
Pacific seas, extending in unbroken lines sometimes a mile or
half as much again in length, hurl themselves upon the reef,
overtowering and falling upon it with tremendous crashes, and yet
the fragile coral structure withstands the shock and protects the
land. Outside lies destruction to the mightiest ship
afloat. Inside reigns the calm of untroubled water, whereon
a canoe like ours can sail with no more than a couple of inches
of free-board.</p>
<p>We flew over the water. And such water!—clear as
the clearest spring-water, and crystalline in its clearness, all
intershot with a maddening pageant of colours and rainbow ribbons
more magnificently gorgeous than any rainbow. Jade green
alternated with turquoise, peacock blue with emerald, while now
the canoe skimmed over reddish purple pools, and again over pools
of dazzling, shimmering white where pounded coral sand lay
beneath and upon which oozed monstrous sea-slugs. One
moment we were above wonder-gardens of coral, wherein coloured
fishes disported, fluttering like marine butterflies; the next
moment we were dashing across the dark surface of deep channels,
out of which schools of flying fish lifted their silvery flight;
and a third moment we were above other gardens of living coral,
each more wonderful than the last. And above all was the
tropic, trade-wind sky with its fluffy clouds racing across the
zenith and heaping the horizon with their soft masses.</p>
<p>Before we were aware, we were close in to Tahaa (pronounced
Tah-hah-ah, with equal accents), and Tehei was grinning approval
of the vahine’s proficiency at bailing. The canoe
grounded on a shallow shore, twenty feet from land, and we waded
out on a soft bottom where big slugs curled and writhed under our
feet and where small octopuses advertised their existence by
their superlative softness when stepped upon. Close to the
beach, amid cocoanut palms and banana trees, erected on stilts,
built of bamboo, with a grass-thatched roof, was Tehei’s
house. And out of the house came Tehei’s vahine, a
slender mite of a woman, kindly eyed and Mongolian of
feature—when she was not North American Indian.
“Bihaura,” Tehei called her, but he did not pronounce
it according to English notions of spelling. Spelled
“Bihaura,” it sounded like Bee-ah-oo-rah, with every
syllable sharply emphasized.</p>
<p>She took Charmian by the hand and led her into the house,
leaving Tehei and me to follow. Here, by sign-language
unmistakable, we were informed that all they possessed was
ours. No hidalgo was ever more generous in the expression
of giving, while I am sure that few hidalgos were ever as
generous in the actual practice. We quickly discovered that
we dare not admire their possessions, for whenever we did admire
a particular object it was immediately presented to us. The
two vahines, according to the way of vahines, got together in a
discussion and examination of feminine fripperies, while Tehei
and I, manlike, went over fishing-tackle and wild-pig-hunting, to
say nothing of the device whereby bonitas are caught on
forty-foot poles from double canoes. Charmian admired a
sewing basket—the best example she had seen of Polynesian
basketry; it was hers. I admired a bonita hook, carved in
one piece from a pearl-shell; it was mine. Charmian was
attracted by a fancy braid of straw sennit, thirty feet of it in
a roll, sufficient to make a hat of any design one wished; the
roll of sennit was hers. My gaze lingered upon a
poi-pounder that dated back to the old stone days; it was
mine. Charmian dwelt a moment too long on a wooden
poi-bowl, canoe-shaped, with four legs, all carved in one piece
of wood; it was hers. I glanced a second time at a gigantic
cocoanut calabash; it was mine. Then Charmian and I held a
conference in which we resolved to admire no more—not
because it did not pay well enough, but because it paid too
well. Also, we were already racking our brains over the
contents of the <i>Snark</i> for suitable return presents.
Christmas is an easy problem compared with a Polynesian
giving-feast.</p>
<p>We sat on the cool porch, on Bihaura’s best mats while
dinner was preparing, and at the same time met the
villagers. In twos and threes and groups they strayed
along, shaking hands and uttering the Tahitian word of
greeting—Ioarana, pronounced yo-rah-nah. The men, big
strapping fellows, were in loin-cloths, with here and there no
shirt, while the women wore the universal <i>ahu</i>, a sort of
adult pinafore that flows in graceful lines from the shoulders to
the ground. Sad to see was the elephantiasis that afflicted
some of them. Here would be a comely woman of magnificent
proportions, with the port of a queen, yet marred by one arm four
times—or a dozen times—the size of the other.
Beside her might stand a six-foot man, erect, mighty-muscled,
bronzed, with the body of a god, yet with feet and calves so
swollen that they ran together, forming legs, shapeless,
monstrous, that were for all the world like elephant legs.</p>
<p>No one seems really to know the cause of the South Sea
elephantiasis. One theory is that it is caused by the
drinking of polluted water. Another theory attributes it to
inoculation through mosquito bites. A third theory charges
it to predisposition plus the process of acclimatization.
On the other hand, no one that stands in finicky dread of it and
similar diseases can afford to travel in the South Seas.
There will be occasions when such a one must drink water.
There may be also occasions when the mosquitoes let up
biting. But every precaution of the finicky one will be
useless. If he runs barefoot across the beach to have a
swim, he will tread where an elephantiasis case trod a few
minutes before. If he closets himself in his own house, yet
every bit of fresh food on his table will have been subjected to
the contamination, be it flesh, fish, fowl, or vegetable.
In the public market at Papeete two known lepers run stalls, and
heaven alone knows through what channels arrive at that market
the daily supplies of fish, fruit, meat, and vegetables.
The only happy way to go through the South Seas is with a
careless poise, without apprehension, and with a Christian
Science-like faith in the resplendent fortune of your own
particular star. When you see a woman, afflicted with
elephantiasis wringing out cream from cocoanut meat with her
naked hands, drink and reflect how good is the cream, forgetting
the hands that pressed it out. Also, remember that diseases
such as elephantiasis and leprosy do not seem to be caught by
contact.</p>
<p>We watched a Raratongan woman, with swollen, distorted limbs,
prepare our cocoanut cream, and then went out to the cook-shed
where Tehei and Bihaura were cooking dinner. And then it
was served to us on a dry-goods box in the house. Our hosts
waited until we were done and then spread their table on the
floor. But our table! We were certainly in the high
seat of abundance. First, there was glorious raw fish,
caught several hours before from the sea and steeped the
intervening time in lime-juice diluted with water. Then
came roast chicken. Two cocoanuts, sharply sweet, served
for drink. There were bananas that tasted like strawberries
and that melted in the mouth, and there was banana-poi that made
one regret that his Yankee forebears ever attempted
puddings. Then there was boiled yam, boiled taro, and
roasted <i>feis</i>, which last are nothing more or less than
large mealy, juicy, red-coloured cooking bananas. We
marvelled at the abundance, and, even as we marvelled, a pig was
brought on, a whole pig, a sucking pig, swathed in green leaves
and roasted upon the hot stones of a native oven, the most
honourable and triumphant dish in the Polynesian cuisine.
And after that came coffee, black coffee, delicious coffee,
native coffee grown on the hillsides of Tahaa.</p>
<p>Tehei’s fishing-tackle fascinated me, and after we
arranged to go fishing, Charmian and I decided to remain all
night. Again Tehei broached Samoa, and again my <i>petit
bateau</i> brought the disappointment and the smile of
acquiescence to his face. Bora Bora was my next port.
It was not so far away but that cutters made the passage back and
forth between it and Raiatea. So I invited Tehei to go that
far with us on the <i>Snark</i>. Then I learned that his
wife had been born on Bora Bora and still owned a house
there. She likewise was invited, and immediately came the
counter invitation to stay with them in their house in Born
Bora. It was Monday. Tuesday we would go fishing and
return to Raiatea. Wednesday we would sail by Tahaa and off
a certain point, a mile away, pick up Tehei and Bihaura and go on
to Bora Bora. All this we arranged in detail, and talked
over scores of other things as well, and yet Tehei knew three
phrases in English, Charmian and I knew possibly a dozen Tahitian
words, and among the four of us there were a dozen or so French
words that all understood. Of course, such polyglot
conversation was slow, but, eked out with a pad, a lead pencil,
the face of a clock Charmian drew on the back of a pad, and with
ten thousand and one gestures, we managed to get on very
nicely.</p>
<p>At the first moment we evidenced an inclination for bed the
visiting natives, with soft <i>Iaoranas</i>, faded away, and
Tehei and Bihaura likewise faded away. The house consisted
of one large room, and it was given over to us, our hosts going
elsewhere to sleep. In truth, their castle was ours.
And right here, I want to say that of all the entertainment I
have received in this world at the hands of all sorts of races in
all sorts of places, I have never received entertainment that
equalled this at the hands of this brown-skinned couple of
Tahaa. I do not refer to the presents, the free-handed
generousness, the high abundance, but to the fineness of courtesy
and consideration and tact, and to the sympathy that was real
sympathy in that it was understanding. They did nothing
they thought ought to be done for us, according to their
standards, but they did what they divined we wanted to be done
for us, while their divination was most successful. It
would be impossible to enumerate the hundreds of little acts of
consideration they performed during the few days of our
intercourse. Let it suffice for me to say that of all
hospitality and entertainment I have known, in no case was theirs
not only not excelled, but in no case was it quite
equalled. Perhaps the most delightful feature of it was
that it was due to no training, to no complex social ideals, but
that it was the untutored and spontaneous outpouring from their
hearts.</p>
<p>The next morning we went fishing, that is, Tehei, Charmian,
and I did, in the coffin-shaped canoe; but this time the enormous
sail was left behind. There was no room for sailing and
fishing at the same time in that tiny craft. Several miles
away, inside the reef, in a channel twenty fathoms deep, Tehei
dropped his baited hooks and rock-sinkers. The bait was
chunks of octopus flesh, which he bit out of a live octopus that
writhed in the bottom of the canoe. Nine of these lines he
set, each line attached to one end of a short length of bamboo
floating on the surface. When a fish was hooked, the end of
the bamboo was drawn under the water. Naturally, the other
end rose up in the air, bobbing and waving frantically for us to
make haste. And make haste we did, with whoops and yells
and driving paddles, from one signalling bamboo to another,
hauling up from the depths great glistening beauties from two to
three feet in length.</p>
<p>Steadily, to the eastward, an ominous squall had been rising
and blotting out the bright trade-wind sky. And we were
three miles to leeward of home. We started as the first
wind-gusts whitened the water. Then came the rain, such
rain as only the tropics afford, where every tap and main in the
sky is open wide, and when, to top it all, the very reservoir
itself spills over in blinding deluge. Well, Charmian was
in a swimming suit, I was in pyjamas, and Tehei wore only a
loin-cloth. Bihaura was on the beach waiting for us, and
she led Charmian into the house in much the same fashion that the
mother leads in the naughty little girl who has been playing in
mud-puddles.</p>
<p>It was a change of clothes and a dry and quiet smoke while
<i>kai-kai</i> was preparing. <i>Kai-kai</i>, by the way,
is the Polynesian for “food” or “to eat,”
or, rather, it is one form of the original root, whatever it may
have been, that has been distributed far and wide over the vast
area of the Pacific. It is <i>kai</i> in the Marquesas,
Raratonga, Manahiki, Niuë, Fakaafo, Tonga, New Zealand, and
Vaté. In Tahiti “to eat” changes to
<i>amu</i>, in Hawaii and Samoa to <i>ai</i>, in Ban to
<i>kana</i>, in Nina to <i>kana</i>, in Nongone to <i>kaka</i>,
and in New Caledonia to <i>ki</i>. But by whatsoever sound
or symbol, it was welcome to our ears after that long paddle in
the rain. Once more we sat in the high seat of abundance
until we regretted that we had been made unlike the image of the
giraffe and the camel.</p>
<p>Again, when we were preparing to return to the <i>Snark</i>,
the sky to windward turned black and another squall swooped
down. But this time it was little rain and all wind.
It blew hour after hour, moaning and screeching through the
palms, tearing and wrenching and shaking the frail bamboo
dwelling, while the outer reef set up a mighty thundering as it
broke the force of the swinging seas. Inside the reef, the
lagoon, sheltered though it was, was white with fury, and not
even Tehei’s seamanship could have enabled his slender
canoe to live in such a welter.</p>
<p>By sunset, the back of the squall had broken though it was
still too rough for the canoe. So I had Tehei find a native
who was willing to venture his cutter across to Raiatea for the
outrageous sum of two dollars, Chili, which is equivalent in our
money to ninety cents. Half the village was told off to
carry presents, with which Tehei and Bihaura speeded their
parting guests—captive chickens, fishes dressed and swathed
in wrappings of green leaves, great golden bunches of bananas,
leafy baskets spilling over with oranges and limes, alligator
pears (the butter-fruit, also called the <i>avoca</i>), huge
baskets of yams, bunches of taro and cocoanuts, and last of all,
large branches and trunks of trees—firewood for the
<i>Snark</i>.</p>
<p>While on the way to the cutter we met the only white man on
Tahaa, and of all men, George Lufkin, a native of New
England! Eighty-six years of age he was, sixty-odd of
which, he said, he had spent in the Society Islands, with
occasional absences, such as the gold rush to Eldorado in
’forty-nine and a short period of ranching in California
near Tulare. Given no more than three months by the doctors
to live, he had returned to his South Seas and lived to
eighty-six and to chuckle over the doctors aforesaid, who were
all in their graves. <i>Fee-fee</i> he had, which is the
native for elephantiasis and which is pronounced fay-fay. A
quarter of a century before, the disease had fastened upon him,
and it would remain with him until he died. We asked him
about kith and kin. Beside him sat a sprightly damsel of
sixty, his daughter. “She is all I have,” he
murmured plaintively, “and she has no children
living.”</p>
<p>The cutter was a small, sloop-rigged affair, but large it
seemed alongside Tehei’s canoe. On the other hand,
when we got out on the lagoon and were struck by another heavy
wind-squall, the cutter became liliputian, while the
<i>Snark</i>, in our imagination, seemed to promise all the
stability and permanence of a continent. They were good
boatmen. Tehei and Bihaura had come along to see us home,
and the latter proved a good boatwoman herself. The cutter
was well ballasted, and we met the squall under full sail.
It was getting dark, the lagoon was full of coral patches, and we
were carrying on. In the height of the squall we had to go
about, in order to make a short leg to windward to pass around a
patch of coral no more than a foot under the surface. As
the cutter filled on the other tack, and while she was in that
“dead” condition that precedes gathering way, she was
knocked flat. Jib-sheet and main-sheet were let go, and she
righted into the wind. Three times she was knocked down,
and three times the sheets were flung loose, before she could get
away on that tack.</p>
<p>By the time we went about again, darkness had fallen. We
were now to windward of the <i>Snark</i>, and the squall was
howling. In came the jib, and down came the mainsail, all
but a patch of it the size of a pillow-slip. By an accident
we missed the <i>Snark</i>, which was riding it out to two
anchors, and drove aground upon the inshore coral. Running
the longest line on the <i>Snark</i> by means of the launch, and
after an hour’s hard work, we heaved the cutter off and had
her lying safely astern.</p>
<p>The day we sailed for Bora Bora the wind was light, and we
crossed the lagoon under power to the point where Tehei and
Bihaura were to meet us. As we made in to the land between
the coral banks, we vainly scanned the shore for our
friends. There was no sign of them.</p>
<p>“We can’t wait,” I said. “This
breeze won’t fetch us to Bora Bora by dark, and I
don’t want to use any more gasolene than I have
to.”</p>
<p>You see, gasolene in the South Seas is a problem. One
never knows when he will be able to replenish his supply.</p>
<p>But just then Tehei appeared through the trees as he came down
to the water. He had peeled off his shirt and was wildly
waving it. Bihaura apparently was not ready. Once
aboard, Tehei informed us by signs that we must proceed along the
land till we got opposite to his house. He took the wheel
and conned the <i>Snark</i> through the coral, around point after
point till we cleared the last point of all. Cries of
welcome went up from the beach, and Bihaura, assisted by several
of the villagers, brought off two canoe-loads of abundance.
There were yams, taro, <i>feis</i>, breadfruit, cocoanuts,
oranges, limes, pineapples, watermelons, alligator pears,
pomegranates, fish, chickens galore crowing and cackling and
laying eggs on our decks, and a live pig that squealed infernally
and all the time in apprehension of imminent slaughter.</p>
<p>Under the rising moon we came in through the perilous passage
of the reef of Bora Bora and dropped anchor off Vaitapé
village. Bihaura, with housewifely anxiety, could not get
ashore too quickly to her house to prepare more abundance for
us. While the launch was taking her and Tehei to the little
jetty, the sound of music and of singing drifted across the quiet
lagoon. Throughout the Society Islands we had been
continually informed that we would find the Bora Borans very
jolly. Charmian and I went ashore to see, and on the
village green, by forgotten graves on the beach, found the youths
and maidens dancing, flower-garlanded and flower-bedecked, with
strange phosphorescent flowers in their hair that pulsed and
dimmed and glowed in the moonlight. Farther along the beach
we came upon a huge grass house, oval-shaped seventy feet in
length, where the elders of the village were singing
<i>himines</i>. They, too, were flower-garlanded and jolly,
and they welcomed us into the fold as little lost sheep straying
along from outer darkness.</p>
<p>Early next morning Tehei was on board, with a string of
fresh-caught fish and an invitation to dinner for that
evening. On the way to dinner, we dropped in at the
<i>himine</i> house. The same elders were singing, with
here or there a youth or maiden that we had not seen the previous
night. From all the signs, a feast was in
preparation. Towering up from the floor was a mountain of
fruits and vegetables, flanked on either side by numerous
chickens tethered by cocoanut strips. After several
<i>himines</i> had been sung, one of the men arose and made
oration. The oration was made to us, and though it was
Greek to us, we knew that in some way it connected us with that
mountain of provender.</p>
<p>“Can it be that they are presenting us with all
that?” Charmian whispered.</p>
<p>“Impossible,” I muttered back. “Why
should they be giving it to us? Besides, there is no room
on the <i>Snark</i> for it. We could not eat a tithe of
it. The rest would spoil. Maybe they are inviting us
to the feast. At any rate, that they should give all that
to us is impossible.”</p>
<p>Nevertheless we found ourselves once more in the high seat of
abundance. The orator, by gestures unmistakable, in detail
presented every item in the mountain to us, and next he presented
it to us <i>in toto</i>. It was an embarrassing
moment. What would you do if you lived in a hall bedroom
and a friend gave you a white elephant? Our <i>Snark</i>
was no more than a hall bedroom, and already she was loaded down
with the abundance of Tahaa. This new supply was too
much. We blushed, and stammered, and
<i>mauruuru’d</i>. We <i>mauruuru’d</i> with
repeated <i>nui’s</i> which conveyed the largeness and
overwhelmingness of our thanks. At the same time, by signs,
we committed the awful breach of etiquette of not accepting the
present. The <i>himine</i> singers’ disappointment
was plainly betrayed, and that evening, aided by Tehei, we
compromised by accepting one chicken, one bunch of bananas, one
bunch of taro, and so on down the list.</p>
<p>But there was no escaping the abundance. I bought a
dozen chickens from a native out in the country, and the
following day he delivered thirteen chickens along with a
canoe-load of fruit. The French storekeeper presented us
with pomegranates and lent us his finest horse. The
gendarme did likewise, lending us a horse that was the very apple
of his eye. And everybody sent us flowers. The
<i>Snark</i> was a fruit-stand and a greengrocer’s shop
masquerading under the guise of a conservatory. We went
around flower-garlanded all the time. When the
<i>himine</i> singers came on board to sing, the maidens kissed
us welcome, and the crew, from captain to cabin-boy, lost its
heart to the maidens of Bora Bora. Tehei got up a big
fishing expedition in our honour, to which we went in a double
canoe, paddled by a dozen strapping Amazons. We were
relieved that no fish were caught, else the <i>Snark</i> would
have sunk at her moorings.</p>
<p>The days passed, but the abundance did not diminish. On
the day of departure, canoe after canoe put off to us.
Tehei brought cucumbers and a young <i>papaia</i> tree burdened
with splendid fruit. Also, for me he brought a tiny, double
canoe with fishing apparatus complete. Further, he brought
fruits and vegetables with the same lavishness as at Tahaa.
Bihaura brought various special presents for Charmian, such as
silk-cotton pillows, fans, and fancy mats. The whole
population brought fruits, flowers, and chickens. And
Bihaura added a live sucking pig. Natives whom I did not
remember ever having seen before strayed over the rail and
presented me with such things as fish-poles, fish-lines, and
fish-hooks carved from pearl-shell.</p>
<p>As the <i>Snark</i> sailed out through the reef, she had a
cutter in tow. This was the craft that was to take Bihaura
back to Tahaa—but not Tehei. I had yielded at last,
and he was one of the crew of the <i>Snark</i>. When the
cutter cast off and headed east, and the <i>Snark’s</i> bow
turned toward the west, Tehei knelt down by the cockpit and
breathed a silent prayer, the tears flowing down his
cheeks. A week later, when Martin got around to developing
and printing, he showed Tehei some of the photographs. And
that brown-skinned son of Polynesia, gazing on the pictured
lineaments of his beloved Bihaura broke down in tears.</p>
<p>But the abundance! There was so much of it. We
could not work the <i>Snark</i> for the fruit that was in the
way. She was festooned with fruit. The life-boat and
launch were packed with it. The awning-guys groaned under
their burdens. But once we struck the full trade-wind sea,
the disburdening began. At every roll the <i>Snark</i>
shook overboard a bunch or so of bananas and cocoanuts, or a
basket of limes. A golden flood of limes washed about in
the lee-scuppers. The big baskets of yams burst, and
pineapples and pomegranates rolled back and forth. The
chickens had got loose and were everywhere, roosting on the
awnings, fluttering and squawking out on the jib-boom, and
essaying the perilous feat of balancing on the
spinnaker-boom. They were wild chickens, accustomed to
flight. When attempts were made to catch them, they flew
out over the ocean, circled about, and came back. Sometimes
they did not come back. And in the confusion, unobserved,
the little sucking pig got loose and slipped overboard.</p>
<p>“On the arrival of strangers, every man endeavoured to
obtain one as a friend and carry him off to his own habitation,
where he is treated with the greatest kindness by the inhabitants
of the district: they place him on a high seat and feed him with
abundance of the finest foods.”</p>
<h2><SPAN name="chap13"></SPAN>CHAPTER XIII<br/> <span class="GutSmall">THE STONE-FISHING OF BORA BORA</span></h2>
<p><span class="smcap">At</span> five in the morning the conches
began to blow. From all along the beach the eerie sounds
arose, like the ancient voice of War, calling to the fishermen to
arise and prepare to go forth. We on the <i>Snark</i>
likewise arose, for there could be no sleep in that mad din of
conches. Also, we were going stone-fishing, though our
preparations were few.</p>
<p><i>Tautai-taora</i> is the name for stone-fishing,
<i>tautai</i> meaning a “fishing instrument.”
And <i>taora</i> meaning “thrown.” But
<i>tautai-taora</i>, in combination, means
“stone-fishing,” for a stone is the instrument that
is thrown. Stone-fishing is in reality a fish-drive,
similar in principle to a rabbit-drive or a cattle-drive, though
in the latter affairs drivers and driven operate in the same
medium, while in the fish-drive the men must be in the air to
breathe and the fish are driven through the water. It does
not matter if the water is a hundred feet deep, the men, working
on the surface, drive the fish just the same.</p>
<p>This is the way it is done. The canoes form in line, one
hundred to two hundred feet apart. In the bow of each canoe
a man wields a stone, several pounds in weight, which is attached
to a short rope. He merely smites the water with the stone,
pulls up the stone, and smites again. He goes on
smiting. In the stern of each canoe another man paddles,
driving the canoe ahead and at the same time keeping it in the
formation. The line of canoes advances to meet a second
line a mile or two away, the ends of the lines hurrying together
to form a circle, the far edge of which is the shore. The
circle begins to contract upon the shore, where the women,
standing in a long row out into the sea, form a fence of legs,
which serves to break any rushes of the frantic fish. At
the right moment when the circle is sufficiently small, a canoe
dashes out from shore, dropping overboard a long screen of
cocoanut leaves and encircling the circle, thus reinforcing the
palisade of legs. Of course, the fishing is always done
inside the reef in the lagoon.</p>
<p>“<i>Très jolie</i>,” the gendarme said,
after explaining by signs and gestures that thousands of fish
would be caught of all sizes from minnows to sharks, and that the
captured fish would boil up and upon the very sand of the
beach.</p>
<p>It is a most successful method of fishing, while its nature is
more that of an outing festival, rather than of a prosaic,
food-getting task. Such fishing parties take place about
once a month at Bora Bora, and it is a custom that has descended
from old time. The man who originated it is not
remembered. They always did this thing. But one
cannot help wondering about that forgotten savage of the long
ago, into whose mind first flashed this scheme of easy fishing,
of catching huge quantities of fish without hook, or net, or
spear. One thing about him we can know: he was a
radical. And we can be sure that he was considered
feather-brained and anarchistic by his conservative
tribesmen. His difficulty was much greater than that of the
modern inventor, who has to convince in advance only one or two
capitalists. That early inventor had to convince his whole
tribe in advance, for without the co-operation of the whole tribe
the device could not be tested. One can well imagine the
nightly pow-wow-ings in that primitive island world, when he
called his comrades antiquated moss-backs, and they called him a
fool, a freak, and a crank, and charged him with having come from
Kansas. Heaven alone knows at what cost of grey hairs and
expletives he must finally have succeeded in winning over a
sufficient number to give his idea a trial. At any rate,
the experiment succeeded. It stood the test of
truth—it worked! And thereafter, we can be confident,
there was no man to be found who did not know all along that it
was going to work.</p>
<p>Our good friends, Tehei and Bihaura, who were giving the
fishing in our honour, had promised to come for us. We were
down below when the call came from on deck that they were
coming. We dashed up the companionway, to be overwhelmed by
the sight of the Polynesian barge in which we were to ride.
It was a long double canoe, the canoes lashed together by timbers
with an interval of water between, and the whole decorated with
flowers and golden grasses. A dozen flower-crowned Amazons
were at the paddles, while at the stern of each canoe was a
strapping steersman. All were garlanded with gold and
crimson and orange flowers, while each wore about the hips a
scarlet <i>pareu</i>. There were flowers everywhere,
flowers, flowers, flowers, without end. The whole thing
was an orgy of colour. On the platform forward resting on
the bows of the canoes, Tehei and Bihaura were dancing. All
voices were raised in a wild song or greeting.</p>
<p>Three times they circled the <i>Snark</i> before coming
alongside to take Charmian and me on board. Then it was
away for the fishing-grounds, a five-mile paddle dead to
windward. “Everybody is jolly in Bora Bora,” is
the saying throughout the Society Islands, and we certainly found
everybody jolly. Canoe songs, shark songs, and fishing
songs were sung to the dipping of the paddles, all joining in on
the swinging choruses. Once in a while the cry <i>Mao</i>!
was raised, whereupon all strained like mad at the paddles.
Mao is shark, and when the deep-sea tigers appear, the natives
paddle for dear life for the shore, knowing full well the danger
they run of having their frail canoes overturned and of being
devoured. Of course, in our case there were no sharks, but
the cry of <i>mao</i> was used to incite them to paddle with as
much energy as if a shark were really after them.
“Hoé! Hoé!” was another cry that
made us foam through the water.</p>
<p>On the platform Tehei and Bihaura danced, accompanied by songs
and choruses or by rhythmic hand-clappings. At other times
a musical knocking of the paddles against the sides of the canoes
marked the accent. A young girl dropped her paddle, leaped
to the platform, and danced a hula, in the midst of which, still
dancing, she swayed and bent, and imprinted on our cheeks the
kiss of welcome. Some of the songs, or <i>himines</i>, were
religious, and they were especially beautiful, the deep basses of
the men mingling with the altos and thin sopranos of the women
and forming a combination of sound that irresistibly reminded one
of an organ. In fact, “kanaka organ” is the
scoffer’s description of the <i>himine</i>. On the
other hand, some of the chants or ballads were very barbaric,
having come down from pre-Christian times.</p>
<p>And so, singing, dancing, paddling, these joyous Polynesians
took us to the fishing. The gendarme, who is the French
ruler of Bora Bora, accompanied us with his family in a double
canoe of his own, paddled by his prisoners; for not only is he
gendarme and ruler, but he is jailer as well, and in this jolly
land when anybody goes fishing, all go fishing. A score of
single canoes, with outriggers, paddled along with us.
Around a point a big sailing-canoe appeared, running beautifully
before the wind as it bore down to greet us. Balancing
precariously on the outrigger, three young men saluted us with a
wild rolling of drums.</p>
<p>The next point, half a mile farther on, brought us to the
place of meeting. Here the launch, which had been brought
along by Warren and Martin, attracted much attention. The
Bora Borans could not see what made it go. The canoes were
drawn upon the sand, and all hands went ashore to drink cocoanuts
and sing and dance. Here our numbers were added to by many
who arrived on foot from near-by dwellings, and a pretty sight it
was to see the flower-crowned maidens, hand in hand and two by
two, arriving along the sands.</p>
<p>“They usually make a big catch,” Allicot, a
half-caste trader, told us. “At the finish the water
is fairly alive with fish. It is lots of fun. Of
course you know all the fish will be yours.”</p>
<p>“All?” I groaned, for already the <i>Snark</i> was
loaded down with lavish presents, by the canoe-load, of fruits,
vegetables, pigs, and chickens.</p>
<p>“Yes, every last fish,” Allicot answered.
“You see, when the surround is completed, you, being the
guest of honour, must take a harpoon and impale the first
one. It is the custom. Then everybody goes in with
their hands and throws the catch out on the sand. There
will be a mountain of them. Then one of the chiefs will
make a speech in which he presents you with the whole kit and
boodle. But you don’t have to take them all.
You get up and make a speech, selecting what fish you want for
yourself and presenting all the rest back again. Then
everybody says you are very generous.”</p>
<p>“But what would be the result if I kept the whole
present?” I asked.</p>
<p>“It has never happened,” was the answer.
“It is the custom to give and give back again.”</p>
<p>The native minister started with a prayer for success in the
fishing, and all heads were bared. Next, the chief
fishermen told off the canoes and allotted them their
places. Then it was into the canoes and away. No
women, however, came along, with the exception of Bihaura and
Charmian. In the old days even they would have been
tabooed. The women remained behind to wade out into the
water and form the palisade of legs.</p>
<p>The big double canoe was left on the beach, and we went in the
launch. Half the canoes paddled off to leeward, while we,
with the other half, headed to windward a mile and a half, until
the end of our line was in touch with the reef. The leader
of the drive occupied a canoe midway in our line. He stood
erect, a fine figure of an old man, holding a flag in his
hand. He directed the taking of positions and the forming
of the two lines by blowing on a conch. When all was ready,
he waved his flag to the right. With a single splash the
throwers in every canoe on that side struck the water with their
stones. While they were hauling them back—a matter of
a moment, for the stones scarcely sank beneath the
surface—the flag waved to the left, and with admirable
precision every stone on that side struck the water. So it
went, back and forth, right and left; with every wave of the flag
a long line of concussion smote the lagoon. At the same
time the paddles drove the canoes forward and what was being done
in our line was being done in the opposing line of canoes a mile
and more away.</p>
<p>On the bow of the launch, Tehei, with eyes fixed on the
leader, worked his stone in unison with the others. Once,
the stone slipped from the rope, and the same instant Tehei went
overboard after it. I do not know whether or not that stone
reached the bottom, but I do know that the next instant Tehei
broke surface alongside with the stone in his hand. I
noticed this same accident occur several times among the near-by
canoes, but in each instance the thrower followed the stone and
brought it back.</p>
<p>The reef ends of our lines accelerated, the shore ends lagged,
all under the watchful supervision of the leader, until at the
reef the two lines joined, forming the circle. Then the
contraction of the circle began, the poor frightened fish harried
shoreward by the streaks of concussion that smote the
water. In the same fashion elephants are driven through the
jungle by motes of men who crouch in the long grasses or behind
trees and make strange noises. Already the palisade of legs
had been built. We could see the heads of the women, in a
long line, dotting the placid surface of the lagoon. The
tallest women went farthest out, thus, with the exception of
those close inshore, nearly all were up to their necks in the
water.</p>
<p>Still the circle narrowed, till canoes were almost
touching. There was a pause. A long canoe shot out
from shore, following the line of the circle. It went as
fast as paddles could drive. In the stern a man threw
overboard the long, continuous screen of cocoanut leaves.
The canoes were no longer needed, and overboard went the men to
reinforce the palisade with their legs. For the screen was
only a screen, and not a net, and the fish could dash through it
if they tried. Hence the need for legs that ever agitated
the screen, and for hands that splashed and throats that
yelled. Pandemonium reigned as the trap tightened.</p>
<p>But no fish broke surface or collided against the hidden
legs. At last the chief fisherman entered the trap.
He waded around everywhere, carefully. But there were no
fish boiling up and out upon the sand. There was not a
sardine, not a minnow, not a polly-wog. Something must have
been wrong with that prayer; or else, and more likely, as one
grizzled fellow put it, the wind was not in its usual quarter and
the fish were elsewhere in the lagoon. In fact, there had
been no fish to drive.</p>
<p>“About once in five these drives are failures,”
Allicot consoled us.</p>
<p>Well, it was the stone-fishing that had brought us to Bora
Bora, and it was our luck to draw the one chance in five.
Had it been a raffle, it would have been the other way
about. This is not pessimism. Nor is it an indictment
of the plan of the universe. It is merely that feeling
which is familiar to most fishermen at the empty end of a hard
day.</p>
<h2><SPAN name="chap14"></SPAN>CHAPTER XIV<br/> <span class="GutSmall">THE AMATEUR NAVIGATOR</span></h2>
<p><span class="smcap">There</span> are captains and captains,
and some mighty fine captains, I know; but the run of the
captains on the <i>Snark</i> has been remarkably otherwise.
My experience with them has been that it is harder to take care
of one captain on a small boat than of two small babies. Of
course, this is no more than is to be expected. The good
men have positions, and are not likely to forsake their
one-thousand-to-fifteen-thousand-ton billets for the <i>Snark</i>
with her ten tons net. The <i>Snark</i> has had to cull her
navigators from the beach, and the navigator on the beach is
usually a congenital inefficient—the sort of man who beats
about for a fortnight trying vainly to find an ocean isle and who
returns with his schooner to report the island sunk with all on
board, the sort of man whose temper or thirst for strong waters
works him out of billets faster than he can work into them.</p>
<p>The <i>Snark</i> has had three captains, and by the grace of
God she shall have no more. The first captain was so senile
as to be unable to give a measurement for a boom-jaw to a
carpenter. So utterly agedly helpless was he, that he was
unable to order a sailor to throw a few buckets of salt water on
the <i>Snark’s</i> deck. For twelve days, at anchor,
under an overhead tropic sun, the deck lay dry. It was a
new deck. It cost me one hundred and thirty-five dollars to
recaulk it. The second captain was angry. He was born
angry. “Papa is always angry,” was the
description given him by his half-breed son. The third
captain was so crooked that he couldn’t hide behind a
corkscrew. The truth was not in him, common honesty was not
in him, and he was as far away from fair play and square-dealing
as he was from his proper course when he nearly wrecked the
<i>Snark</i> on the Ring-gold Isles.</p>
<p>It was at Suva, in the Fijis, that I discharged my third and
last captain and took up gain the rôle of amateur
navigator. I had essayed it once before, under my first
captain, who, out of San Francisco, jumped the <i>Snark</i> so
amazingly over the chart that I really had to find out what was
doing. It was fairly easy to find out, for we had a run of
twenty-one hundred miles before us. I knew nothing of
navigation; but, after several hours of reading up and half an
hour’s practice with the sextant, I was able to find the
<i>Snark’s</i> latitude by meridian observation and her
longitude by the simple method known as “equal
altitudes.” This is not a correct method. It is
not even a safe method, but my captain was attempting to navigate
by it, and he was the only one on board who should have been able
to tell me that it was a method to be eschewed. I brought
the <i>Snark</i> to Hawaii, but the conditions favoured me.
The sun was in northern declination and nearly overhead.
The legitimate “chronometer-sight” method of
ascertaining the longitude I had not heard of—yes, I had
heard of it. My first captain mentioned it vaguely, but
after one or two attempts at practice of it he mentioned it no
more.</p>
<p>I had time in the Fijis to compare my chronometer with two
other chronometers. Two weeks previous, at Pago Pago, in
Samoa, I had asked my captain to compare our chronometer with the
chronometers on the American cruiser, the <i>Annapolis</i>.
This he told me he had done—of course he had done nothing
of the sort; and he told me that the difference he had
ascertained was only a small fraction of a second. He told
it to me with finely simulated joy and with words of praise for
my splendid time-keeper. I repeat it now, with words of
praise for his splendid and unblushing unveracity. For
behold, fourteen days later, in Suva, I compared the chronometer
with the one on the Atua, an Australian steamer, and found that
mine was thirty-one seconds fast. Now thirty-one seconds of
time, converted into arc, equals seven and one-quarter
miles. That is to say, if I were sailing west, in the
night-time, and my position, according to my dead reckoning from
my afternoon chronometer sight, was shown to be seven miles off
the land, why, at that very moment I would be crashing on the
reef. Next I compared my chronometer with Captain
Wooley’s. Captain Wooley, the harbourmaster, gives
the time to Suva, firing a gun signal at twelve, noon, three
times a week. According to his chronometer mine was
fifty-nine seconds fast, which is to say, that, sailing west, I
should be crashing on the reef when I thought I was fifteen miles
off from it.</p>
<p>I compromised by subtracting thirty-one seconds from the total
of my chronometer’s losing error, and sailed away for
Tanna, in the New Hebrides, resolved, when nosing around the land
on dark nights, to bear in mind the other seven miles I might be
out according to Captain Wooley’s instrument. Tanna
lay some six hundred miles west-southwest from the Fijis, and it
was my belief that while covering that distance I could quite
easily knock into my head sufficient navigation to get me
there. Well, I got there, but listen first to my
troubles. Navigation <i>is</i> easy, I shall always contend
that; but when a man is taking three gasolene engines and a wife
around the world and is writing hard every day to keep the
engines supplied with gasolene and the wife with pearls and
volcanoes, he hasn’t much time left in which to study
navigation. Also, it is bound to be easier to study said
science ashore, where latitude and longitude are unchanging, in a
house whose position never alters, than it is to study navigation
on a boat that is rushing along day and night toward land that
one is trying to find and which he is liable to find disastrously
at a moment when he least expects it.</p>
<p>To begin with, there are the compasses and the setting of the
courses. We sailed from Suva on Saturday afternoon, June 6,
1908, and it took us till after dark to run the narrow,
reef-ridden passage between the islands of Viti Levu and
Mbengha. The open ocean lay before me. There was
nothing in the way with the exception of Vatu Leile, a miserable
little island that persisted in poking up through the sea some
twenty miles to the west-southwest—just where I wanted to
go. Of course, it seemed quite simple to avoid it by
steering a course that would pass it eight or ten miles to the
north. It was a black night, and we were running before the
wind. The man at the wheel must be told what direction to
steer in order to miss Vatu Leile. But what
direction? I turned me to the navigation books.
“True Course” I lighted upon. The very
thing! What I wanted was the true course. I read
eagerly on:</p>
<p>“The True Course is the angle made with the meridian by
a straight line on the chart drawn to connect the ship’s
position with the place bound to.”</p>
<p>Just what I wanted. The <i>Snark’s</i> position
was at the western entrance of the passage between Viti Levu and
Mbengha. The immediate place she was bound to was a place
on the chart ten miles north of Vatu Leile. I pricked that
place off on the chart with my dividers, and with my parallel
rulers found that west-by-south was the true course. I had
but to give it to the man at the wheel and the <i>Snark</i> would
win her way to the safety of the open sea.</p>
<p>But alas and alack and lucky for me, I read on. I
discovered that the compass, that trusty, everlasting friend of
the mariner, was not given to pointing north. It
varied. Sometimes it pointed east of north, sometimes west
of north, and on occasion it even turned tail on north and
pointed south. The variation at the particular spot on the
globe occupied by the <i>Snark</i> was 9° 40′
easterly. Well, that had to be taken into account before I
gave the steering course to the man at the wheel. I
read:</p>
<p>“The Correct Magnetic Course is derived from the True
Course by applying to it the variation.”</p>
<p>Therefore, I reasoned, if the compass points 9° 40′
eastward of north, and I wanted to sail due north, I should have
to steer 9° 40′ westward of the north indicated by the
compass and which was not north at all. So I added 9°
40′ to the left of my west-by-south course, thus getting my
correct Magnetic Course, and was ready once more to run to open
sea.</p>
<p>Again alas and alack! The Correct Magnetic Course was
not the Compass Course. There was another sly little devil
lying in wait to trip me up and land me smashing on the reefs of
Vatu Leile. This little devil went by the name of
Deviation. I read:</p>
<p>“The Compass Course is the course to steer, and is
derived from the Correct Magnetic Course by applying to it the
Deviation.”</p>
<p>Now Deviation is the variation in the needle caused by the
distribution of iron on board of ship. This purely local
variation I derived from the deviation card of my standard
compass and then applied to the Correct Magnetic Course.
The result was the Compass Course. And yet, not yet.
My standard compass was amidships on the companionway. My
steering compass was aft, in the cockpit, near the wheel.
When the steering compass pointed west-by-south
three-quarters-south (the steering course), the standard compass
pointed west-one-half-north, which was certainly not the steering
course. I kept the <i>Snark</i> up till she was heading
west-by-south-three-quarters-south on the standard compass, which
gave, on the steering compass, south-west-by-west.</p>
<p>The foregoing operations constitute the simple little matter
of setting a course. And the worst of it is that one must
perform every step correctly or else he will hear “Breakers
ahead!” some pleasant night, a nice sea-bath, and be given
the delightful diversion of fighting his way to the shore through
a horde of man-eating sharks.</p>
<p>Just as the compass is tricky and strives to fool the mariner
by pointing in all directions except north, so does that guide
post of the sky, the sun, persist in not being where it ought to
be at a given time. This carelessness of the sun is the
cause of more trouble—at least it caused trouble for
me. To find out where one is on the earth’s surface,
he must know, at precisely the same time, where the sun is in the
heavens. That is to say, the sun, which is the timekeeper
for men, doesn’t run on time. When I discovered this,
I fell into deep gloom and all the Cosmos was filled with
doubt. Immutable laws, such as gravitation and the
conservation of energy, became wobbly, and I was prepared to
witness their violation at any moment and to remain
unastonished. For see, if the compass lied and the sun did
not keep its engagements, why should not objects lose their
mutual attraction and why should not a few bushel baskets of
force be annihilated? Even perpetual motion became
possible, and I was in a frame of mind prone to purchase
Keeley-Motor stock from the first enterprising agent that landed
on the <i>Snark’s</i> deck. And when I discovered
that the earth really rotated on its axis 366 times a year, while
there were only 365 sunrises and sunsets, I was ready to doubt my
own identity.</p>
<p>This is the way of the sun. It is so irregular that it
is impossible for man to devise a clock that will keep the
sun’s time. The sun accelerates and retards as no
clock could be made to accelerate and retard. The sun is
sometimes ahead of its schedule; at other times it is lagging
behind; and at still other times it is breaking the speed limit
in order to overtake itself, or, rather, to catch up with where
it ought to be in the sky. In this last case it does not
slow down quick enough, and, as a result, goes dashing ahead of
where it ought to be. In fact, only four days in a year do
the sun and the place where the sun ought to be happen to
coincide. The remaining 361 days the sun is pothering
around all over the shop. Man, being more perfect than the
sun, makes a clock that keeps regular time. Also, he
calculates how far the sun is ahead of its schedule or
behind. The difference between the sun’s position and
the position where the sun ought to be if it were a decent,
self-respecting sun, man calls the Equation of Time. Thus,
the navigator endeavouring to find his ship’s position on
the sea, looks in his chronometer to see where precisely the sun
ought to be according to the Greenwich custodian of the
sun. Then to that location he applies the Equation of Time
and finds out where the sun ought to be and isn’t.
This latter location, along with several other locations, enables
him to find out what the man from Kansas demanded to know some
years ago.</p>
<p>The <i>Snark</i> sailed from Fiji on Saturday, June 6, and the
next day, Sunday, on the wide ocean, out of sight of land, I
proceeded to endeavour to find out my position by a chronometer
sight for longitude and by a meridian observation for
latitude. The chronometer sight was taken in the morning
when the sun was some 21° above the horizon. I looked
in the Nautical Almanac and found that on that very day, June 7,
the sun was behind time 1 minute and 26 seconds, and that it was
catching up at a rate of 14.67 seconds per hour. The
chronometer said that at the precise moment of taking the
sun’s altitude it was twenty-five minutes after eight
o’clock at Greenwich. From this date it would seem a
schoolboy’s task to correct the Equation of Time.
Unfortunately, I was not a schoolboy. Obviously, at the
middle of the day, at Greenwich, the sun was 1 minute and 26
seconds behind time. Equally obviously, if it were eleven
o’clock in the morning, the sun would be 1 minute and 26
seconds behind time plus 14.67 seconds. If it were ten
o’clock in the morning, twice 14.67 seconds would have to
be added. And if it were 8: 25 in the morning, then
3½ times 14.67 seconds would have to be added. Quite
clearly, then, if, instead of being 8:25 <span class="GutSmall">A.M.</span>, it were 8:25 <span class="GutSmall">P.M.</span>, then 8½ times 14.67 seconds
would have to be, not added, but <i>subtracted</i>; for, if, at
noon, the sun were 1 minute and 26 seconds behind time, and if it
were catching up with where it ought to be at the rate of 14.67
seconds per hour, then at 8.25 <span class="GutSmall">P.M.</span>
it would be much nearer where it ought to be than it had been at
noon.</p>
<p>So far, so good. But was that 8:25 of the chronometer
<span class="GutSmall">A.M.</span>, or <span class="GutSmall">P.M.</span>? I looked at the
<i>Snark’s</i> clock. It marked 8:9, and it was
certainly <span class="GutSmall">A.M.</span> for I had just
finished breakfast. Therefore, if it was eight in the
morning on board the <i>Snark</i>, the eight o’clock of the
chronometer (which was the time of the day at Greenwich) must be
a different eight o’clock from the <i>Snark’s</i>
eight o’clock. But what eight o’clock was
it? It can’t be the eight o’clock of this
morning, I reasoned; therefore, it must be either eight
o’clock this evening or eight o’clock last night.</p>
<p>It was at this juncture that I fell into the bottomless pit of
intellectual chaos. We are in east longitude, I reasoned,
therefore we are ahead of Greenwich. If we are behind
Greenwich, then to-day is yesterday; if we are ahead of
Greenwich, then yesterday is to-day, but if yesterday is to-day,
what under the sun is to-day!—to-morrow?
Absurd! Yet it must be correct. When I took the sun
this morning at 8:25, the sun’s custodians at Greenwich
were just arising from dinner last night.</p>
<p>“Then correct the Equation of Time for yesterday,”
says my logical mind.</p>
<p>“But to-day is to-day,” my literal mind
insists. “I must correct the sun for to-day and not
for yesterday.”</p>
<p>“Yet to-day is yesterday,” urges my logical
mind.</p>
<p>“That’s all very well,” my literal mind
continues, “If I were in Greenwich I might be in
yesterday. Strange things happen in Greenwich. But I
know as sure as I am living that I am here, now, in to-day, June
7, and that I took the sun here, now, to-day, June 7.
Therefore, I must correct the sun here, now, to-day, June
7.”</p>
<p>“Bosh!” snaps my logical mind. “Lecky
says—”</p>
<p>“Never mind what Lecky says,” interrupts my
literal mind. “Let me tell you what the Nautical
Almanac says. The Nautical Almanac says that to-day, June
7, the sun was 1 minute and 26 seconds behind time and catching
up at the rate of 14.67 seconds per hour. It says that
yesterday, June 6, the sun was 1 minute and 36 seconds behind
time and catching up at the rate of 15.66 seconds per hour.
You see, it is preposterous to think of correcting to-day’s
sun by yesterday’s time-table.”</p>
<p>“Fool!”</p>
<p>“Idiot!”</p>
<p>Back and forth they wrangle until my head is whirling around
and I am ready to believe that I am in the day after the last
week before next.</p>
<p>I remembered a parting caution of the Suva harbour-master:
“<i>In east longitude take from the Nautical Almanac the
elements for the preceding day</i>.”</p>
<p>Then a new thought came to me. I corrected the Equation
of Time for Sunday and for Saturday, making two separate
operations of it, and lo, when the results were compared, there
was a difference only of four-tenths of a second. I was a
changed man. I had found my way out of the crypt. The
<i>Snark</i> was scarcely big enough to hold me and my
experience. Four-tenths of a second would make a difference
of only one-tenth of a mile—a cable-length!</p>
<p>All went merrily for ten minutes, when I chanced upon the
following rhyme for navigators:</p>
<blockquote><p>“Greenwich time least<br/>
Longitude east;<br/>
Greenwich best,<br/>
Longitude west.”</p>
</blockquote>
<p>Heavens! The <i>Snark’s</i> time was not as good
as Greenwich time. When it was 8:25 at Greenwich, on board
the <i>Snark</i> it was only 8:9. “Greenwich time
best, longitude west.” There I was. In west
longitude beyond a doubt.</p>
<p>“Silly!” cries my literal mind. “You
are 8:9 <span class="GutSmall">A.M.</span> and Greenwich is 8:25
<span class="GutSmall">P.M.</span>”</p>
<p>“Very well,” answers my logical mind.
“To be correct, 8.25 <span class="GutSmall">P.M.</span> is
really twenty hours and twenty-five minutes, and that is
certainly better than eight hours and nine minutes. No,
there is no discussion; you are in west longitude.”</p>
<p>Then my literal mind triumphs.</p>
<p>“We sailed from Suva, in the Fijis, didn’t
we?” it demands, and logical mind agrees. “And
Suva is in east longitude?” Again logical mind
agrees. “And we sailed west (which would take us
deeper into east longitude), didn’t we? Therefore,
and you can’t escape it, we are in east
longitude.”</p>
<p>“Greenwich time best, longitude west,” chants my
logical mind; “and you must grant that twenty hours and
twenty-five minutes is better than eight hours and nine
minutes.”</p>
<p>“All right,” I break in upon the squabble;
“we’ll work up the sight and then we’ll
see.”</p>
<p>And work it up I did, only to find that my longitude was
184° west.</p>
<p>“I told you so,” snorts my logical mind.</p>
<p>I am dumbfounded. So is my literal mind, for several
minutes. Then it enounces:</p>
<p>“But there is no 184° west longitude, nor east
longitude, nor any other longitude. The largest meridian is
180° as you ought to know very well.”</p>
<p>Having got this far, literal mind collapses from the brain
strain, logical mind is dumb flabbergasted; and as for me, I get
a bleak and wintry look in my eyes and go around wondering
whether I am sailing toward the China coast or the Gulf of
Darien.</p>
<p>Then a thin small voice, which I do not recognize, coming from
nowhere in particular in my consciousness, says:</p>
<p>“The total number of degrees is 360. Subtract the
184° west longitude from 360°, and you will get 176°
east longitude.”</p>
<p>“That is sheer speculation,” objects literal mind;
and logical mind remonstrates. “There is no rule for
it.”</p>
<p>“Darn the rules!” I exclaim.
“Ain’t I here?”</p>
<p>“The thing is self-evident,” I continue.
“184° west longitude means a lapping over in east
longitude of four degrees. Besides I have been in east
longitude all the time. I sailed from Fiji, and Fiji is in
east longitude. Now I shall chart my position and prove it
by dead reckoning.”</p>
<p>But other troubles and doubts awaited me. Here is a
sample of one. In south latitude, when the sun is in
northern declination, chronometer sights may be taken early in
the morning. I took mine at eight o’clock. Now,
one of the necessary elements in working up such a sight is
latitude. But one gets latitude at twelve o’clock,
noon, by a meridian observation. It is clear that in order
to work up my eight o’clock chronometer sight I must have
my eight o’clock latitude. Of course, if the
<i>Snark</i> were sailing due west at six knots per hour, for the
intervening four hours her latitude would not change. But
if she were sailing due south, her latitude would change to the
tune of twenty-four miles. In which case a simple addition
or subtraction would convert the twelve o’clock latitude
into eight o’clock latitude. But suppose the
<i>Snark</i> were sailing southwest. Then the traverse
tables must be consulted.</p>
<p>This is the illustration. At eight <span class="GutSmall">A.M.</span> I took my chronometer sight.
At the same moment the distance recorded on the log was
noted. At twelve <span class="GutSmall">M.</span>, when the
sight for latitude was taken, I again noted the log, which
showed me that since eight o’clock the <i>Snark</i> had run
24 miles. Her true course had been west ¾
south. I entered Table I, in the distance column, on the
page for ¾ point courses, and stopped at 24, the number of
miles run. Opposite, in the next two columns, I found that
the <i>Snark</i> had made 3.5 miles of southing or latitude, and
that she had made 23.7 miles of westing. To find my eight
o’clock’ latitude was easy. I had but to
subtract 3.5 miles from my noon latitude. All the elements
being present, I worked up my longitude.</p>
<p>But this was my eight o’clock longitude. Since
then, and up till noon, I had made 23.7 miles of westing.
What was my noon longitude? I followed the rule, turning to
Traverse Table No. II. Entering the table, according to
rule, and going through every detail, according to rule, I found
the difference of longitude for the four hours to be 25
miles. I was aghast. I entered the table again,
according to rule; I entered the table half a dozen times,
according to rule, and every time found that my difference of
longitude was 25 miles. I leave it to you, gentle
reader. Suppose you had sailed 24 miles and that you had
covered 3.5 miles of latitude, then how could you have covered 25
miles of longitude? Even if you had sailed due west 24
miles, and not changed your latitude, how could you have changed
your longitude 25 miles? In the name of human reason, how
could you cover one mile more of longitude than the total number
of miles you had sailed?</p>
<p>It was a reputable traverse table, being none other than
Bowditch’s. The rule was simple (as navigators’
rules go); I had made no error. I spent an hour over it,
and at the end still faced the glaring impossibility of having
sailed 24 miles, in the course of which I changed my latitude 3.5
miles and my longitude 25 miles. The worst of it was that
there was nobody to help me out. Neither Charmian nor
Martin knew as much as I knew about navigation. And all the
time the <i>Snark</i> was rushing madly along toward Tanna, in
the New Hebrides. Something had to be done.</p>
<p>How it came to me I know not—call it an inspiration if
you will; but the thought arose in me: if southing is latitude,
why isn’t westing longitude? Why should I have to
change westing into longitude? And then the whole beautiful
situation dawned upon me. The meridians of longitude are 60
miles (nautical) apart at the equator. At the poles they
run together. Thus, if I should travel up the 180°
meridian of longitude until I reached the North Pole, and if the
astronomer at Greenwich travelled up the 0 meridian of longitude
to the North Pole, then, at the North Pole, we could shake hands
with each other, though before we started for the North Pole we
had been some thousands of miles apart. Again: if a degree
of longitude was 60 miles wide at the equator, and if the same
degree, at the point of the Pole, had no width, then somewhere
between the Pole and the equator that degree would be half a mile
wide, and at other places a mile wide, two miles wide, ten miles
wide, thirty miles wide, ay, and sixty miles wide.</p>
<p>All was plain again. The <i>Snark</i> was in 19°
south latitude. The world wasn’t as big around there
as at the equator. Therefore, every mile of westing at
19° south was more than a minute of longitude; for sixty
miles were sixty miles, but sixty minutes are sixty miles only at
the equator. George Francis Train broke Jules Verne’s
record of around the world. But any man that wants can
break George Francis Train’s record. Such a man would
need only to go, in a fast steamer, to the latitude of Cape Horn,
and sail due east all the way around. The world is very
small in that latitude, and there is no land in the way to turn
him out of his course. If his steamer maintained sixteen
knots, he would circumnavigate the globe in just about forty
days.</p>
<p>But there are compensations. On Wednesday evening, June
10, I brought up my noon position by dead reckoning to eight
<span class="GutSmall">P.M.</span> Then I projected the
<i>Snark’s</i> course and saw that she would strike Futuna,
one of the easternmost of the New Hebrides, a volcanic cone two
thousand feet high that rose out of the deep ocean. I
altered the course so that the <i>Snark</i> would pass ten miles
to the northward. Then I spoke to Wada, the cook, who had
the wheel every morning from four to six.</p>
<p>“Wada San, to-morrow morning, your watch, you look sharp
on weather-bow you see land.”</p>
<p>And then I went to bed. The die was cast. I had
staked my reputation as a navigator. Suppose, just suppose,
that at daybreak there was no land. Then, where would my
navigation be? And where would we be? And how would
we ever find ourselves? or find any land? I caught ghastly
visions of the <i>Snark</i> sailing for months through ocean
solitudes and seeking vainly for land while we consumed our
provisions and sat down with haggard faces to stare cannibalism
in the face.</p>
<p>I confess my sleep was not</p>
<blockquote><p>“ . . . like a summer sky<br/>
That held the music of a lark.”</p>
</blockquote>
<p>Rather did “I waken to the voiceless dark,” and
listen to the creaking of the bulkheads and the rippling of the
sea alongside as the <i>Snark</i> logged steadily her six knots
an hour. I went over my calculations again and again,
striving to find some mistake, until my brain was in such fever
that it discovered dozens of mistakes. Suppose, instead of
being sixty miles off Futuna, that my navigation was all wrong
and that I was only six miles off? In which case my course
would be wrong, too, and for all I knew the <i>Snark</i> might be
running straight at Futuna. For all I knew the <i>Snark</i>
might strike Futuna the next moment. I almost sprang from
the bunk at that thought; and, though I restrained myself, I know
that I lay for a moment, nervous and tense, waiting for the
shock.</p>
<p>My sleep was broken by miserable nightmares. Earthquake
seemed the favourite affliction, though there was one man, with a
bill, who persisted in dunning me throughout the night.
Also, he wanted to fight; and Charmian continually persuaded me
to let him alone. Finally, however, the man with the
everlasting dun ventured into a dream from which Charmian was
absent. It was my opportunity, and we went at it,
gloriously, all over the sidewalk and street, until he cried
enough. Then I said, “Now how about that
bill?” Having conquered, I was willing to pay.
But the man looked at me and groaned. “It was all a
mistake,” he said; “the bill is for the house next
door.”</p>
<p>That settled him, for he worried my dreams no more; and it
settled me, too, for I woke up chuckling at the episode. It
was three in the morning. I went up on deck. Henry,
the Rapa islander, was steering. I looked at the log.
It recorded forty-two miles. The <i>Snark</i> had not
abated her six-knot gait, and she had not struck Futuna
yet. At half-past five I was again on deck. Wada, at
the wheel, had seen no land. I sat on the cockpit rail, a
prey to morbid doubt for a quarter of an hour. Then I saw
land, a small, high piece of land, just where it ought to be,
rising from the water on the weather-bow. At six
o’clock I could clearly make it out to be the beautiful
volcanic cone of Futuna. At eight o’clock, when it
was abreast, I took its distance by the sextant and found it to
be 9.3 miles away. And I had elected to pass it 10 miles
away!</p>
<p>Then, to the south, Aneiteum rose out of the sea, to the
north, Aniwa, and, dead ahead, Tanna. There was no
mistaking Tanna, for the smoke of its volcano was towering high
in the sky. It was forty miles away, and by afternoon, as
we drew close, never ceasing to log our six knots, we saw that it
was a mountainous, hazy land, with no apparent openings in its
coast-line. I was looking for Port Resolution, though I was
quite prepared to find that as an anchorage, it had been
destroyed. Volcanic earthquakes had lifted its bottom
during the last forty years, so that where once the largest ships
rode at anchor there was now, by last reports, scarcely space and
depth sufficient for the <i>Snark</i>. And why should not
another convulsion, since the last report, have closed the
harbour completely?</p>
<p>I ran in close to the unbroken coast, fringed with rocks awash
upon which the crashing trade-wind sea burst white and
high. I searched with my glasses for miles, but could see
no entrance. I took a compass bearing of Futuna, another of
Aniwa, and laid them off on the chart. Where the two
bearings crossed was bound to be the position of the
<i>Snark</i>. Then, with my parallel rulers, I laid down a
course from the <i>Snark’s</i> position to Port
Resolution. Having corrected this course for variation and
deviation, I went on deck, and lo, the course directed me towards
that unbroken coast-line of bursting seas. To my Rapa
islander’s great concern, I held on till the rocks awash
were an eighth of a mile away.</p>
<p>“No harbour this place,” he announced, shaking his
head ominously.</p>
<p>But I altered the course and ran along parallel with the
coast. Charmian was at the wheel. Martin was at the
engine, ready to throw on the propeller. A narrow slit of
an opening showed up suddenly. Through the glasses I could
see the seas breaking clear across. Henry, the Rapa man,
looked with troubled eyes; so did Tehei, the Tahaa man.</p>
<p>“No passage, there,” said Henry. “We
go there, we finish quick, sure.”</p>
<p>I confess I thought so, too; but I ran on abreast, watching to
see if the line of breakers from one side the entrance did not
overlap the line from the other side. Sure enough, it
did. A narrow place where the sea ran smooth
appeared. Charmian put down the wheel and steadied
for the entrance. Martin threw on the engine, while all
hands and the cook sprang to take in sail.</p>
<p>A trader’s house showed up in the bight of the
bay. A geyser, on the shore, a hundred yards away; spouted
a column of steam. To port, as we rounded a tiny point, the
mission station appeared.</p>
<p>“Three fathoms,” cried Wada at the
lead-line. “Three fathoms,” “two
fathoms,” came in quick succession.</p>
<p>Charmian put the wheel down, Martin stopped the engine, and
the <i>Snark</i> rounded to and the anchor rumbled down in three
fathoms. Before we could catch our breaths a swarm of black
Tannese was alongside and aboard—grinning, apelike
creatures, with kinky hair and troubled eyes, wearing safety-pins
and clay-pipes in their slitted ears: and as for the rest,
wearing nothing behind and less than that before. And I
don’t mind telling that that night, when everybody was
asleep, I sneaked up on deck, looked out over the quiet scene,
and gloated—yes, gloated—over my navigation.</p>
<h2><SPAN name="chap15"></SPAN>CHAPTER XV<br/> <span class="GutSmall">CRUISING IN THE SOLOMONS</span></h2>
<p>“<span class="smcap">Why</span> not come along
now?” said Captain Jansen to us, at Penduffryn, on the
island of Guadalcanar.</p>
<p>Charmian and I looked at each other and debated silently for
half a minute. Then we nodded our heads
simultaneously. It is a way we have of making up our minds
to do things; and a very good way it is when one has no
temperamental tears to shed over the last tin-of condensed milk
when it has capsized. (We are living on tinned goods these
days, and since mind is rumoured to be an emanation of matter,
our similes are naturally of the packing-house variety.)</p>
<p>“You’d better bring your revolvers along, and a
couple of rifles,” said Captain Jansen.
“I’ve got five rifles aboard, though the one Mauser
is without ammunition. Have you a few rounds to
spare?”</p>
<p>We brought our rifles on board, several handfuls of Mauser
cartridges, and Wada and Nakata, the <i>Snark’s</i> cook
and cabin-boy respectively. Wada and Nakata were in a bit
of a funk. To say the least, they were not enthusiastic,
though never did Nakata show the white feather in the face of
danger. The Solomon Islands had not dealt kindly with
them. In the first place, both had suffered from Solomon
sores. So had the rest of us (at the time, I was nursing
two fresh ones on a diet of corrosive sublimate); but the two
Japanese had had more than their share. And the sores are
not nice. They may be described as excessively active
ulcers. A mosquito bite, a cut, or the slightest abrasion,
serves for lodgment of the poison with which the air seems to be
filled. Immediately the ulcer commences to eat. It
eats in every direction, consuming skin and muscle with
astounding rapidity. The pin-point ulcer of the first day
is the size of a dime by the second day, and by the end of the
week a silver dollar will not cover it.</p>
<p>Worse than the sores, the two Japanese had been afflicted with
Solomon Island fever. Each had been down repeatedly with
it, and in their weak, convalescent moments they were wont to
huddle together on the portion of the <i>Snark</i> that happened
to be nearest to faraway Japan, and to gaze yearningly in that
direction.</p>
<p>But worst of all, they were now brought on board the
<i>Minota</i> for a recruiting cruise along the savage coast of
Malaita. Wada, who had the worse funk, was sure that he
would never see Japan again, and with bleak, lack-lustre eyes he
watched our rifles and ammunition going on board the
<i>Minota</i>. He knew about the <i>Minota</i> and her
Malaita cruises. He knew that she had been captured six
months before on the Malaita coast, that her captain had been
chopped to pieces with tomahawks, and that, according to the
barbarian sense of equity on that sweet isle, she owed two more
heads. Also, a labourer on Penduffryn Plantation, a Malaita
boy, had just died of dysentery, and Wada knew that Penduffryn
had been put in the debt of Malaita by one more head.
Furthermore, in stowing our luggage away in the skipper’s
tiny cabin, he saw the axe gashes on the door where the
triumphant bushmen had cut their way in. And, finally, the
galley stove was without a pipe—said pipe having been part
of the loot.</p>
<p>The <i>Minota</i> was a teak-built, Australian yacht,
ketch-rigged, long and lean, with a deep fin-keel, and designed
for harbour racing rather than for recruiting blacks. When
Charmian and I came on board, we found her crowded. Her
double boat’s crew, including substitutes, was fifteen, and
she had a score and more of “return” boys, whose time
on the plantations was served and who were bound back to their
bush villages. To look at, they were certainly true
head-hunting cannibals. Their perforated nostrils were
thrust through with bone and wooden bodkins the size of
lead-pencils. Numbers of them had punctured the extreme
meaty point of the nose, from which protruded, straight out,
spikes of turtle-shell or of beads strung on stiff wire. A
few had further punctured their noses with rows of holes
following the curves of the nostrils from lip to point.
Each ear of every man had from two to a dozen holes in
it—holes large enough to carry wooden plugs three inches in
diameter down to tiny holes in which were carried clay-pipes and
similar trifles. In fact, so many holes did they possess
that they lacked ornaments to fill them; and when, the following
day, as we neared Malaita, we tried out our rifles to see that
they were in working order, there was a general scramble for the
empty cartridges, which were thrust forthwith into the many
aching voids in our passengers’ ears.</p>
<p>At the time we tried out our rifles we put up our barbed wire
railings. The <i>Minota</i>, crown-decked, without any
house, and with a rail six inches high, was too accessible to
boarders. So brass stanchions were screwed into the rail
and a double row of barbed wire stretched around her from stem to
stern and back again. Which was all very well as a
protection from savages, but it was mighty uncomfortable to those
on board when the <i>Minota</i> took to jumping and plunging in a
sea-way. When one dislikes sliding down upon the lee-rail
barbed wire, and when he dares not catch hold of the weather-rail
barbed wire to save himself from sliding, and when, with these
various disinclinations, he finds himself on a smooth flush-deck
that is heeled over at an angle of forty-five degrees, some of
the delights of Solomon Islands cruising may be
comprehended. Also, it must be remembered, the penalty of a
fall into the barbed wire is more than the mere scratches, for
each scratch is practically certain to become a venomous
ulcer. That caution will not save one from the wire was
evidenced one fine morning when we were running along the Malaita
coast with the breeze on our quarter. The wind was fresh,
and a tidy sea was making. A black boy was at the
wheel. Captain Jansen, Mr. Jacobsen (the mate), Charmian,
and I had just sat down on deck to breakfast. Three
unusually large seas caught us. The boy at the wheel lost
his head. Three times the <i>Minota</i> was swept.
The breakfast was rushed over the lee-rail. The knives and
forks went through the scuppers; a boy aft went clean overboard
and was dragged back; and our doughty skipper lay half inboard
and half out, jammed in the barbed wire. After that, for
the rest of the cruise, our joint use of the several remaining
eating utensils was a splendid example of primitive
communism. On the <i>Eugenie</i>, however, it was even
worse, for we had but one teaspoon among four of us—but the
<i>Eugenie</i> is another story.</p>
<p>Our first port was Su’u on the west coast of
Malaita. The Solomon Islands are on the fringe of
things. It is difficult enough sailing on dark nights
through reef-spiked channels and across erratic currents where
there are no lights to guide (from northwest to southeast the
Solomons extend across a thousand miles of sea, and on all the
thousands of miles of coasts there is not one lighthouse); but
the difficulty is seriously enhanced by the fact that the land
itself is not correctly charted. Su’u is an
example. On the Admiralty chart of Malaita the coast at
this point runs a straight, unbroken line. Yet across this
straight, unbroken line the <i>Minota</i> sailed in twenty
fathoms of water. Where the land was alleged to be, was a
deep indentation. Into this we sailed, the mangroves
closing about us, till we dropped anchor in a mirrored
pond. Captain Jansen did not like the anchorage. It
was the first time he had been there, and Su’u had a bad
reputation. There was no wind with which to get away in
case of attack, while the crew could be bushwhacked to a man if
they attempted to tow out in the whale-boat. It was a
pretty trap, if trouble blew up.</p>
<p>“Suppose the <i>Minota</i> went ashore—what would
you do?” I asked.</p>
<p>“She’s not going ashore,” was Captain
Jansen’s answer.</p>
<p>“But just in case she did?” I insisted. He
considered for a moment and shifted his glance from the mate
buckling on a revolver to the boat’s crew climbing into the
whale-boat each man with a rifle.</p>
<p>“We’d get into the whale-boat, and get out of here
as fast as God’d let us,” came the skipper’s
delayed reply.</p>
<p>He explained at length that no white man was sure of his
<i>Malaita</i> crew in a tight place; that the bushmen looked
upon all wrecks as their personal property; that the bushmen
possessed plenty of Snider rifles; and that he had on board a
dozen “return” boys for Su’u who were certain
to join in with their friends and relatives ashore when it came
to looting the <i>Minota</i>.</p>
<p>The first work of the whale-boat was to take the
“return” boys and their trade-boxes ashore.
Thus one danger was removed. While this was being done, a
canoe came alongside manned by three naked savages. And
when I say naked, I mean naked. Not one vestige of clothing
did they have on, unless nose-rings, ear-plugs, and shell armlets
be accounted clothing. The head man in the canoe was an old
chief, one-eyed, reputed to be friendly, and so dirty that a
boat-scraper would have lost its edge on him. His mission
was to warn the skipper against allowing any of his people to go
ashore. The old fellow repeated the warning again that
night.</p>
<p>In vain did the whale-boat ply about the shores of the bay in
quest of recruits. The bush was full of armed natives; all
willing enough to talk with the recruiter, but not one would
engage to sign on for three years’ plantation labour at six
pounds per year. Yet they were anxious enough to get our
people ashore. On the second day they raised a smoke on the
beach at the head of the bay. This being the customary
signal of men desiring to recruit, the boat was sent. But
nothing resulted. No one recruited, nor were any of our men
lured ashore. A little later we caught glimpses of a number
of armed natives moving about on the beach.</p>
<p>Outside of these rare glimpses, there was no telling how many
might be lurking in the bush. There was no penetrating that
primeval jungle with the eye. In the afternoon, Captain
Jansen, Charmian, and I went dynamiting fish. Each one of
the boat’s crew carried a Lee-Enfield.
“Johnny,” the native recruiter, had a Winchester
beside him at the steering sweep. We rowed in close to a
portion of the shore that looked deserted. Here the boat
was turned around and backed in; in case of attack, the boat
would be ready to dash away. In all the time I was on
Malaita I never saw a boat land bow on. In fact, the
recruiting vessels use two boats—one to go in on the beach,
armed, of course, and the other to lie off several hundred feet
and “cover” the first boat. The <i>Minota</i>,
however, being a small vessel, did not carry a covering boat.</p>
<p>We were close in to the shore and working in closer,
stern-first, when a school of fish was sighted. The fuse
was ignited and the stick of dynamite thrown. With the
explosion, the surface of the water was broken by the flash of
leaping fish. At the same instant the woods broke into
life. A score of naked savages, armed with bows and arrows,
spears, and Sniders, burst out upon the shore. At the same
moment our boat’s crew lifted their rifles. And thus
the opposing parties faced each other, while our extra boys dived
over after the stunned fish.</p>
<p>Three fruitless days were spent at Su’u. The
<i>Minota</i> got no recruits from the bush, and the bushmen got
no heads from the <i>Minota</i>. In fact, the only one who
got anything was Wada, and his was a nice dose of fever. We
towed out with the whale-boat, and ran along the coast to Langa
Langa, a large village of salt-water people, built with
prodigious labour on a lagoon sand-bank—literally
<i>built</i> up, an artificial island reared as a refuge from the
blood-thirsty bushmen. Here, also, on the shore side of the
lagoon, was Binu, the place where the <i>Minota</i> was captured
half a year previously and her captain killed by the
bushmen. As we sailed in through the narrow entrance, a
canoe came alongside with the news that the man-of-war had just
left that morning after having burned three villages, killed some
thirty pigs, and drowned a baby. This was the Cambrian,
Captain Lewes commanding. He and I had first met in Korea
during the Japanese-Russian War, and we had been crossing each
other’s trail ever since without ever a meeting. The
day the <i>Snark</i> sailed into Suva, in the Fijis, we made out
the <i>Cambrian</i> going out. At Vila, in the New
Hebrides, we missed each other by one day. We passed each
other in the night-time off the island of Santo. And the
day the <i>Cambrian</i> arrived at Tulagi, we sailed from
Penduffryn, a dozen miles away. And here at Langa Langa we
had missed by several hours.</p>
<p>The <i>Cambrian</i> had come to punish the murderers of the
<i>Minota’s</i> captain, but what she had succeeded in
doing we did not learn until later in the day, when a Mr. Abbot,
a missionary, came alongside in his whale-boat. The
villages had been burned and the pigs killed. But the
natives had escaped personal harm. The murderers had not
been captured, though the <i>Minota’s</i> flag and other of
her gear had been recovered. The drowning of the baby had
come about through a misunderstanding. Chief Johnny, of
Binu, had declined to guide the landing party into the bush, nor
could any of his men be induced to perform that office.
Whereupon Captain Lewes, righteously indignant, had told Chief
Johnny that he deserved to have his village burned.
Johnny’s <i>bêche de mer</i> English did not include
the word “deserve.” So his understanding of it
was that his village was to be burned anyway. The immediate
stampede of the inhabitants was so hurried that the baby was
dropped into the water. In the meantime Chief Johnny
hastened to Mr. Abbot. Into his hand he put fourteen
sovereigns and requested him to go on board the <i>Cambrian</i>
and buy Captain Lewes off. Johnny’s village was not
burned. Nor did Captain Lewes get the fourteen sovereigns,
for I saw them later in Johnny’s possession when he boarded
the <i>Minota</i>. The excuse Johnny gave me for not
guiding the landing party was a big boil which he proudly
revealed. His real reason, however, and a perfectly valid
one, though he did not state it, was fear of revenge on the part
of the bushmen. Had he, or any of his men, guided the
marines, he could have looked for bloody reprisals as soon as the
<i>Cambrian</i> weighed anchor.</p>
<p>As an illustration of conditions in the Solomons,
Johnny’s business on board was to turn over, for a tobacco
consideration, the sprit, mainsail, and jib of a
whale-boat. Later in the day, a Chief Billy came on board
and turned over, for a tobacco consideration, the mast and
boom. This gear belonged to a whale-boat which Captain
Jansen had recovered the previous trip of the
<i>Minota</i>. The whale-boat belonged to Meringe
Plantation on the island of Ysabel. Eleven contract
labourers, Malaita men and bushmen at that, had decided to run
away. Being bushmen, they knew nothing of salt water nor of
the way of a boat in the sea. So they persuaded two natives
of San Cristoval, salt-water men, to run away with them. It
served the San Cristoval men right. They should have known
better. When they had safely navigated the stolen boat to
Malaita, they had their heads hacked off for their pains.
It was this boat and gear that Captain Jansen had recovered.</p>
<p>Not for nothing have I journeyed all the way to the
Solomons. At last I have seen Charmian’s proud spirit
humbled and her imperious queendom of femininity dragged in the
dust. It happened at Langa Langa, ashore, on the
manufactured island which one cannot see for the houses.
Here, surrounded by hundreds of unblushing naked men, women, and
children, we wandered about and saw the sights. We had our
revolvers strapped on, and the boat’s crew, fully armed,
lay at the oars, stern in; but the lesson of the man-of-war was
too recent for us to apprehend trouble. We walked about
everywhere and saw everything until at last we approached a large
tree trunk that served as a bridge across a shallow
estuary. The blacks formed a wall in front of us and
refused to let us pass. We wanted to know why we were
stopped. The blacks said we could go on. We
misunderstood, and started. Explanations became more
definite. Captain Jansen and I, being men, could go
on. But no Mary was allowed to wade around that bridge,
much less cross it. “Mary” is bêche de
mer for woman. Charmian was a Mary. To her the bridge
was tambo, which is the native for taboo. Ah, how my chest
expanded! At last my manhood was vindicated. In truth
I belonged to the lordly sex. Charmian could trapse along
at our heels, but we were MEN, and we could go right over that
bridge while she would have to go around by whale-boat.</p>
<p>Now I should not care to be misunderstood by what follows; but
it is a matter of common knowledge in the Solomons that attacks
of fever are often brought on by shock. Inside half an hour
after Charmian had been refused the right of way, she was being
rushed aboard the <i>Minota</i>, packed in blankets, and dosed
with quinine. I don’t know what kind of shock had
happened to Wada and Nakata, but at any rate they were down with
fever as well. The Solomons might be healthfuller.</p>
<p>Also, during the attack of fever, Charmian developed a Solomon
sore. It was the last straw. Every one on the
<i>Snark</i> had been afflicted except her. I had thought
that I was going to lose my foot at the ankle by one
exceptionally malignant boring ulcer. Henry and Tehei, the
Tahitian sailors, had had numbers of them. Wada had been
able to count his by the score. Nakata had had single ones
three inches in length. Martin had been quite certain that
necrosis of his shinbone had set in from the roots of the amazing
colony he elected to cultivate in that locality. But
Charmian had escaped. Out of her long immunity had been
bred contempt for the rest of us. Her ego was flattered to
such an extent that one day she shyly informed me that it was all
a matter of pureness of blood. Since all the rest of us
cultivated the sores, and since she did not—well, anyway,
hers was the size of a silver dollar, and the pureness of her
blood enabled her to cure it after several weeks of strenuous
nursing. She pins her faith to corrosive sublimate.
Martin swears by iodoform. Henry uses lime-juice
undiluted. And I believe that when corrosive sublimate is
slow in taking hold, alternate dressings of peroxide of hydrogen
are just the thing. There are white men in the Solomons who
stake all upon boracic acid, and others who are prejudiced in
favour of lysol. I also have the weakness of a
panacea. It is California. I defy any man to get a
Solomon Island sore in California.</p>
<p>We ran down the lagoon from Langa Langa, between mangrove
swamps, through passages scarcely wider than the <i>Minota</i>,
and past the reef villages of Kaloka and Auki. Like the
founders of Venice, these salt-water men were originally refugees
from the mainland. Too weak to hold their own in the bush,
survivors of village massacres, they fled to the sand-banks of
the lagoon. These sand-banks they built up into
islands. They were compelled to seek their provender from
the sea, and in time they became salt-water men. They
learned the ways of the fish and the shellfish, and they invented
hooks and lines, nets and fish-traps. They developed
canoe-bodies. Unable to walk about, spending all their time
in the canoes, they became thick-armed and broad-shouldered, with
narrow waists and frail spindly legs. Controlling the
sea-coast, they became wealthy, trade with the interior passing
largely through their hands. But perpetual enmity exists
between them and the bushmen. Practically their only truces
are on market-days, which occur at stated intervals, usually
twice a week. The bushwomen and the salt-water women do the
bartering. Back in the bush, a hundred yards away, fully
armed, lurk the bushmen, while to seaward, in the canoes, are the
salt-water men. There are very rare instances of the
market-day truces being broken. The bushmen like their fish
too well, while the salt-water men have an organic craving for
the vegetables they cannot grow on their crowded islets.</p>
<p>Thirty miles from Langa Langa brought us to the passage
between Bassakanna Island and the mainland. Here, at
nightfall, the wind left us, and all night, with the whale-boat
towing ahead and the crew on board sweating at the sweeps, we
strove to win through. But the tide was against us.
At midnight, midway in the passage, we came up with the
<i>Eugenie</i>, a big recruiting schooner, towing with two
whale-boats. Her skipper, Captain Keller, a sturdy young
German of twenty-two, came on board for a “gam,” and
the latest news of Malaita was swapped back and forth. He
had been in luck, having gathered in twenty recruits at the
village of Fiu. While lying there, one of the customary
courageous killings had taken place. The murdered boy was
what is called a salt-water bushman—that is, a salt-water
man who is half bushman and who lives by the sea but does not
live on an islet. Three bushmen came down to this man where
he was working in his garden. They behaved in friendly
fashion, and after a time suggested <i>kai-kai</i>.
<i>Kai-kai</i> means food. He built a fire and started to
boil some taro. While bending over the pot, one of the
bushmen shot him through the head. He fell into the flames,
whereupon they thrust a spear through his stomach, turned it
around, and broke it off.</p>
<p>“My word,” said Captain Keller, “I
don’t want ever to be shot with a Snider.
Spread! You could drive a horse and carriage through that
hole in his head.”</p>
<p>Another recent courageous killing I heard of on Malaita was
that of an old man. A bush chief had died a natural
death. Now the bushmen don’t believe in natural
deaths. No one was ever known to die a natural death.
The only way to die is by bullet, tomahawk, or spear
thrust. When a man dies in any other way, it is a clear
case of having been charmed to death. When the bush chief
died naturally, his tribe placed the guilt on a certain
family. Since it did not matter which one of the family was
killed, they selected this old man who lived by himself.
This would make it easy. Furthermore, he possessed no
Snider. Also, he was blind. The old fellow got an
inkling of what was coming and laid in a large supply of
arrows. Three brave warriors, each with a Snider, came down
upon him in the night time. All night they fought valiantly
with him. Whenever they moved in the bush and made a noise
or a rustle, he discharged an arrow in that direction. In
the morning, when his last arrow was gone, the three heroes crept
up to him and blew his brains out.</p>
<p>Morning found us still vainly toiling through the
passage. At last, in despair, we turned tail, ran out to
sea, and sailed clear round Bassakanna to our objective,
Malu. The anchorage at Malu was very good, but it lay
between the shore and an ugly reef, and while easy to enter, it
was difficult to leave. The direction of the southeast
trade necessitated a beat to windward; the point of the reef was
widespread and shallow; while a current bore down at all times
upon the point.</p>
<p>Mr. Caulfeild, the missionary at Malu, arrived in his
whale-boat from a trip down the coast. A slender, delicate
man he was, enthusiastic in his work, level-headed and practical,
a true twentieth-century soldier of the Lord. When he came
down to this station on Malaita, as he said, he agreed to come
for six months. He further agreed that if he were alive at
the end of that time, he would continue on. Six years had
passed and he was still continuing on. Nevertheless he was
justified in his doubt as to living longer than six months.
Three missionaries had preceded him on Malaita, and in less than
that time two had died of fever and the third had gone home a
wreck.</p>
<p>“What murder are you talking about?” he asked
suddenly, in the midst of a confused conversation with Captain
Jansen.</p>
<p>Captain Jansen explained.</p>
<p>“Oh, that’s not the one I have reference
to,” quoth Mr. Caulfeild. “That’s old
already. It happened two weeks ago.”</p>
<p>It was here at Malu that I atoned for all the exulting and
gloating I had been guilty of over the Solomon sore Charmian had
collected at Langa Langa. Mr. Caulfeild was indirectly
responsible for my atonement. He presented us with a
chicken, which I pursued into the bush with a rifle. My
intention was to clip off its head. I succeeded, but in
doing so fell over a log and barked my shin. Result: three
Solomon sores. This made five all together that were
adorning my person. Also, Captain Jansen and Nakata had
caught <i>gari-gari</i>. Literally translated,
<i>gari-gari</i> is scratch-scratch. But translation was
not necessary for the rest of us. The skipper’s and
Nakata’s gymnastics served as a translation without
words.</p>
<p>(No, the Solomon Islands are not as healthy as they might
be. I am writing this article on the island of Ysabel,
where we have taken the <i>Snark</i> to careen and clean her
cooper. I got over my last attack of fever this morning,
and I have had only one free day between attacks.
Charmian’s are two weeks apart. Wada is a wreck from
fever. Last night he showed all the symptoms of coming down
with pneumonia. Henry, a strapping giant of a Tahitian,
just up from his last dose of fever, is dragging around the deck
like a last year’s crab-apple. Both he and Tehei have
accumulated a praiseworthy display of Solomon sores. Also,
they have caught a new form of gari-gari, a sort of vegetable
poisoning like poison oak or poison ivy. But they are not
unique in this. A number of days ago Charmian, Martin, and
I went pigeon-shooting on a small island, and we have had a
foretaste of eternal torment ever since. Also, on that
small island, Martin cut the soles of his feet to ribbons on the
coral whilst chasing a shark—at least, so he says, but from
the glimpse I caught of him I thought it was the other way
about. The coral-cuts have all become Solomon sores.
Before my last fever I knocked the skin off my knuckles while
heaving on a line, and I now have three fresh sores. And
poor Nakata! For three weeks he has been unable to sit
down. He sat down yesterday for the first time, and managed
to stay down for fifteen minutes. He says cheerfully that
he expects to be cured of his gari-gari in another month.
Furthermore, his gari-gari, from too enthusiastic
scratch-scratching, has furnished footholds for countless Solomon
sores. Still furthermore, he has just come down with his
seventh attack of fever. If I were king, the worst
punishment I could inflict on my enemies would be to banish them
to the Solomons. On second thought, king or no king, I
don’t think I’d have the heart to do it.)</p>
<p>Recruiting plantation labourers on a small, narrow yacht,
built for harbour sailing, is not any too nice. The decks
swarm with recruits and their families. The main cabin is
packed with them. At night they sleep there. The only
entrance to our tiny cabin is through the main cabin, and we jam
our way through them or walk over them. Nor is this
nice. One and all, they are afflicted with every form of
malignant skin disease. Some have ringworm, others have
<i>bukua</i>. This latter is caused by a vegetable parasite
that invades the skin and eats it away. The itching is
intolerable. The afflicted ones scratch until the air is
filled with fine dry flakes. Then there are yaws and many
other skin ulcerations. Men come aboard with Solomon sores
in their feet so large that they can walk only on their toes, or
with holes in their legs so terrible that a fist could be thrust
in to the bone. Blood-poisoning is very frequent, and
Captain Jansen, with sheath-knife and sail needle, operates
lavishly on one and all. No matter how desperate the
situation, after opening and cleansing, he claps on a poultice of
sea-biscuit soaked in water. Whenever we see a particularly
horrible case, we retire to a corner and deluge our own sores
with corrosive sublimate. And so we live and eat and sleep
on the <i>Minota</i>, taking our chance and “pretending it
is good.”</p>
<p>At Suava, another artificial island, I had a second crow over
Charmian. A big fella marster belong Suava (which means the
high chief of Suava) came on board. But first he sent an
emissary to Captain Jansen for a fathom of calico with which to
cover his royal nakedness. Meanwhile he lingered in the
canoe alongside. The regal dirt on his chest I swear was
half an inch thick, while it was a good wager that the underneath
layers were anywhere from ten to twenty years of age. He
sent his emissary on board again, who explained that the big
fella marster belong Suava was condescendingly willing enough to
shake hands with Captain Jansen and me and cadge a stick or so of
trade tobacco, but that nevertheless his high-born soul was still
at so lofty an altitude that it could not sink itself to such a
depth of degradation as to shake hands with a mere female
woman. Poor Charmian! Since her Malaita experiences
she has become a changed woman. Her meekness and humbleness
are appallingly becoming, and I should not be surprised, when we
return to civilization and stroll along a sidewalk, to see her
take her station, with bowed head, a yard in the rear.</p>
<p>Nothing much happened at Suava. Bichu, the native cook,
deserted. The <i>Minota</i> dragged anchor. It blew
heavy squalls of wind and rain. The mate, Mr. Jacobsen, and
Wada were prostrated with fever. Our Solomon sores
increased and multiplied. And the cockroaches on board held
a combined Fourth of July and Coronation Parade. They
selected midnight for the time, and our tiny cabin for the
place. They were from two to three inches long; there were
hundreds of them, and they walked all over us. When we
attempted to pursue them, they left solid footing, rose up in the
air, and fluttered about like humming-birds. They were much
larger than ours on the <i>Snark</i>. But ours are young
yet, and haven’t had a chance to grow. Also, the
<i>Snark</i> has centipedes, big ones, six inches long. We
kill them occasionally, usually in Charmian’s bunk.
I’ve been bitten twice by them, both times foully, while I
was asleep. But poor Martin had worse luck. After
being sick in bed for three weeks, the first day he sat up he sat
down on one. Sometimes I think they are the wisest who
never go to Carcassonne.</p>
<p>Later on we returned to Malu, picked up seven recruits, hove
up anchor, and started to beat out the treacherous
entrance. The wind was chopping about, the current upon the
ugly point of reef setting strong. Just as we were on the
verge of clearing it and gaining open sea, the wind broke off
four points. The <i>Minota</i> attempted to go about, but
missed stays. Two of her anchors had been lost at
Tulagi. Her one remaining anchor was let go. Chain
was let out to give it a hold on the coral. Her fin keel
struck bottom, and her main topmast lurched and shivered as if
about to come down upon our heads. She fetched up on the
slack of the anchors at the moment a big comber smashed her
shoreward. The chain parted. It was our only
anchor. The <i>Minota</i> swung around on her heel and
drove headlong into the breakers.</p>
<p>Bedlam reigned. All the recruits below, bushmen and
afraid of the sea, dashed panic-stricken on deck and got in
everybody’s way. At the same time the boat’s
crew made a rush for the rifles. They knew what going
ashore on Malaita meant—one hand for the ship and the other
hand to fight off the natives. What they held on with I
don’t know, and they needed to hold on as the <i>Minota</i>
lifted, rolled, and pounded on the coral. The bushmen clung
in the rigging, too witless to watch out for the topmast.
The whale-boat was run out with a tow-line endeavouring in a puny
way to prevent the <i>Minota</i> from being flung farther in
toward the reef, while Captain Jansen and the mate, the latter
pallid and weak with fever, were resurrecting a scrap-anchor from
out the ballast and rigging up a stock for it. Mr.
Caulfeild, with his mission boys, arrived in his whale-boat to
help.</p>
<p>When the <i>Minota</i> first struck, there was not a canoe in
sight; but like vultures circling down out of the blue, canoes
began to arrive from every quarter. The boat’s crew,
with rifles at the ready, kept them lined up a hundred feet away
with a promise of death if they ventured nearer. And there
they clung, a hundred feet away, black and ominous, crowded with
men, holding their canoes with their paddles on the perilous edge
of the breaking surf. In the meantime the bushmen were
flocking down from the hills armed with spears, Sniders, arrows,
and clubs, until the beach was massed with them. To
complicate matters, at least ten of our recruits had been
enlisted from the very bushmen ashore who were waiting hungrily
for the loot of the tobacco and trade goods and all that we had
on board.</p>
<p>The <i>Minota</i> was honestly built, which is the first
essential for any boat that is pounding on a reef. Some
idea of what she endured may be gained from the fact that in the
first twenty-four hours she parted two anchor-chains and eight
hawsers. Our boat’s crew was kept busy diving for the
anchors and bending new lines. There were times when she
parted the chains reinforced with hawsers. And yet she held
together. Tree trunks were brought from ashore and worked
under her to save her keel and bilges, but the trunks were gnawed
and splintered and the ropes that held them frayed to fragments,
and still she pounded and held together. But we were
luckier than the <i>Ivanhoe</i>, a big recruiting schooner, which
had gone ashore on Malaita several months previously and been
promptly rushed by the natives. The captain and crew
succeeded in getting away in the whale-boats, and the bushmen and
salt-water men looted her clean of everything portable.</p>
<p>Squall after squall, driving wind and blinding rain, smote the
<i>Minota</i>, while a heavier sea was making. The
<i>Eugenie</i> lay at anchor five miles to windward, but she was
behind a point of land and could not know of our mishap. At
Captain Jansen’s suggestion, I wrote a note to Captain
Keller, asking him to bring extra anchors and gear to our
aid. But not a canoe could be persuaded to carry the
letter. I offered half a case of tobacco, but the blacks
grinned and held their canoes bow-on to the breaking seas.
A half a case of tobacco was worth three pounds. In two
hours, even against the strong wind and sea, a man could have
carried the letter and received in payment what he would have
laboured half a year for on a plantation. I managed to get
into a canoe and paddle out to where Mr. Caulfeild was running an
anchor with his whale-boat. My idea was that he would have
more influence over the natives. He called the canoes up to
him, and a score of them clustered around and heard the offer of
half a case of tobacco. No one spoke.</p>
<p>“I know what you think,” the missionary called out
to them. “You think plenty tobacco on the schooner
and you’re going to get it. I tell you plenty rifles
on schooner. You no get tobacco, you get
bullets.”</p>
<p>At last, one man, alone in a small canoe, took the letter and
started. Waiting for relief, work went on steadily on the
<i>Minota</i>. Her water-tanks were emptied, and spars,
sails, and ballast started shoreward. There were lively
times on board when the <i>Minota</i> rolled one bilge down and
then the other, a score of men leaping for life and legs as the
trade-boxes, booms, and eighty-pound pigs of iron ballast rushed
across from rail to rail and back again. The poor pretty
harbour yacht! Her decks and running rigging were a
raffle. Down below everything was disrupted. The
cabin floor had been torn up to get at the ballast, and rusty
bilge-water swashed and splashed. A bushel of limes, in a
mess of flour and water, charged about like so many sticky
dumplings escaped from a half-cooked stew. In the inner
cabin, Nakata kept guard over our rifles and ammunition.</p>
<p>Three hours from the time our messenger started, a whale-boat,
pressing along under a huge spread of canvas, broke through the
thick of a shrieking squall to windward. It was Captain
Keller, wet with rain and spray, a revolver in belt, his
boat’s crew fully armed, anchors and hawsers heaped high
amidships, coming as fast as wind could drive—the white
man, the inevitable white man, coming to a white man’s
rescue.</p>
<p>The vulture line of canoes that had waited so long broke and
disappeared as quickly as it had formed. The corpse was not
dead after all. We now had three whale-boats, two plying
steadily between the vessel and shore, the other kept busy
running out anchors, rebending parted hawsers, and recovering the
lost anchors. Later in the afternoon, after a consultation,
in which we took into consideration that a number of our
boat’s crew, as well as ten of the recruits, belonged to
this place, we disarmed the boat’s crew. This,
incidently, gave them both hands free to work for the
vessel. The rifles were put in the charge of five of Mr.
Caulfeild’s mission boys. And down below in the wreck
of the cabin the missionary and his converts prayed to God to
save the <i>Minota</i>. It was an impressive scene! the
unarmed man of God praying with cloudless faith, his savage
followers leaning on their rifles and mumbling amens. The
cabin walls reeled about them. The vessel lifted and
smashed upon the coral with every sea. From on deck came
the shouts of men heaving and toiling, praying, in another
fashion, with purposeful will and strength of arm.</p>
<p>That night Mr. Caulfeild brought off a warning. One of
our recruits had a price on his head of fifty fathoms of
shell-money and forty pigs. Baffled in their desire to
capture the vessel, the bushmen decided to get the head of the
man. When killing begins, there is no telling where it will
end, so Captain Jansen armed a whale-boat and rowed in to the
edge of the beach. Ugi, one of his boat’s crew, stood
up and orated for him. Ugi was excited. Captain
Jansen’s warning that any canoe sighted that night would be
pumped full of lead, Ugi turned into a bellicose declaration of
war, which wound up with a peroration somewhat to the following
effect: “You kill my captain, I drink his blood and die
with him!”</p>
<p>The bushmen contented themselves with burning an unoccupied
mission house, and sneaked back to the bush. The next day
the <i>Eugenie</i> sailed in and dropped anchor. Three days
and two nights the <i>Minota</i> pounded on the reef; but she
held together, and the shell of her was pulled off at last and
anchored in smooth water. There we said good-bye to her and
all on board, and sailed away on the <i>Eugenie</i>, bound for
Florida Island. <SPAN name="citation268"></SPAN><SPAN href="#footnote268" class="citation">[268]</SPAN></p>
<h2><SPAN name="chap16"></SPAN>CHAPTER XVI<br/> <span class="GutSmall">BÊCHE DE MER ENGLISH</span></h2>
<p><span class="smcap">Given</span> a number of white traders, a
wide area of land, and scores of savage languages and dialects,
the result will be that the traders will manufacture a totally
new, unscientific, but perfectly adequate, language. This
the traders did when they invented the Chinook lingo for use over
British Columbia, Alaska, and the Northwest Territory. So
with the lingo of the Kroo-boys of Africa, the pigeon English of
the Far East, and the bêche de mer of the westerly portion
of the South Seas. This latter is often called pigeon
English, but pigeon English it certainly is not. To show
how totally different it is, mention need be made only of the
fact that the classic piecee of China has no place in it.</p>
<p>There was once a sea captain who needed a dusky potentate down
in his cabin. The potentate was on deck. The
captain’s command to the Chinese steward was “Hey,
boy, you go top-side catchee one piecee king.” Had
the steward been a New Hebridean or a Solomon islander, the
command would have been: “Hey, you fella boy, go look
’m eye belong you along deck, bring ’m me fella one
big fella marster belong black man.”</p>
<p>It was the first white men who ventured through Melanesia
after the early explorers, who developed bêche de mer
English—men such as the bêche de mer fishermen, the
sandalwood traders, the pearl hunters, and the labour
recruiters. In the Solomons, for instance, scores of
languages and dialects are spoken. Unhappy the trader who
tried to learn them all; for in the next group to which he might
wander he would find scores of additional tongues. A common
language was necessary—a language so simple that a child
could learn it, with a vocabulary as limited as the intelligence
of the savages upon whom it was to be used. The traders did
not reason this out. Bêche de mer English was the
product of conditions and circumstances. Function precedes
organ; and the need for a universal Melanesian lingo preceded
bêche de mer English. Bêche de mer was purely
fortuitous, but it was fortuitous in the deterministic way.
Also, from the fact that out of the need the lingo arose,
bêche de mer English is a splendid argument for the
Esperanto enthusiasts.</p>
<p>A limited vocabulary means that each word shall be
overworked. Thus, <i>fella</i>, in bêche de mer,
means all that <i>piecee</i> does and quite a bit more, and is
used continually in every possible connection. Another
overworked word is <i>belong</i>. Nothing stands
alone. Everything is related. The thing desired is
indicated by its relationship with other things. A
primitive vocabulary means primitive expression, thus, the
continuance of rain is expressed as <i>rain he stop</i>.
<i>Sun he come up</i> cannot possibly be misunderstood, while the
phrase-structure itself can be used without mental exertion in
ten thousand different ways, as, for instance, a native who
desires to tell you that there are fish in the water and who says
<i>fish he stop</i>. It was while trading on Ysabel island
that I learned the excellence of this usage. I wanted two
or three pairs of the large clam-shells (measuring three feet
across), but I did not want the meat inside. Also, I wanted
the meat of some of the smaller clams to make a chowder. My
instruction to the natives finally ripened into the following
“You fella bring me fella big fella clam—kai-kai he
no stop, he walk about. You fella bring me fella small
fella clam—kai-kai he stop.”</p>
<p>Kai-kai is the Polynesian for food, meat, eating, and to eat:
but it would be hard to say whether it was introduced into
Melanesia by the sandalwood traders or by the Polynesian westward
drift. Walk about is a quaint phrase. Thus, if one
orders a Solomon sailor to put a tackle on a boom, he will
suggest, “That fella boom he walk about too
much.” And if the said sailor asks for shore liberty,
he will state that it is his desire to walk about. Or if
said sailor be seasick, he will explain his condition by stating,
“Belly belong me walk about too much.”</p>
<p>Too much, by the way, does not indicate anything
excessive. It is merely the simple superlative. Thus,
if a native is asked the distance to a certain village, his
answer will be one of these four: “Close-up”;
“long way little bit”; “long way big
bit”; or “long way too much.” Long way
too much does not mean that one cannot walk to the village; it
means that he will have to walk farther than if the village were
a long way big bit.</p>
<p><i>Gammon</i> is to lie, to exaggerate, to joke.
<i>Mary</i> is a woman. Any woman is a Mary. All
women are Marys. Doubtlessly the first dim white adventurer
whimsically called a native woman Mary, and of similar birth must
have been many other words in bêche de mer. The white
men were all seamen, and so capsize and sing out were introduced
into the lingo. One would not tell a Melanesian cook to
empty the dish-water, but he would tell him to capsize it.
To sing out is to cry loudly, to call out, or merely to
speak. Sing-sing is a song. The native Christian does
not think of God calling for Adam in the Garden of Eden; in the
native’s mind, God sings out for Adam.</p>
<p>Savvee or catchee are practically the only words which have
been introduced straight from pigeon English. Of course,
pickaninny has happened along, but some of its uses are
delicious. Having bought a fowl from a native in a canoe,
the native asked me if I wanted “Pickaninny stop along him
fella.” It was not until he showed me a handful of
hen’s eggs that I understood his meaning. My word, as
an exclamation with a thousand significances, could have arrived
from nowhere else than Old England. A paddle, a sweep, or
an oar, is called washee, and washee is also the verb.</p>
<p>Here is a letter, dictated by one Peter, a native trader at
Santa Anna, and addressed to his employer. Harry, the
schooner captain, started to write the letter, but was stopped by
Peter at the end of the second sentence. Thereafter the
letter runs in Peter’s own words, for Peter was afraid that
Harry gammoned too much, and he wanted the straight story of his
needs to go to headquarters.</p>
<blockquote><p style="text-align: right">“<span class="smcap">Santa Anna</span></p>
<p>“Trader Peter has worked 12 months for your firm and has
not received any pay yet. He hereby wants
£12.” (At this point Peter began
dictation). “Harry he gammon along him all the
time too much. I like him 6 tin biscuit, 4 bag rice, 24 tin
bullamacow. Me like him 2 rifle, me savvee look out along
boat, some place me go man he no good, he <i>kai-kai</i> along
me.</p>
<p style="text-align: right">“<span class="smcap">Peter</span>.”</p>
</blockquote>
<p><i>Bullamacow</i> means tinned beef. This word was
corrupted from the English language by the Samoans, and from them
learned by the traders, who carried it along with them into
Melanesia. Captain Cook and the other early navigators made
a practice of introducing seeds, plants, and domestic animals
amongst the natives. It was at Samoa that one such
navigator landed a bull and a cow. “This is a bull
and cow,” said he to the Samoans. They thought he was
giving the name of the breed, and from that day to this, beef on
the hoof and beef in the tin is called <i>bullamacow</i>.</p>
<p>A Solomon islander cannot say <i>fence</i>, so, in bêche
de mer, it becomes <i>fennis</i>; store is <i>sittore</i>, and
box is <i>bokkis</i>. Just now the fashion in chests, which
are known as boxes, is to have a bell-arrangement on the lock so
that the box cannot be opened without sounding an alarm. A
box so equipped is not spoken of as a mere box, but as the
<i>bokkis belong bell</i>.</p>
<p><i>Fright</i> is the bêche de mer for fear. If a
native appears timid and one asks him the cause, he is liable to
hear in reply: “Me fright along you too much.”
Or the native may be <i>fright</i> along storm, or wild bush, or
haunted places. <i>Cross</i> covers every form of
anger. A man may be cross at one when he is feeling only
petulant; or he may be cross when he is seeking to chop off your
head and make a stew out of you. A recruit, after having
toiled three years on a plantation, was returned to his own
village on Malaita. He was clad in all kinds of gay and
sportive garments. On his head was a top-hat. He
possessed a trade-box full of calico, beads, porpoise-teeth, and
tobacco. Hardly was the anchor down, when the villagers
were on board. The recruit looked anxiously for his own
relatives, but none was to be seen. One of the natives took
the pipe out of his mouth. Another confiscated the strings
of beads from around his neck. A third relieved him of his
gaudy loin-cloth, and a fourth tried on the top-hat and omitted
to return it. Finally, one of them took his trade-box,
which represented three years’ toil, and dropped it into a
canoe alongside. “That fella belong you?” the
captain asked the recruit, referring to the thief.
“No belong me,” was the answer. “Then why
in Jericho do you let him take the box?” the captain
demanded indignantly. Quoth the recruit, “Me speak
along him, say bokkis he stop, that fella he cross along
me”—which was the recruit’s way of saying that
the other man would murder him. God’s wrath, when He
sent the Flood, was merely a case of being cross along
mankind.</p>
<p>What name? is the great interrogation of bêche de
mer. It all depends on how it is uttered. It may
mean: What is your business? What do you mean by this
outrageous conduct? What do you want? What is the
thing you are after? You had best watch out; I demand an
explanation; and a few hundred other things. Call a native
out of his house in the middle of the night, and he is likely to
demand, “What name you sing out along me?”</p>
<p>Imagine the predicament of the Germans on the plantations of
Bougainville Island, who are compelled to learn bêche de
mer English in order to handle the native labourers. It is
to them an unscientific polyglot, and there are no text-books by
which to study it. It is a source of unholy delight to the
other white planters and traders to hear the German wrestling
stolidly with the circumlocutions and short-cuts of a language
that has no grammar and no dictionary.</p>
<p>Some years ago large numbers of Solomon islanders were
recruited to labour on the sugar plantations of Queensland.
A missionary urged one of the labourers, who was a convert, to
get up and preach a sermon to a shipload of Solomon islanders who
had just arrived. He chose for his subject the Fall of Man,
and the address he gave became a classic in all
Australasia. It proceeded somewhat in the following
manner:</p>
<p>“Altogether you boy belong Solomons you no savvee white
man. Me fella me savvee him. Me fella me savvee talk
along white man.</p>
<p>“Before long time altogether no place he stop. God
big fella marster belong white man, him fella He make ’m
altogether. God big fella marster belong white man, He make
’m big fella garden. He good fella too much.
Along garden plenty yam he stop, plenty cocoanut, plenty taro,
plenty <i>kumara</i> (sweet potatoes), altogether good fella
kai-kai too much.</p>
<p>“Bimeby God big fella marster belong white man He make
’m one fella man and put ’m along garden belong
Him. He call ’m this fella man Adam. He name
belong him. He put him this fella man Adam along garden,
and He speak, ‘This fella garden he belong
you.’ And He look ’m this fella Adam he walk
about too much. Him fella Adam all the same sick; he no
savvee kai-kai; he walk about all the time. And God He no
savvee. God big fella marster belong white man, He scratch
’m head belong Him. God say: ‘What name?
Me no savvee what name this fella Adam he want.’</p>
<p>“Bimeby God He scratch ’m head belong Him too
much, and speak: ‘Me fella me savvee, him fella Adam him
want ’m Mary.’ So He make Adam he go asleep, He
take one fella bone belong him, and He make ’m one fella
Mary along bone. He call him this fella Mary, Eve. He
give ’m this fella Eve along Adam, and He speak along him
fella Adam: ‘Close up altogether along this fella garden
belong you two fella. One fella tree he tambo (taboo) along
you altogether. This fella tree belong apple.’</p>
<p>“So Adam Eve two fella stop along garden, and they two
fella have ’m good time too much. Bimeby, one day,
Eve she come along Adam, and she speak, ‘More good you me
two fella we eat ’m this fella apple.’ Adam he
speak, ‘No,’ and Eve she speak, ‘What name you
no like ’m me?’ And Adam he speak, ‘Me
like ’m you too much, but me fright along God.’
And Eve she speak, ‘Gammon! What name? God He
no savvee look along us two fella all ’m time. God
big fella marster, He gammon along you.’ But Adam he
speak, ‘No.’ But Eve she talk, talk, talk,
allee time—allee same Mary she talk along boy along
Queensland and make ’m trouble along boy. And bimeby
Adam he tired too much, and he speak, ‘All
right.’ So these two fella they go eat
’m. When they finish eat ’m, my word, they
fright like hell, and they go hide along scrub.</p>
<p>“And God He come walk about along garden, and He sing
out, ‘Adam!’ Adam he no speak. He too
much fright. My word! And God He sing out,
‘Adam!’ And Adam he speak, ‘You call
’m me?’ God He speak, ‘Me call ’m
you too much.’ Adam he speak, ‘Me sleep strong
fella too much.’ And God He speak, ‘You been
eat ’m this fella apple.’ Adam he speak,
‘No, me no been eat ’m.’ God He
speak. ‘What name you gammon along me? You been
eat ’m.’ And Adam he speak, ‘Yes, me been
eat ’m.’</p>
<p>“And God big fella marster He cross along Adam Eve two
fella too much, and He speak, ‘You two fella finish along
me altogether. You go catch ’m bokkis (box) belong
you, and get to hell along scrub.’</p>
<p>“So Adam Eve these two fella go along scrub. And
God He make ’m one big fennis (fence) all around garden and
He put ’m one fella marster belong God along fennis.
And He give this fella marster belong God one big fella musket,
and He speak, ‘S’pose you look ’m these two
fella Adam Eve, you shoot ’m plenty too
much.’”</p>
<h2><SPAN name="chap17"></SPAN>CHAPTER XVII<br/> <span class="GutSmall">THE AMATEUR M.D.</span></h2>
<p><span class="smcap">When</span> we sailed from San Francisco
on the <i>Snark</i> I knew as much about sickness as the Admiral
of the Swiss Navy knows about salt water. And here, at the
start, let me advise any one who meditates going to
out-of-the-way tropic places. Go to a first-class
druggist—the sort that have specialists on their salary
list who know everything. Talk the matter over with such an
one. Note carefully all that he says. Have a list
made of all that he recommends. Write out a cheque for the
total cost, and tear it up.</p>
<p>I wish I had done the same. I should have been far
wiser, I know now, if I had bought one of those ready-made,
self-acting, fool-proof medicine chests such as are favoured by
fourth-rate ship-masters. In such a chest each bottle has a
number. On the inside of the lid is placed a simple table
of directions: No. 1, toothache; No. 2, smallpox; No. 3,
stomachache; No. 4, cholera; No. 5, rheumatism; and so on,
through the list of human ills. And I might have used it as
did a certain venerable skipper, who, when No. 3 was empty, mixed
a dose from No. 1 and No. 2, or, when No. 7 was all gone, dosed
his crew with 4 and 3 till 3 gave out, when he used 5 and 2.</p>
<p>So far, with the exception of corrosive sublimate (which was
recommended as an antiseptic in surgical operations, and which I
have not yet used for that purpose), my medicine-chest has been
useless. It has been worse than useless, for it has
occupied much space which I could have used to advantage.</p>
<p>With my surgical instruments it is different. While I
have not yet had serious use for them, I do not regret the space
they occupy. The thought of them makes me feel good.
They are so much life insurance, only, fairer than that last grim
game, one is not supposed to die in order to win. Of
course, I don’t know how to use them, and what I
don’t know about surgery would set up a dozen quacks in
prosperous practice. But needs must when the devil drives,
and we of the <i>Snark</i> have no warning when the devil may
take it into his head to drive, ay, even a thousand miles from
land and twenty days from the nearest port.</p>
<p>I did not know anything about dentistry, but a friend fitted
me out with forceps and similar weapons, and in Honolulu I picked
up a book upon teeth. Also, in that sub-tropical city I
managed to get hold of a skull, from which I extracted the teeth
swiftly and painlessly. Thus equipped, I was ready, though
not exactly eager, to tackle any tooth that get in my way.
It was in Nuku-hiva, in the Marquesas, that my first case
presented itself in the shape of a little, old Chinese. The
first thing I did was to got the buck fever, and I leave it to
any fair-minded person if buck fever, with its attendant
heart-palpitations and arm-tremblings, is the right condition for
a man to be in who is endeavouring to pose as an old hand at the
business. I did not fool the aged Chinaman. He was as
frightened as I and a bit more shaky. I almost forgot to be
frightened in the fear that he would bolt. I swear, if he
had tried to, that I would have tripped him up and sat on him
until calmness and reason returned.</p>
<p>I wanted that tooth. Also, Martin wanted a snap-shot of
me getting it. Likewise Charmian got her camera. Then
the procession started. We were stopping at what had been
the club-house when Stevenson was in the Marquesas on the
Casco. On the veranda, where he had passed so many pleasant
hours, the light was not good—for snapshots, I mean.
I led on into the garden, a chair in one hand, the other hand
filled with forceps of various sorts, my knees knocking together
disgracefully. The poor old Chinaman came second, and he
was shaking, too. Charmian and Martin brought up the rear,
armed with kodaks. We dived under the avocado trees,
threaded our way through the cocoanut palms, and came on a spot
that satisfied Martin’s photographic eye.</p>
<p>I looked at the tooth, and then discovered that I could not
remember anything about the teeth I had pulled from the skull
five months previously. Did it have one prong? two prongs?
or three prongs? What was left of the part that showed
appeared very crumbly, and I knew that I should have taken hold of
the tooth deep down in the gum. It was very necessary that
I should know how many prongs that tooth had. Back to the
house I went for the book on teeth. The poor old victim
looked like photographs I had seen of fellow-countrymen of his,
criminals, on their knees, waiting the stroke of the beheading
sword.</p>
<p>“Don’t let him get away,” I cautioned to
Martin. “I want that tooth.”</p>
<p>“I sure won’t,” he replied with enthusiasm,
from behind his camera. “I want that
photograph.”</p>
<p>For the first time I felt sorry for the Chinaman. Though
the book did not tell me anything about pulling teeth, it was all
right, for on one page I found drawings of all the teeth,
including their prongs and how they were set in the jaw.
Then came the pursuit of the forceps. I had seven pairs,
but was in doubt as to which pair I should use. I did not
want any mistake. As I turned the hardware over with rattle
and clang, the poor victim began to lose his grip and to turn a
greenish yellow around the gills. He complained about the
sun, but that was necessary for the photograph, and he had to
stand it. I fitted the forceps around the tooth, and the
patient shivered and began to wilt.</p>
<p>“Ready?” I called to Martin.</p>
<p>“All ready,” he answered.</p>
<p>I gave a pull. Ye gods! The tooth was
loose! Out it came on the instant. I was jubilant as
I held it aloft in the forceps.</p>
<p>“Put it back, please, oh, put it back,” Martin
pleaded. “You were too quick for me.”</p>
<p>And the poor old Chinaman sat there while I put the tooth back
and pulled over. Martin snapped the camera. The deed
was done. Elation? Pride? No hunter was ever
prouder of his first pronged buck than I was of that three-pronged
tooth. I did it! I did it! With my own hands
and a pair of forceps I did it, to say nothing of the forgotten
memories of the dead man’s skull.</p>
<p>My next case was a Tahitian sailor. He was a small man,
in a state of collapse from long days and nights of jumping
toothache. I lanced the gums first. I didn’t
know how to lance them, but I lanced them just the same. It
was a long pull and a strong pull. The man was a
hero. He groaned and moaned, and I thought he was going to
faint. But he kept his mouth open and let me pull.
And then it came.</p>
<p>After that I was ready to meet all comers—just the
proper state of mind for a Waterloo. And it came. Its
name was Tomi. He was a strapping giant of a heathen with a
bad reputation. He was addicted to deeds of violence.
Among other things he had beaten two of his wives to death with
his fists. His father and mother had been naked
cannibals. When he sat down and I put the forceps into his
mouth, he was nearly as tall as I was standing up. Big men,
prone to violence, very often have a streak of fat in their
make-up, so I was doubtful of him. Charmian grabbed one arm
and Warren grabbed the other. Then the tug of war
began. The instant the forceps closed down on the tooth,
his jaws closed down on the forceps. Also, both his hands
flew up and gripped my pulling hand. I held on, and he held
on. Charmian and Warren held on. We wrestled all
about the shop.</p>
<p>It was three against one, and my hold on an aching tooth was
certainly a foul one; but in spite of the handicap he got away
with us. The forceps slipped off, banging and grinding
along against his upper teeth with a nerve-scraping sound.
Out of his month flew the forceps, and he rose up in the air with
a blood-curdling yell. The three of us fell back. We
expected to be massacred. But that howling savage of
sanguinary reputation sank back in the chair. He held his
head in both his hands, and groaned and groaned and
groaned. Nor would he listen to reason. I was a
quack. My painless tooth-extraction was a delusion and a
snare and a low advertising dodge. I was so anxious to get
that tooth that I was almost ready to bribe him. But that
went against my professional pride and I let him depart with the
tooth still intact, the only case on record up to date of failure
on my part when once I had got a grip. Since then I have
never let a tooth go by me. Only the other day I
volunteered to beat up three days to windward to pull a woman
missionary’s tooth. I expect, before the voyage of
the <i>Snark</i> is finished, to be doing bridge work and putting
on gold crowns.</p>
<p>I don’t know whether they are yaws or not—a
physician in Fiji told me they were, and a missionary in the
Solomons told me they were not; but at any rate I can vouch for
the fact that they are most uncomfortable. It was my luck
to ship in Tahiti a French-sailor, who, when we got to sea,
proved to be afflicted with a vile skin disease. The
<i>Snark</i> was too small and too much of a family party to
permit retaining him on board; but perforce, until we could reach
land and discharge him, it was up to me to doctor him. I
read up the books and proceeded to treat him, taking care
afterwards always to use a thorough antiseptic wash. When
we reached Tutuila, far from getting rid of him, the port doctor
declared a quarantine against him and refused to allow him
ashore. But at Apia, Samoa, I managed to ship him off on a
steamer to New Zealand. Here at Apia my ankles were badly
bitten by mosquitoes, and I confess to having scratched the
bites—as I had a thousand times before. By the time I
reached the island of Savaii, a small sore had developed on the
hollow of my instep. I thought it was due to chafe and to
acid fumes from the hot lava over which I tramped. An
application of salve would cure it—so I thought. The
salve did heal it over, whereupon an astonishing inflammation set
in, the new skin came off, and a larger sore was exposed.
This was repeated many times. Each time new skin formed, an
inflammation followed, and the circumference of the sore
increased. I was puzzled and frightened. All my life
my skin had been famous for its healing powers, yet here was
something that would not heal. Instead, it was daily eating
up more skin, while it had eaten down clear through the skin and
was eating up the muscle itself.</p>
<p>By this time the <i>Snark</i> was at sea on her way to
Fiji. I remembered the French sailor, and for the first
time became seriously alarmed. Four other similar sores had
appeared—or ulcers, rather, and the pain of them kept me
awake at night. All my plans were made to lay up the
<i>Snark</i> in Fiji and get away on the first steamer to
Australia and professional M.D.’s. In the meantime,
in my amateur M.D. way, I did my best. I read through all
the medical works on board. Not a line nor a word could I
find descriptive of my affliction. I brought common
horse-sense to bear on the problem. Here were malignant and
excessively active ulcers that were eating me up. There was
an organic and corroding poison at work. Two things I
concluded must be done. First, some agent must be found to
destroy the poison. Secondly, the ulcers could not possibly
heal from the outside in; they must heal from the inside
out. I decided to fight the poison with corrosive
sublimate. The very name of it struck me as vicious.
Talk of fighting fire with fire! I was being consumed by a
corrosive poison, and it appealed to my fancy to fight it with
another corrosive poison. After several days I alternated
dressings of corrosive sublimate with dressings of peroxide of
hydrogen. And behold, by the time we reached Fiji four of
the five ulcers were healed, while the remaining one was no
bigger than a pea.</p>
<p>I now felt fully qualified to treat yaws. Likewise I had
a wholesome respect for them. Not so the rest of the crew
of the <i>Snark</i>. In their case, seeing was not
believing. One and all, they had seen my dreadful
predicament; and all of them, I am convinced, had a subconscious
certitude that their own superb constitutions and glorious
personalities would never allow lodgment of so vile a poison in
their carcasses as my anæmic constitution and mediocre
personality had allowed to lodge in mine. At Port
Resolution, in the New Hebrides, Martin elected to walk
barefooted in the bush and returned on board with many cuts and
abrasions, especially on his shins.</p>
<p>“You’d better be careful,” I warned
him. “I’ll mix up some corrosive sublimate for
you to wash those cuts with. An ounce of prevention, you
know.”</p>
<p>But Martin smiled a superior smile. Though he did not
say so, I nevertheless was given to understand that he was
not as other men (I was the only man he could possibly have had
reference to), and that in a couple of days his cuts would be
healed. He also read me a dissertation upon the peculiar
purity of his blood and his remarkable healing powers. I
felt quite humble when he was done with me. Evidently I was
different from other men in so far as purity of blood was
concerned.</p>
<p>Nakata, the cabin-boy, while ironing one day, mistook the calf
of his leg for the ironing-block and accumulated a burn three
inches in length and half an inch wide. He, too, smiled the
superior smile when I offered him corrosive sublimate and
reminded him of my own cruel experience. I was given to
understand, with all due suavity and courtesy, that no matter
what was the matter with my blood, his number-one, Japanese,
Port-Arthur blood was all right and scornful of the festive
microbe.</p>
<p>Wada, the cook, took part in a disastrous landing of the
launch, when he had to leap overboard and fend the launch off the
beach in a smashing surf. By means of shells and coral he
cut his legs and feet up beautifully. I offered him the
corrosive sublimate bottle. Once again I suffered the
superior smile and was given to understand that his blood was the
same blood that had licked Russia and was going to lick the
United States some day, and that if his blood wasn’t able
to cure a few trifling cuts, he’d commit hari-kari in sheer
disgrace.</p>
<p>From all of which I concluded that an amateur M.D. is without
honour on his own vessel, even if he has cured himself. The
rest of the crew had begun to look upon me as a sort of mild
mono-maniac on the question of sores and sublimate. Just
because my blood was impure was no reason that I should think
everybody else’s was. I made no more overtures.
Time and microbes were with me, and all I had to do was wait.</p>
<p>“I think there’s some dirt in these cuts,”
Martin said tentatively, after several days.
“I’ll wash them out and then they’ll be all
right,” he added, after I had refused to rise to the
bait.</p>
<p>Two more days passed, but the cuts did not pass, and I caught
Martin soaking his feet and legs in a pail of hot water.</p>
<p>“Nothing like hot water,” he proclaimed
enthusiastically. “It beats all the dope the doctors
ever put up. These sores will be all right in the
morning.”</p>
<p>But in the morning he wore a troubled look, and I knew that
the hour of my triumph approached.</p>
<p>“I think I <i>will</i> try some of that medicine,”
he announced later on in the day. “Not that I think
it’ll do much good,” he qualified, “but
I’ll just give it a try anyway.”</p>
<p>Next came the proud blood of Japan to beg medicine for its
illustrious sores, while I heaped coals of fire on all their
houses by explaining in minute and sympathetic detail the
treatment that should be given. Nakata followed
instructions implicitly, and day by day his sores grew
smaller. Wada was apathetic, and cured less readily.
But Martin still doubted, and because he did not cure
immediately, he developed the theory that while doctor’s
dope was all right, it did not follow that the same kind of dope
was efficacious with everybody. As for himself, corrosive
sublimate had no effect. Besides, how did I know that it
was the right stuff? I had had no experience. Just
because I happened to get well while using it was not proof that
it had played any part in the cure. There were such things
as coincidences. Without doubt there was a dope that would
cure the sores, and when he ran across a real doctor he would
find what that dope was and get some of it.</p>
<p>About this time we arrived in the Solomon Islands. No
physician would ever recommend the group for invalids or
sanitoriums. I spent but little time there ere I really and
for the first time in my life comprehended how frail and unstable
is human tissue. Our first anchorage was Port Mary, on the
island of Santa Anna. The one lone white man, a trader,
came alongside. Tom Butler was his name, and he was a
beautiful example of what the Solomons can do to a strong
man. He lay in his whale-boat with the helplessness of a
dying man. No smile and little intelligence illumined his
face. He was a sombre death’s-head, too far gone to
grin. He, too, had yaws, big ones. We were compelled
to drag him over the rail of the <i>Snark</i>. He said that
his health was good, that he had not had the fever for some time,
and that with the exception of his arm he was all right and
trim. His arm appeared to be paralysed. Paralysis he
rejected with scorn. He had had it before, and
recovered. It was a common native disease on Santa Anna, he
said, as he was helped down the companion ladder, his dead arm
dropping, bump-bump, from step to step. He was certainly
the ghastliest guest we ever entertained, and we’ve had not
a few lepers and elephantiasis victims on board.</p>
<p>Martin inquired about yaws, for here was a man who ought to
know. He certainly did know, if we could judge by his
scarred arms and legs and by the live ulcers that corroded in the
midst of the scars. Oh, one got used to yaws, quoth Tom
Butler. They were never really serious until they had eaten
deep into the flesh. Then they attacked the walls of the
arteries, the arteries burst, and there was a funeral.
Several of the natives had recently died that way ashore.
But what did it matter? If it wasn’t yaws, it was
something else in the Solomons.</p>
<p>I noticed that from this moment Martin displayed a swiftly
increasing interest in his own yaws. Dosings with corrosive
sublimate were more frequent, while, in conversation, he began to
revert with growing enthusiasm to the clean climate of Kansas and
all other things Kansan. Charmian and I thought that
California was a little bit of all right. Henry swore by
Rapa, and Tehei staked all on Bora Bora for his own blood’s
sake; while Wada and Nakata sang the sanitary pæan of
Japan.</p>
<p>One evening, as the <i>Snark</i> worked around the southern
end of the island of Ugi, looking for a reputed anchorage, a
Church of England missionary, a Mr. Drew, bound in his whaleboat
for the coast of San Cristoval, came alongside and stopped for
dinner. Martin, his legs swathed in Red Cross bandages till
they looked like a mummy’s, turned the conversation upon
yaws. Yes, said Mr. Drew, they were quite common in the
Solomons. All white men caught them.</p>
<p>“And have you had them?” Martin demanded, in the
soul of him quite shocked that a Church of England missionary
could possess so vulgar an affliction.</p>
<p>Mr. Drew nodded his head and added that not only had he had
them, but at that moment he was doctoring several.</p>
<p>“What do you use on them?” Martin asked like a
flash.</p>
<p>My heart almost stood still waiting the answer. By that
answer my professional medical prestige stood or fell.
Martin, I could see, was quite sure it was going to fall.
And then the answer—O blessed answer!</p>
<p>“Corrosive sublimate,” said Mr. Drew.</p>
<p>Martin gave in handsomely, I’ll admit, and I am
confident that at that moment, if I had asked permission to pull
one of his teeth, he would not have denied me.</p>
<p>All white men in the Solomons catch yaws, and every cut or
abrasion practically means another yaw. Every man I met had
had them, and nine out of ten had active ones. There was
but one exception, a young fellow who had been in the islands
five months, who had come down with fever ten days after he
arrived, and who had since then been down so often with fever
that he had had neither time nor opportunity for yaws.</p>
<p>Every one on the <i>Snark</i> except Charmian came down with
yaws. Hers was the same egotism that Japan and Kansas had
displayed. She ascribed her immunity to the pureness of her
blood, and as the days went by she ascribed it more often and
more loudly to the pureness of her blood. Privately I
ascribed her immunity to the fact that, being a woman, she
escaped most of the cuts and abrasions to which we hard-working
men were subject in the course of working the <i>Snark</i> around
the world. I did not tell her so. You see, I did not
wish to bruise her ego with brutal facts. Being an M.D., if
only an amateur one, I knew more about the disease than she, and
I knew that time was my ally. But alas, I abused my ally
when it dealt a charming little yaw on the shin. So quickly
did I apply antiseptic treatment, that the yaw was cured before
she was convinced that she had one. Again, as an M.D., I
was without honour on my own vessel; and, worse than that, I was
charged with having tried to mislead her into the belief that she
had had a yaw. The pureness of her blood was more rampant
than ever, and I poked my nose into my navigation books and kept
quiet. And then came the day. We were cruising along
the coast of Malaita at the time.</p>
<p>“What’s that abaft your ankle-bone?” said
I.</p>
<p>“Nothing,” said she.</p>
<p>“All right,” said I; “but put some corrosive
sublimate on it just the same. And some two or three weeks
from now, when it is well and you have a scar that you will carry
to your grave, just forget about the purity of your blood and
your ancestral history and tell me what you think about yaws
anyway.”</p>
<p>It was as large as a silver dollar, that yaw, and it took all
of three weeks to heal. There were times when Charmian
could not walk because of the hurt of it; and there were times
upon times when she explained that abaft the ankle-bone was the
most painful place to have a yaw. I explained, in turn,
that, never having experienced a yaw in that locality, I was
driven to conclude the hollow of the instep was the most painful
place for yaw-culture. We left it to Martin, who disagreed
with both of us and proclaimed passionately that the only truly
painful place was the shin. No wonder horse-racing is so
popular.</p>
<p>But yaws lose their novelty after a time. At the present
moment of writing I have five yaws on my hands and three more on
my shin. Charmian has one on each side of her right
instep. Tehei is frantic with his. Martin’s
latest shin-cultures have eclipsed his earlier ones. And
Nakata has several score casually eating away at his
tissue. But the history of the <i>Snark</i> in the Solomons
has been the history of every ship since the early
discoverers. From the “Sailing Directions” I
quote the following:</p>
<p>“The crews of vessels remaining any considerable time in
the Solomons find wounds and sores liable to change into
malignant ulcers.”</p>
<p>Nor on the question of fever were the “Sailing
Directions” any more encouraging, for in them I read:</p>
<p>“New arrivals are almost certain sooner or later to
suffer from fever. The natives are also subject to
it. The number of deaths among the whites in the year 1897
amounted to 9 among a population of 50.”</p>
<p>Some of these deaths, however, were accidental.</p>
<p>Nakata was the first to come down with fever. This
occurred at Penduffryn. Wada and Henry followed him.
Charmian surrendered next. I managed to escape for a couple
of months; but when I was bowled over, Martin sympathetically
joined me several days later. Out of the seven of us all
told Tehei is the only one who has escaped; but his sufferings
from nostalgia are worse than fever. Nakata, as usual,
followed instructions faithfully, so that by the end of his third
attack he could take a two hours’ sweat, consume thirty or
forty grains of quinine, and be weak but all right at the end of
twenty-four hours.</p>
<p>Wada and Henry, however, were tougher patients with which to
deal. In the first place, Wada got in a bad funk. He
was of the firm conviction that his star had set and that the
Solomons would receive his bones. He saw that life about
him was cheap. At Penduffryn he saw the ravages of
dysentery, and, unfortunately for him, he saw one victim carried
out on a strip of galvanized sheet-iron and dumped without coffin
or funeral into a hole in the ground. Everybody had fever,
everybody had dysentery, everybody had everything. Death
was common. Here to-day and gone to-morrow—and Wada
forgot all about to-day and made up his mind that to-morrow had
come.</p>
<p>He was careless of his ulcers, neglected to sublimate them,
and by uncontrolled scratching spread them all over his
body. Nor would he follow instructions with fever, and, as
a result, would be down five days at a time, when a day would
have been sufficient. Henry, who is a strapping giant of a
man, was just as bad. He refused point blank to take
quinine, on the ground that years before he had had fever and
that the pills the doctor gave him were of different size and
colour from the quinine tablets I offered him. So Henry
joined Wada.</p>
<p>But I fooled the pair of them, and dosed them with their own
medicine, which was faith-cure. They had faith in their
funk that they were going to die. I slammed a lot of
quinine down their throats and took their temperature. It
was the first time I had used my medicine-chest thermometer, and
I quickly discovered that it was worthless, that it had been
produced for profit and not for service. If I had let on to
my two patients that the thermometer did not work, there would
have been two funerals in short order. Their temperature I
swear was 105°. I solemnly made one and then the other
smoke the thermometer, allowed an expression of satisfaction to
irradiate my countenance, and joyfully told them that their
temperature was 94°. Then I slammed more quinine down
their throats, told them that any sickness or weakness they might
experience would be due to the quinine, and left them to get
well. And they did get well, Wada in spite of
himself. If a man can die through a misapprehension, is
there any immorality in making him live through a
misapprehension?</p>
<p>Commend me the white race when it comes to grit and
surviving. One of our two Japanese and both our Tahitians
funked and had to be slapped on the back and cheered up and
dragged along by main strength toward life. Charmian and
Martin took their afflictions cheerfully, made the least of them,
and moved with calm certitude along the way of life. When
Wada and Henry were convinced that they were going to die, the
funeral atmosphere was too much for Tehei, who prayed dolorously
and cried for hours at a time. Martin, on the other hand,
cursed and got well, and Charmian groaned and made plans for what
she was going to do when she got well again.</p>
<p>Charmian had been raised a vegetarian and a sanitarian.
Her Aunt Netta, who brought her up and who lived in a healthful
climate, did not believe in drugs. Neither did
Charmian. Besides, drugs disagreed with her. Their
effects were worse than the ills they were supposed to
alleviate. But she listened to the argument in favour of
quinine, accepted it as the lesser evil, and in consequence had
shorter, less painful, and less frequent attacks of fever.
We encountered a Mr. Caulfeild, a missionary, whose two
predecessors had died after less than six months’ residence
in the Solomons. Like them he had been a firm believer in
homeopathy, until after his first fever, whereupon, unlike them,
he made a grand slide back to allopathy and quinine, catching
fever and carrying on his Gospel work.</p>
<p>But poor Wada! The straw that broke the cook’s
back was when Charmian and I took him along on a cruise to the
cannibal island of Malaita, in a small yacht, on the deck of
which the captain had been murdered half a year before.
<i>Kai-kai</i> means to eat, and Wada was sure he was going to be
<i>kai-kai’d</i>. We went about heavily armed, our
vigilance was unremitting, and when we went for a bath in the
mouth of a fresh-water stream, black boys, armed with rifles, did
sentry duty about us. We encountered English war vessels
burning and shelling villages in punishment for murders.
Natives with prices on their heads sought shelter on board of
us. Murder stalked abroad in the land. In
out-of-the-way places we received warnings from friendly savages
of impending attacks. Our vessel owed two heads to Malaita,
which were liable to be collected any time. Then to cap it
all, we were wrecked on a reef, and with rifles in one hand
warned the canoes of wreckers off while with the other hand we
toiled to save the ship. All of which was too much for
Wada, who went daffy, and who finally quitted the <i>Snark</i> on
the island of Ysabel, going ashore for good in a driving
rain-storm, between two attacks of fever, while threatened with
pneumonia. If he escapes being <i>kai-kai’d</i>, and
if he can survive sores and fever which are riotous ashore, he
can expect, if he is reasonably lucky, to get away from that
place to the adjacent island in anywhere from six to eight
weeks. He never did think much of my medicine, despite the
fact that I successfully and at the first trial pulled two aching
teeth for him.</p>
<p>The <i>Snark</i> has been a hospital for months, and I confess
that we are getting used to it. At Meringe Lagoon, where we
careened and cleaned the <i>Snark’s</i> copper, there were
times when only one man of us was able to go into the water,
while the three white men on the plantation ashore were all down
with fever. At the moment of writing this we are lost at
sea somewhere northeast of Ysabel and trying vainly to find Lord
Howe Island, which is an atoll that cannot be sighted unless one
is on top of it. The chronometer has gone wrong. The
sun does not shine anyway, nor can I get a star observation at
night, and we have had nothing but squalls and rain for days and
days. The cook is gone. Nakata, who has been trying
to be both cook and cabin boy, is down on his back with
fever. Martin is just up from fever, and going down
again. Charmian, whose fever has become periodical, is
looking up in her date book to find when the next attack will
be. Henry has begun to eat quinine in an expectant
mood. And, since my attacks hit me with the suddenness of
bludgeon-blows I do not know from moment to moment when I shall
be brought down. By a mistake we gave our last flour away
to some white men who did not have any flour. We
don’t know when we’ll make land. Our Solomon
sores are worse than ever, and more numerous. The corrosive
sublimate was accidentally left ashore at Penduffryn; the
peroxide of hydrogen is exhausted; and I am experimenting with
boracic acid, lysol, and antiphlogystine. At any rate, if I
fail in becoming a reputable M.D., it won’t be from lack of
practice.</p>
<p>P.S. It is now two weeks since the foregoing was
written, and Tehei, the only immune on board has been down ten
days with far severer fever than any of us and is still
down. His temperature has been repeatedly as high as 104,
and his pulse 115.</p>
<p>P.S. At sea, between Tasman atoll and Manning
Straits. Tehei’s attack developed into black water
fever—the severest form of malarial fever, which, the
doctor-book assures me, is due to some outside infection as
well. Having pulled him through his fever, I am now at my
wit’s end, for he has lost his wits altogether. I am
rather recent in practice to take up the cure of insanity.
This makes the second lunacy case on this short voyage.</p>
<p>P.S. Some day I shall write a book (for the profession),
and entitle it, “Around the World on the Hospital Ship
<i>Snark</i>.” Even our pets have not escaped.
We sailed from Meringe Lagoon with two, an Irish terrier and a
white cockatoo. The terrier fell down the cabin
companionway and lamed its nigh hind leg, then repeated the
manœuvre and lamed its off fore leg. At the present
moment it has but two legs to walk on. Fortunately, they
are on opposite sides and ends, so that she can still dot and
carry two. The cockatoo was crushed under the cabin
skylight and had to be killed. This was our first
funeral—though for that matter, the several chickens we
had, and which would have made welcome broth for the
convalescents, flew overboard and were drowned. Only the
cockroaches flourish. Neither illness nor accident ever
befalls them, and they grow larger and more carnivorous day by
day, gnawing our finger-nails and toe-nails while we sleep.</p>
<p>P.S. Charmian is having another bout with fever.
Martin, in despair, has taken to horse-doctoring his yaws with
bluestone and to blessing the Solomons. As for me, in
addition to navigating, doctoring, and writing short stories, I
am far from well. With the exception of the insanity cases,
I’m the worst off on board. I shall catch the next
steamer to Australia and go on the operating table. Among
my minor afflictions, I may mention a new and mysterious
one. For the past week my hands have been swelling as with
dropsy. It is only by a painful effort that I can close
them. A pull on a rope is excruciating. The
sensations are like those that accompany severe chilblains.
Also, the skin is peeling off both hands at an alarming rate,
besides which the new skin underneath is growing hard and
thick. The doctor-book fails to mention this disease.
Nobody knows what it is.</p>
<p>P.S. Well, anyway, I’ve cured the
chronometer. After knocking about the sea for eight
squally, rainy days, most of the time hove to, I succeeded in
catching a partial observation of the sun at midday. From
this I worked up my latitude, then headed by log to the latitude
of Lord Howe, and ran both that latitude and the island down
together. Here I tested the chronometer by longitude sights
and found it something like three minutes out. Since each
minute is equivalent to fifteen miles, the total error can be
appreciated. By repeated observations at Lord Howe I rated
the chronometer, finding it to have a daily losing error of
seven-tenths of a second. Now it happens that a year ago,
when we sailed from Hawaii, that selfsame chronometer had that
selfsame losing error of seven-tenths of a second. Since
that error was faithfully added every day, and since that error,
as proved by my observations at Lord Howe, has not changed, then
what under the sun made that chronometer all of a sudden
accelerate and catch up with itself three minutes? Can such
things be? Expert watchmakers say no; but I say that they
have never done any expert watch-making and watch-rating in the
Solomons. That it is the climate is my only
diagnosis. At any rate, I have successfully doctored the
chronometer, even if I have failed with the lunacy cases and with
Martin’s yaws.</p>
<p>P.S. Martin has just tried burnt alum, and is blessing
the Solomons more fervently than ever.</p>
<p>P.S. Between Manning Straits and Pavuvu Islands.</p>
<p>Henry has developed rheumatism in his back, ten skins have
peeled off my hands and the eleventh is now peeling, while Tehei
is more lunatic than ever and day and night prays God not to kill
him. Also, Nakata and I are slashing away at fever
again. And finally up to date, Nakata last evening had an
attack of ptomaine poisoning, and we spent half the night pulling
him through.</p>
<h2><SPAN name="chap18"></SPAN>BACKWORD</h2>
<p><span class="smcap">The</span> <i>Snark</i> was forty-three
feet on the water-line and fifty-five over all, with fifteen feet
beam (tumble-home sides) and seven feet eight inches
draught. She was ketch-rigged, carrying flying-jib, jib,
fore-staysail, main-sail, mizzen, and spinnaker. There were
six feet of head-room below, and she was crown-decked and
flush-decked. There were four alleged <i>water-tight</i>
compartments. A seventy-horse power auxiliary gas-engine
sporadically furnished locomotion at an approximate cost of
twenty dollars per mile. A five-horse power engine ran the
pumps when it was in order, and on two occasions proved capable
of furnishing juice for the search-light. The storage
batteries worked four or five times in the course of two
years. The fourteen-foot launch was rumoured to work at
times, but it invariably broke down whenever I stepped on
board.</p>
<p>But the <i>Snark</i> sailed. It was the only way she
could get anywhere. She sailed for two years, and never
touched rock, reef, nor shoal. She had no inside ballast,
her iron keel weighed five tons, but her deep draught and high
freeboard made her very stiff. Caught under full sail in
tropic squalls, she buried her rail and deck many times, but
stubbornly refused to turn turtle. She steered easily, and
she could run day and night, without steering, close-by,
full-and-by, and with the wind abeam. With the wind on her
quarter and the sails properly trimmed, she steered herself
within two points, and with the wind almost astern she required
scarcely three points for self-steering.</p>
<p>The <i>Snark</i> was partly built in San Francisco. The
morning her iron keel was to be cast was the morning of the great
earthquake. Then came anarchy. Six months overdue in
the building, I sailed the shell of her to Hawaii to be finished,
the engine lashed to the bottom, building materials lashed on
deck. Had I remained in San Francisco for completion,
I’d still be there. As it was, partly built, she cost
four times what she ought to have cost.</p>
<p>The <i>Snark</i> was born unfortunately. She was
libelled in San Francisco, had her cheques protested as
fraudulent in Hawaii, and was fined for breach of quarantine in
the Solomons. To save themselves, the newspapers could not
tell the truth about her. When I discharged an incompetent
captain, they said I had beaten him to a pulp. When one
young man returned home to continue at college, it was reported
that I was a regular Wolf Larsen, and that my whole crew had
deserted because I had beaten it to a pulp. In fact the
only blow struck on the <i>Snark</i> was when the cook was
manhandled by a captain who had shipped with me under false
pretences, and whom I discharged in Fiji. Also, Charmian
and I boxed for exercise; but neither of us was seriously
maimed.</p>
<p>The voyage was our idea of a good time. I built the
<i>Snark</i> and paid for it, and for all expenses. I
contracted to write thirty-five thousand words descriptive of the
trip for a magazine which was to pay me the same rate I received
for stories written at home. Promptly the magazine
advertised that it was sending me especially around the world for
itself. It was a wealthy magazine. And every man who
had business dealings with the <i>Snark</i> charged three prices
because forsooth the magazine could afford it. Down in the
uttermost South Sea isle this myth obtained, and I paid
accordingly. To this day everybody believes that the
magazine paid for everything and that I made a fortune out of the
voyage. It is hard, after such advertising, to hammer it
into the human understanding that the whole voyage was done for
the fun of it.</p>
<p>I went to Australia to go into hospital, where I spent five
weeks. I spent five months miserably sick in hotels.
The mysterious malady that afflicted my hands was too much for
the Australian specialists. It was unknown in the
literature of medicine. No case like it had ever been
reported. It extended from my hands to my feet so that at
times I was as helpless as a child. On occasion my hands
were twice their natural size, with seven dead and dying skins
peeling off at the same time. There were times when my
toe-nails, in twenty-four hours, grew as thick as they were
long. After filing them off, inside another twenty-four
hours they were as thick as before.</p>
<p>The Australian specialists agreed that the malady was
non-parasitic, and that, therefore, it must be nervous. It
did not mend, and it was impossible for me to continue the
voyage. The only way I could have continued it would have
been by being lashed in my bunk, for in my helpless condition,
unable to clutch with my hands, I could not have moved about on a
small rolling boat. Also, I said to myself that while there
were many boats and many voyages, I had but one pair of hands and
one set of toe-nails. Still further, I reasoned that in my
own climate of California I had always maintained a stable
nervous equilibrium. So back I came.</p>
<p>Since my return I have completely recovered. And I have
found out what was the matter with me. I encountered a book
by Lieutenant-Colonel Charles E. Woodruff of the United States
Army entitled “Effects of Tropical Light on White
Men.” Then I knew. Later, I met Colonel
Woodruff, and learned that he had been similarly afflicted.
Himself an Army surgeon, seventeen Army surgeons sat on his case
in the Philippines, and, like the Australian specialists,
confessed themselves beaten. In brief, I had a strong
predisposition toward the tissue-destructiveness of tropical
light. I was being torn to pieces by the ultra-violet rays
just as many experimenters with the X-ray have been torn to
pieces.</p>
<p>In passing, I may mention that among the other afflictions
that jointly compelled the abandonment of the voyage, was one
that is variously called the healthy man’s disease,
European Leprosy, and Biblical Leprosy. Unlike True
Leprosy, nothing is known of this mysterious malady. No
doctor has ever claimed a cure for a case of it, though
spontaneous cures are recorded. It comes, they know not
how. It is, they know not what. It goes, they know
not why. Without the use of drugs, merely by living in the
wholesome California climate, my silvery skin vanished. The
only hope the doctors had held out to me was a spontaneous cure,
and such a cure was mine.</p>
<p>A last word: the test of the voyage. It is easy enough
for me or any man to say that it was enjoyable. But there
is a better witness, the one woman who made it from beginning to
end. In hospital when I broke the news to Charmian that I
must go back to California, the tears welled into her eyes.
For two days she was wrecked and broken by the knowledge that the
happy, happy voyage was abandoned.</p>
<p><span class="smcap">Glen Ellen</span>, <span class="smcap">California</span>,<br/>
<i>April</i> 7, 1911.</p>
<h2><SPAN name="chap19"></SPAN>FOOTNOTES</h2>
<p><SPAN name="footnote268"></SPAN><SPAN href="#citation268" class="footnote">[268]</SPAN> To point out that we of the
<i>Snark</i> are not a crowd of weaklings, which might be
concluded from our divers afflictions, I quote the following,
which I gleaned verbatim from the <i>Eugenie’s</i> log and
which may be considered as a sample of Solomon Islands
cruising:</p>
<p style="text-align: center">Ulava, Thursday, March 12,
1908.</p>
<p>Boat went ashore in the morning. Got two loads ivory
nut, 4000 copra. Skipper down with fever.</p>
<p style="text-align: center">Ulava, Friday, March 13, 1908.</p>
<p>Buying nuts from bushmen, 1½ ton. Mate and
skipper down with fever.</p>
<p style="text-align: center">Ulava, Saturday, March 14,
1908.</p>
<p>At noon hove up and proceeded with a very light E.N.E. wind
for Ngora-Ngora. Anchored in 5 fathoms—shell and
coral. Mate down with fever.</p>
<p style="text-align: center">Ngora-Ngora, Sunday, March 15,
1908.</p>
<p>At daybreak found that the boy Bagua had died during the
night, on dysentery. He was about 14 days sick. At
sunset, big N.W. squall. (Second anchor ready)
Lasting one hour and 30 minutes.</p>
<p style="text-align: center">At sea, Monday, March 16, 1908.</p>
<p>Set course for Sikiana at 4 <span class="GutSmall">P.M.</span> Wind broke off. Heavy
squalls during the night. Skipper down on dysentery, also
one man.</p>
<p style="text-align: center">At sea, Tuesday, March 17,
1908.</p>
<p>Skipper and 2 crew down on dysentery. Mate fever.</p>
<p style="text-align: center">At sea, Wednesday, March 18,
1908.</p>
<p>Big sea. Lee-rail under water all the time. Ship
under reefed mainsail, staysail, and inner jib. Skipper and
3 men dysentery. Mate fever.</p>
<p style="text-align: center">At sea, Thursday, March 19,
1908.</p>
<p>Too thick to see anything. Blowing a gale all the
time. Pump plugged up and bailing with buckets.
Skipper and five boys down on dysentery.</p>
<p style="text-align: center">At sea, Friday, March 20, 1908.</p>
<p>During night squalls with hurricane force. Skipper and
six men down on dysentery.</p>
<p style="text-align: center">At sea, Saturday, March 21,
1908.</p>
<p>Turned back from Sikiana. Squalls all day with heavy
rain and sea. Skipper and best part of crew on
dysentery. Mate fever.</p>
<div class="gapspace"> </div>
<p>And so, day by day, with the majority of all on board
prostrated, the <i>Eugenie’s</i> log goes on. The
only variety occurred on March 31, when the mate came down with
dysentery and the skipper was floored by fever.</p>
<SPAN name="endofbook"></SPAN>
<div style="break-after:column;"></div><br />